Skip to main content

Plumbing

Black & Decker the Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition - Completely Updated to Current Codes

Source: Black & Decker the Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition - Completely Updated to Current Codes.pdf

Source file: Black & Decker the Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition - Completely Updated to Current Codes.pdf

                                                       The Complete Guide to

                  PLUMBING                                           Updated 7th Edition

                                               Completely Updated to Current Codes

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 1 24/9/18 5:03 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 1 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:1

              © 2019 Quarto Publishing Group USA Inc. Text © 2003, additional         10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
              text 2015, 2019
                                                                                      ISBN: 978-0-7603-6281-5
              First published in 2019 by Cool Springs Press, an imprint of The
              Quarto Group, 100 Cummings Center, Suite 265-D, Beverly, MA             Digital edition published in 2019
              01915, USA. T (978) 282-9590 F (978) 283-2742                           eISBN: 978-0-7603-6282-2
              QuartoKnows.com
                                                                                      Library of Congress Control Number: 2018908702
              All rights reserved. No part of this book may be reproduced in any
              form without written permission of the copyright owners. All images     Acquiring Editor: Mark Johanson
              in this book have been reproduced with the knowledge and prior          Edition Editor: Chris Peterson
              consent of the artists concerned, and no responsibility is accepted     Project Manager: Alyssa Bluhm
              by producer, publisher, or printer for any infringement of copyright    Art Director: Brad Springer
              or otherwise, arising from the contents of this publication. Every      Layout: Danielle Smith-Boldt
              effort has been made to ensure that credits accurately comply with      Photography: Rich Fleischman (except as noted)
              information supplied. We apologize for any inaccuracies that may        Photo Assistance: Charles Mossey
              have occurred and will resolve inaccurate or missing information in a
              subsequent reprinting of the book.                                       (printer will drop
                                                                                       in FSC logo here;
              Cool Springs Press titles are also available at discount for retail,
                                                                                          12mm high)
              wholesale, promotional, and bulk purchase. For details, contact
              the Special Sales Manager by email at specialsales@quarto.com
              or by mail at The Quarto Group, Attn: Special Sales Manager, 100
              Cummings Center, Suite 265-D, Beverly, MA 01915, USA.

              BLACK+DECKER and the BLACK+DECKER logo are trademarks of The Black & Decker Corporation and are used under license. All rights reserved.

                 NOTICE TO READERS
                 For safety, use caution, care, and good judgment when following the procedures described in this book. The publisher and
                 BLACK+DECKER cannot assume responsibility for any damage to property or injury to persons as a result of misuse of the
                 information provided.
                     The techniques shown in this book are general techniques for various applications. In some instances, additional
                 techniques not shown in this book may be required. Always follow manufacturers’ instructions included with products,
                 since deviating from the directions may void warranties. The projects in this book vary widely as to skill levels required:
                 some may not be appropriate for all do-it-yourselfers, and some may require professional help.
                     Consult your local building department for information on building permits, codes, and other laws as they apply to
                 your project.

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 2 24/9/18 5:03 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 2 23/10/18 11:55 AM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:2

       Contents
                                   The Complete Guide to Plumbing                                                     12

                                   Introduction                                                            7
                                   The Home Plumbing System                                                8
                                   Shutting off the Water                                                12
                                                                                                                      15

                                   PLUMBING TOOLS, MATERIALS & SKILLS
                                   Plumbing Tools                                                        16
                                   Plumbing Materials                                                    20
                                   Copper                                                                22
                                   Push-Fit Fittings                                                     30
                                   PEX Pipe                                                              32
                                   Rigid Plastic Pipe                                                    42
                                   Working with Outdoor Flexible Plastic Pipe                            46
                                   Pipe Fittings                                                         48
                                   Shutoff Valves                                                        52
                                                                                                                      76
                                   Valves & Hose Bibs                                                    54
                                   Compression Fittings                                                  56

                                   INSTALLING PLUMBING LINES
                                   Installation Basics                                                   60
                                   Planning Plumbing Routes                                              64
                                   Building a Wet Wall                                                   76

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 3 2/10/18 10:25 AM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 3 2/10/18 10:24 AM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:3

                                           Contents (Cont.)

                                             INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS
                               84
                                             Toilets                                                        84
                                             Kitchen Faucets                                                90
                                             Kitchen Drains & Traps                                         96
                                             Dishwashers                                                  100
                                             Garbage Disposals                                            104
                                             Icemakers                                                    110
                                             Water Heaters                                                116
                               96            Lavatory Faucets                                             128
                                             Hands-Free Bathroom Faucets                                  133
                                             Lavatory Drains                                              136
                                             Shower Kits                                                  140
                                             Glass-Wall Shower                                            148
                                             Custom Shower Bases                                          154
                                             Wet Rooms & Curbless Showers                                 162

                              184            Alcove Bathtubs                                              174
                                             Sliding Tub Doors                                            180
                                             Jetted Tub                                                   184
                                             Bidets                                                       192
                                             Water Softeners                                              196
                                             Pedestal & Console Sinks                                     200
                                             Traditional Vanity                                           206

                              202

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 4 24/9/18 5:04 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 4 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:4

                                   Vanity Top with Integral Sink                                   208
                                                                                                                 208
                                   Kitchen Sinks                                                   212
                                   Standpipe Drains                                                214
                                   Freestanding Tubs                                               218
                                   Pot Filler                                                      222

                                   PLUMBING REPAIRS
                                   Common Toilet Problems                                          226
                                   Clogged Toilets                                                 240           214

                                   Toilet Flanges                                                  244
                                   Sink Faucets                                                    248
                                   Kitchen Sprayers                                                258
                                   Fixing Leaky Tubs & Shower Faucets                              262
                                   Single-Handle Tub & Shower Faucet with Scald Control            270
                                   Tubs & Showers                                                  274
                                   Sink Drains                                                     278           225
                                   Branch & Main Drains                                            280
                                   Noisy Pipes                                                     282

                                   Measurement Conversions                                         284
                                   Resources                                                       285
                                   Photo Credits                                                   285
                                   Index                                                           286
                                                                                                                 280

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 5 2/10/18 9:41 AM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 5 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:5

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 6 24/9/18 5:04 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 6 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:6

       Introduction
       P    lumbing can seem like an overwhelming part of home DIY. Walk down any plumbing
            aisle in a large home improvement center, or even your local hardware store, and
       the vast array of fittings, pipe, and tubing types and accessories can seem endlessly
       complex. How do they all go together? Which material is best? The questions quickly
       mount. But you can rest assured that tackling your own home plumbing issues,
       improvements, and repairs is not only entirely doable, but it will also save you big
       money. The really good news? All your home plumbing follows basic principles and
       commonsense guidelines, and is dictated by simple hydro science. Once you understand
       the fundamentals of how water comes into your house, is heated or not, and exits with
       or without waste, you’ll quickly master how and why different materials and fixtures are
       used where they’re used.

       This seventh edition of The Complete Guide                    material seldom used a decade ago—continues to rise
       to Plumbing has been written—and revised—                     in popularity and use among both professionals and
       specifically to help you gain that understanding              home DIYers thanks to its ease of manipulation and
       and simplify what can seem at first glance like a             low cost. Toilets continue to become more efficient,
       very complex part of your home’s construction. For            and some now even include smarthome features,
       almost twenty years, this book has been the first tool        such as voice-command seat heating and nightlights.
       in the homeowner’s plumbing tool kit—a resource               More importantly, suppliers continue to come up with
       any DIYer can turn to for trusted information                 ingenious ways to make plumbing projects easier,
       presented in a no-nonsense, easy-to-use format.               such as the push-fit fittings covered on page 30.
       We’ve included a wealth of pictures that capture                  Of course, it’s understandable if you want to start
       every how-to procedure and technique in precise               small and build the skills you’ll need for a bigger
       detail. The pictures accompany simple and direct              project. You might tackle updating your kitchen faucet
       text instructions, explanations, and advice. The              (see page 90) or adding a more powerful garbage
       combination provides all you need to make any                 disposal (see page 104). Once you’ve become
       common plumbing repair or update.                             familiar with the techniques and materials, you can
           This edition of The Complete Guide to Plumbing            move on to replacing your toilet with a new, more
       includes instructions and information consistent              efficient, and more attractive version (see page 84),
       with the 2018 update to the national plumbing                 or even replacing an old, undersized bathtub with
       code. The code is updated every three years, a key            a sleek curbless shower that will turn your morning
       reason why this revised edition is so important. But          shower into a daily luxury and add value to the home.
       there’s another reason to regularly update this book.         Soon enough, you’ll be able to replace a water heater,
       Manufacturers are constantly refining plumbing                fix a sink drain, or even plumb for a new addition as
       products and technology. For instance, PEX tubing—a           the need arises. It’s all just a turn of the page away.

                                                                                                                  INTRODUCTION            7

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 7 24/9/18 5:04 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 7 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:7

              The Home Plumbing System

              B    ecause most of a plumbing system is hidden inside walls and floors,
                   it may seem to be a complex maze of pipes and fittings. But spend
              a few minutes with us and you’ll gain a basic understanding of your
              system. Understanding how home plumbing works is an important first
              step toward doing routine maintenance and money‑saving repairs.
                  A typical home plumbing system includes three basic parts: a water
              supply system, a fixture and appliance set, and a drain system. These
              three parts can be seen clearly in the photograph of the cut‑away house
              on the opposite page.
                  Fresh water enters a home through a main supply line (1). This fresh
              water source is provided by either a municipal water company or a
              private underground well. If the source is a municipal supplier, the water
              passes through a meter (2) that registers the amount of water used. A
              family of four uses about 400 gallons of water each day.
                  Immediately after the main supply enters the house, a branch line
              splits off (3) and is joined to a water heater (4). From the water heater,
              a hot water line runs parallel to the cold water line to bring the water
              supply to fixtures and appliances throughout the house. Fixtures include
              sinks, bathtubs, showers, and laundry tubs. Appliances include water
              heaters, dishwashers, clothes washers, and water softeners. Toilets
              and exterior sillcocks are examples of fixtures that require only a cold
              water line.
                  The water supply to fixtures and appliances is controlled with
              faucets and valves. Faucets and valves have moving parts and seals that
              eventually may wear out or break, but they are easily repaired or replaced.
                  Waste water then enters the drain system. It first must flow past a
              drain trap (5), a U‑shaped piece of pipe that holds standing water and
              prevents sewer gases from entering the home. Every fixture must have a
              drain trap.
                  The drain system works entirely by gravity, allowing waste water to
              flow downhill through a series of large‑diameter pipes. These drain pipes
              are attached to a system of vent pipes. Vent pipes (6) bring air into the
              drain system to prevent suction or pressure that might allow the trap to
              lose its water seal. Vent pipes usually exit the house at a roof vent (7).
                  All waste water eventually reaches a drainage stack or a building drain (8).
                                                                                                   Water meters and main shutoff valves
              NOTE: In a two- or more story house there is usually more than one                   are located where the main water
              drainage stack. There is no stack in a one-story house. The stack or                 supply pipe enters the house. The
                                                                                                   water meter is the property of your local
              building drain becomes a sewer line (9) that exits the house near the
                                                                                                   municipal water company. If the water
              foundation. In a municipal system, this sewer line joins a main sewer                meter leaks, or if you suspect it is not
              line located near the street. Where sewer service is not available, waste            functioning properly, call your water
              water empties into a septic system.                                                  company for repairs.

       8      THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 8 24/9/18 5:04 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 8 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:8

                                                        (7) Roof vent

                                                                                        (8) Drainage stack
                                                                                             and vent

                                                                                                                  (6) Vent pipe

                                                        (5) Drain trap

                             (4) Water
                               heater

                                                          (3) Branch
                                                              line

                                                                                                                 Branch drain line

                                                           Main shutoff
                                                              valve

                                                                     (2) Water meter

            Hot water
            supply lines
                                                                      Floor drain
            Cold water
            supply lines

            Drain lines

            Vent lines

                                         (1) Main supply line                (9) Sewer line

                                                                                                                                       INTRODUCTION            9

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 9 24/9/18 5:04 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 9 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:9

              Water Supply System
              Water supply pipes carry hot and cold water                bibs, are supplied only by cold water. Appliances
              throughout a house. In homes built before 1960, the        include dishwashers and clothes washers. A
              original supply pipes were usually made of galvanized      refrigerator icemaker uses only cold water. Tradition
              steel. Newer homes have supply pipes made of copper.       says that hot water supply pipes and faucet handles
              Beginning in the 1980s, supply pipes made of rigid         are found on the left‑hand side of a fixture, with cold
              CPVC plastic became more commonplace, and the              water on the right.
              more recent plumbing innovations find PEX pipe                 Because it is pressurized, the water supply system
              widely used and accepted.                                  is occasionally prone to leaks. This is especially true
                  Water supply pipes are made to withstand the high      of galvanized iron pipe, which has limited resistance
              pressures of the water supply system. They have small      to corrosion.
              diameters, usually ½ to 1 inch, and are joined with            For some houses in older neighborhoods, the main
              strong, watertight fittings. The hot and cold lines run    supply line running from the street to the house is
              in tandem to all parts of the house. Usually, the supply   made of lead; this once posed a health hazard. Today,
              pipes run inside wall cavities or are strapped to the      however, municipalities with lead pipes often add a
              undersides of floor joists.                                trace amount of phosphate to the water, which coats
                  Hot and cold water supply pipes are connected          the inside of the pipes and virtually eliminates leaching
              to fixtures or appliances. Fixtures include sinks, tubs,   of lead into the water. If you are concerned about lead
              and showers. Some fixtures, such as toilets or hose        in your water, check with your local water supplier.

                             Hot water supply lines

                                                                                    Cold water supply lines

                    In from municipal water supply                                          In from municipal water supply

     10       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 10 24/9/18 5:04 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 10 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:10

       Drain-Waste-Vent System
       Drain pipes use gravity to carry waste water away                    water, and they are usually found immediately after
       from fixtures, appliances, and other drain openings.                 the drain tailpiece in the drain opening. The standing
       This waste water is carried out of the house to a                    water of a trap prevents sewer gases from backing
       municipal sewer system or septic tank.                               up into the home. Each time a drain is used, the
           Newer drain pipes are plastic. In an older home,                 standing trap water is flushed away and replaced by
       drain pipes may be cast iron, galvanized steel, copper,              new water.
       or lead. Because they are not part of the supply                        In order to work properly, the drain system
       system, lead drain pipes pose no health hazard.                      requires air. Air allows waste water to flow freely
       However, lead pipes are no longer manufactured for                   down drain pipes.
       home plumbing systems.                                                  To allow air into the drain system, drain pipes
           Drain pipes have diameters ranging from 1¼ to                    are connected to vent pipes. All drain systems must
       4 inches. These large diameters allow waste to pass                  include vents, and the entire system is called the
       through efficiently.                                                 drain‑waste‑vent (DWV) system. One or more vents,
           Traps are an important part of the drain system.                 located on the roof, provide the air needed for the
       These curved sections of drain pipe hold standing                    DWV system to work.

                                                                             Vent
                                                                                                     Vent lines

                                                                 Trap

                                                                                                     Drain lines

                                    Out to municipal sewer or septic tank

                                                                                                                         INTRODUCTION            11

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 11 24/9/18 5:04 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 11 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:11

                                                                                                               Some outdoor shutoffs
                                                                                                               require the use of

              Shutting off the Water                                                                           a special tool, often
                                                                                                               referred to as a “key.”
                                                                                                               Keep your key within
                                                                                                               easy reach in case
                                                                                                               of an emergency. To

              I  n case an emergency requires you to replace or
                 repair a faucet, fixture, or appliance, knowing how
              to shut off the water is imperative. The photos on this
                                                                                                               turn off, slip the key
                                                                                                               over the valve and
                                                                                                               rotate one quarter
                                                                                                               turn, so the handle
              page show the most common types of shutoffs. If you                                              is at a right angle to
              don’t feel completely confident about finding your                                               the pipe. The outdoor
              home’s shutoff points or how to turn them off, contact                                           main shutoff shown
              your local water company for information.                                                        below is an example
                  There are two basic types of valves, which shut off                                          of a shutoff that
                                                                                                               requires a key. If you
              in two different ways. To turn off many older valves,
                                                                                                               lack a key, a meter
              rotate the handle clockwise (remember “lefty loosey;                                             valve can usually be
              righty tighty”) until it stops. To turn off many newer                                           turned with a wrench
              valves, rotate the handle one‑quarter turn only.                                                 or channel-type pliers.

              An outdoor main shutoff may be as
              simple as an exposed valve that you
              turn by hand. Or it may be buried in
              a housing that is sometimes called a
              Buffalo box. In this example, both the
              meter and the main shutoff are housed
              in the Buffalo box; in other cases, the                                Meter
              meter is located inside the house.

                                                                        Key-operated shutoff (open)

              You may have an inside main shutoff,
              usually located near the point where
              the main supply pipe enters the house
              near the water meter. Many homes have
              both a Buffalo box and an indoor main
              shutoff. There may be a valve on each
              side of the meter; turn off either one of
              them to shut off water to the house.

                                                                                         Main shutoff valve

     12       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 12 24/9/18 5:04 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 12 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:12

       Partial-house shutoffs are often found in medium- to large-size            Fixture shutoff valves, also called stop valves, control water
       homes. They control water flow to large areas of the house.                to a specific faucet, toilet, or fixture. They are also usually
       They are found in pairs, one for hot and one for cold water.               found in pairs, one for hot and one for cold. However, toilets,
       Turning off a pair of these may shut off water to a floor or to            icemakers, and other cold-water-only fixtures will have only
       an entire bathroom or kitchen.                                             one stop valve. If you live in an older home that lacks stop
                                                                                  valves, it’s a good idea to install them.

                                                                                              Built-in shutoff valves

                                                             Saddle tee fitting

       Saddle valves often are used to tap into a water supply
       pipe to bring water to a low-demand fixture, such as an
       ice maker or a hot water dispenser. Some municipalities
       do not allow saddle valves, but most do (although the
       vast majority of professional plumbers do not like to
       install them because they tend to leak). The saddle
       valve handle appears to be a shutoff but it is not—if a
       leak develops at or downline from a saddle valve, find
       the closest shutoff valve between the water supply
                                                                                  Integral shutoffs are sometimes found on tub-and-shower
       and the saddle if you need to stop the water flow.
                                                                                  faucets and other fixtures. This arrangement allows water to
                                                                                  be turned off to the fixture only, so water remains available for
                                                                                  the rest of the house.

                                                                                                                                 INTRODUCTION            13

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 13 24/9/18 5:04 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 13 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:13

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 14 24/9/18 5:04 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 14 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:14

                                                                      Plumbing Tools,
                                                                      Materials & Skills

                                                                      M     ost of what you’ll need for basic plumbing
                                                                            projects and repairs is probably already sitting
                                                                      in your toolbox. Certain specialized tools, such as a
                                                                      basin wrench, make specific jobs much easier and
                                                                      quicker and don’t necessarily cost a lot. If you’re
                                                                      willing to do your own plumbing repairs and updates,
                                                                      it only makes sense to purchase one, as well as a good
                                                                      spud wrench. More expensive tools, such as a power
                                                                      drain auger, can be rented at a local tool rental shop
                                                                      as the need for them arises.
                                                                          Plumbing materials continue to evolve. Where
                                                                      copper was once standard for supply lines, PEX has
                                                                      now widely become the material of choice. PVC primer
                                                                      and cement no longer need to be applied in two stages;
                                                                      new combination products make for swifter PVC pipe
                                                                      connections. Many newer plumbing materials are
                                                                      often less expensive and are much easier to work with.
                                                                      Some basic materials should be kept on hand at all
                                                                      times—this includes plumber’s putty and Teflon tape.
                                                                          Of course, you’ll also need to use the right
                                                                      techniques to ensure a good job and head off
                                                                      problems in the future. You’ll find the lowdown on all
                                                                      of these—the right tools, the right materials, and the
                                                                      correct way of doing things—in this section.

                                                                      In this chapter:
                                                                      •   Plumbing Tools
                                                                      •   Plumbing Materials
                                                                      •   Copper
                                                                      •   Push-Fit Fittings
                                                                      •   PEX Pipe
                                                                      •   Rigid Plastic Pipe
                                                                      •   Working with Outdoor Flexible Plastic Pipe
                                                                      •   Pipe Fittings
                                                                      •   Shutoff Valves
                                                                      •   Valves & Hose Bibs
                                                                      •   Compression Fittings

                                                                                   PLUMBING TOOLS, MATERIALS & SKILLS                      15

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 15 24/9/18 5:04 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 15 2/10/18 10:31 AM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:15

              Plumbing Tools

             M     any plumbing projects and repairs can be
                   completed with basic hand tools you probably
              already own. Adding a few simple plumbing tools will
                                                                                        Always care for tools properly. Clean tools after
                                                                                     using them, wiping them free of dirt and dust with a
                                                                                     soft rag. Prevent rust on metal tools by wiping them
              prepare you for all the projects in this book. Specialty               with a rag dipped in household oil. If a metal tool gets
              tools, such as a snap cutter or appliance dolly, are                   wet, dry it immediately, and then wipe it with an oiled
              available at rental centers. When buying tools, invest                 rag. Keep toolboxes and cabinets organized. Make
              in quality products.                                                   sure all tools are stored securely.

                                                                                                Caulk gun & all purpose caulk

                                                                                                             Utility knife

                                                  Head lamp                                             Non-contact volt meter

                                                                                                Wire brush

                                                                           Hacksaw

                                                                      Cold chisel

                                                                                                                             Ratchet wrench
                                                                                                                              and sockets

     16       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 16 24/9/18 5:04 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 16 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:16

                                                                                                            Metal files

                                       Tape measure

                                 Strainer wrench

                                                                      Adjustable wrenches

                               Seat wrench

                            Screwdriver                                                     Needlenose pliers                             Level
                                                  Putty knife         Channel-type pliers

                                                                                                      Basin wrench
                                                                                                                                               (continued)

                                                                                                         PLUMBING TOOLS, MATERIALS & SKILLS                     17

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 17 24/9/18 5:04 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 17 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:17

                                                                               Drill-powered auger is stronger than a hand-crank
                                                                               auger for removing larger pipe obstructions. This auger
                                                                               can be cranked by hand or attached to a standard
                                                                               3
                                                                                ⁄8" power drill.

                                                                                                    Force cup clears drain clogs with
                                                                                                    water and air pressure. The force cup
                                                                                                    is used for toilet bowls. The flange
                                                                                                    usually can be folded up into the cup
                                                                                                    for use as a standard plunger.

                                                                         Pipe wrench has a movable jaw that adjusts
                                                                         to fit a variety of pipe diameters. Pipe
                                                                         wrench is used for tightening and
                                                                         loosening pipes, pipe fittings, and
                                                                         large nuts. Two pipe wrenches
                        Spud wrench is specially designed                often are used together
                        for removing or tightening large                 to prevent damage to
                        nuts that are 2" to 4" in diameter.              pipes and fittings.
                        Hooks on the ends of the wrench
                        grab onto the lugs of large nuts
                        for increased leverage.

                      Blow bag, sometimes
                      called an expansion
                      nozzle, is used
                      to clear drains. It
                      attaches to a garden
                      hose and removes
                      clogs with large
                      spurts of water. The
                      blow bag is best
                      used on floor drains.

                                                                        Plastic tubing cutter works like a
                                                                        gardener’s pruners to cut flexible
                                                                        plastic pipes quickly.
                                       Tubing cutters make straight,
                                       smooth cuts in plastic and
                                       copper pipe. A tubing cutter
                                       usually has a triangular blade
                                       for removing burrs from the
                                       insides of pipes.

     18       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 18 24/9/18 5:04 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 18 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:18

       Closet auger is used to clear toilet clogs.
       It is a slender tube with a crank handle
       on one end of a flexible auger cable.
           A special bend in the tube allows
               the auger to be positioned in the
                  bottom of the toilet bowl. The
                     bend is usually protected
                         with a rubber sleeve to                                                      Motorized
                            prevent scratching                                                       drain auger
                                the toilet.

                                                                      Power miter box

                                     MAPP torch
                                                                      Right-angle
                                     is used for
                                                                         drill                                                     Appliance dolly
                                     soldering fittings
                                     to copper pipes.
                                     Light the torch
                                     quickly and
                                     safely using a
                                     spark lighter.                                                             Snap cutter

                                                                Rental tools may be needed for large jobs and special situations. A power miter saw
                                                                makes fast, accurate cuts in a wide variety of materials, including plastic pipes. A
                                                                motorized drain auger clears tree roots from sewer service lines. Use an appliance
                                                                dolly to move heavy objects, such as water heaters. A snap cutter is designed
                                                                to cut tough cast-iron pipes. The right-angle drill is useful for drilling holes in
                                                                hard-to-reach areas.

                                                                                        Power drills and bits

                                                                                               Reciprocating saw

       Flame-resistant pad helps keep wood
       and other underlying materials safe                      Power hand tools can make any job faster, easier, and safer. Cordless power tools
       from the torch’s flame.                                  offer added convenience. Use a cordless 3⁄8" power drill for virtually any drilling task.

                                                                                                        PLUMBING TOOLS, MATERIALS & SKILLS                     19

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 19 24/9/18 5:04 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 19 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:19

              Plumbing Materials
                     COMMON PIPE & TUBE TYPES
                                                                      BENEFITS & CHARACTERISTICS

                                                                      Acrylonitrile butadiene styrene (ABS) is an approved DWV pipe (although it
                                                                      has its detractors) and is commonly used in many markets, especially in the
                                                                      western U.S.

                                                                      Cast iron is strong but hard to work with. Repairs should be made with
                                                                      plastic pipe.

                                                                      Polyvinyl chloride (PVC) is rigid plastic that resists heat and chemicals. Schedule
                                                                      40 is the minimum thickness, although Schedule 80 pipe minimizes water noise.

                                                                      Chlorinated polyvinyl chloride (CPVC) rigid plastic is inexpensive and
                                                                      withstands high temperature and pressure.

                                                                      Chromed brass has an attractive shiny surface and is used for drain traps
                                                                      where appearance is important.

                                                                      Polyethylene (PE) plastic is a black or bluish flexible pipe sometimes used for
                                                                      main water service lines as well as irrigation systems.

                                                                      Black pipe (iron pipe) generally is threaded at the ends to accept female-
                                                                      threaded fittings. Usually used for gas lines; it is not for potable water.

                                                                      Rigid copper is used for water supply pipes. It resists corrosion and has
                                                                      smooth surfaces for good water flow.

                                                                      Braided metal is used for water supply tubes that connect shutoff valves
                                                                      to fixtures.

                                                                      Flexible stainless-steel (protective coated) connectors are used to attach gas
                                                                      appliances to supply stopcocks.

                                                                      Flexible stainless-steel (uncoated) connectors are used to attach gas
                                                                      appliances to supply stopcocks.

                                                                      Chromed copper supply tube is used in areas where appearance is important.
                                                                      It is easy to bend and fit.

                                                                      Cross-linked polyethylene (PEX) is flexible and is approved by major building
                                                                      codes for water supply.

                                                                      Flexible copper tubing (not shown) bends easily and requires fewer couplings
                                                                      than rigid copper.

     20       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 20 24/9/18 5:04 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 20 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:20

            COMMON USES                                  LENGTHS               DIAMETERS       FITTING METHODS                              TOOLS USED FOR CUTTING

                                                                               1¼, 1½, 2,                                                   Tubing cutter, miter box,
            DWV pipes, sewer pipes, drain traps          10'                                   Solvent cement or threaded fittings
                                                                               3, 4"                                                        or hacksaw

                                                                                               Oakum & lead, banded
            DWV pipes, sewer pipes                       5', 10'               1½, 2, 3, 4"                                                 Snap cutter or hacksaw
                                                                                               neoprene couplings

le 10’, 20’; or sold 1¼”, 1½”, Tubing cutter, miter box, DWV pipes, sewer pipes, drain traps Solvent cement, threaded fittings e. by linear feet 2”, 3”, 4” or hacksaw

                                                                               3
                                                                                ⁄8", ½", ¾",   Solvent cement & plastic fittings,           Tubing cutter, miter box,
            Hot & cold water supply pipes                10'
                                                                               1"              or with compression fittings                 or hacksaw

            Valves & shutoffs; drain traps,                                    1¼", ½", ¾",    Compression fittings,                        Tubing cutter, hacksaw,
                                                         Lengths vary
            supply risers                                                      1¼", 1½"        or with metal solder                         or reciprocating saw

                                                         Sold in coils of 25                   Rigid PVC fittings                           Ratchet-style plastic pipe
            Outdoor cold water supply pipes                                  ¼" to 1"
                                                         to hundreds of feet                   & stainless steel hose clamps                cutter or miter saw

                                                                                                                                            Hacksaw, power cutoff saw,
                                                         Sold in lengths       3
                                                                                ⁄8, 1, 1¼,
            Gas supply pipe                                                                    Threaded connectors                          or reciprocating saw with
                                                         up to 10'             1½"
                                                                                                                                            bi-metal blade
                                                                                               Metal solder, compression fittings,
                                                         10', 20'; or sold     3
                                                                                ⁄8", ½", ¾",                                                Tubing cutter, hacksaw,
            Hot & cold water supply pipes                                                      threaded fittings, press connect fittings,
                                                         by linear feet        1"                                                           or jigsaw
                                                                                               push connect fittings, flared fittings

            Supply tubes                                 12" or 20"            ⁄8, ½, ¾"
                                                                               3
                                                                                               Attached threaded fittings                   Do not cut

            Gas ranges, dryers, water heaters            12" to 60"            ⁄8", ½" (OD)
                                                                               5
                                                                                               Attached threaded fittings                   Do not cut

            Gas ranges, dryers, water heaters            12" to 60"            ⁄8", ½" (OD)
                                                                               5
                                                                                               Attached threaded fittings                   Do not cut

            Supply tubing                                12", 20", 30"         ⁄8"
                                                                               3
                                                                                               Brass compression fittings                   Tubing cutter or hacksaw

                                                         Sold in coils of 25
            Hot & cold water supply; PEX-AL-PEX
                                                         feet to hundreds      ¼" to 1"        Crimp fittings, push connect fittings        Tubing cutter
            (usually orange) is used in radiant floors
                                                         of feet

                                                         30', 60' coils;       ¼", 3⁄8", ½",   Brass flare fittings, solder, compression
            Gas supply; hot & cold water supply                                                                                             Tubing cutter or hacksaw
                                                         or by feet            ¾", 1"          fittings

                                                                                                                   PLUMBING TOOLS, MATERIALS & SKILLS                     21

 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 21                                                                                                 24/9/18 5:04 PM
 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 21                                                                                                 24/9/18 5:03 PM
                                                                                                               Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition
                                                     Text                                                                                                           Page:21

              Copper

              C    opper is nearly ideal for water supply pipes. A
                   purely natural (and consequently environmentally
              friendly) material, it resists corrosion and has a
              smooth surface that allows efficient water flow. The
              pipes are available in several diameters, but most
              home plumbing is done with ½‑ or ¾‑inch pipe. The
              pipe comes in both rigid and flexible forms, although
              any copper pipe is going to be somewhat rigid.                               Soldering is a traditional way to join copper pipe and fittings,
                  The drawbacks to copper pipe are its susceptibility                      but it takes some practice to master (lead-free solders, now
              to leaks if it comes in contact with highly acidic                           a requirement, can be a little more finicky). But push-fit
              well water, as well as its expense—also, traditional                         fittings and other connection and material options are largely
                                                                                           replacing soldered fittings and pipe.
              soldering or “sweating” of copper fittings is a skill
              that takes some practice to get right. PEX is an
              increasingly popular option because it is cheaper                                Flexible copper, also called soft copper, comes in two
              and the semiflexible tubes can be quickly and easily                         wall‑thickness grades: Types L and K. Both are approved
              routed through framing without concern for kinks or                          for most home water supply systems, although flexible
              the need for meticulous bending.                                             Type L copper is used primarily for gas service lines.
                  Rigid copper, sometimes called hard copper, is                           Because it is bendable and will resist a mild frost, Type
              approved for home water supply systems by all local                          L may be installed as part of a water supply system in
              codes. It comes in three wall‑thickness grades: Types                        unheated indoor areas, such as crawl spaces. Type K is
              M, L, and K. Type M is the thinnest, the least expensive,                    used for underground water service lines.
              and a good choice for do‑it‑yourself home plumbing.                              A third form of copper, called DWV, is used for drain
                  Rigid Type L usually is required by code for                             systems. Because most codes now allow low‑cost plastic
              commercial plumbing systems. Because it is strong                            pipes for drain systems, DWV copper is seldom used.
              and solders easily, Type L may be preferred by some                              Copper pipes are connected with soldered,
              professional plumbers and do‑it‑yourselfers for home                         compression, flare, or push‑fit fittings (see chart
              use. Type K has the heaviest wall thickness and is                           below). Always follow your local code for the correct
              used most often for underground water service lines.                         types of pipes and fittings allowed in your area.

                     COPPER PIPE & FITTING CHART
                                                       RIGID COPPER                FLEXIBLE COPPER
                  FITTING METHOD            TYPE M         TYPE L        TYPE K   TYPE L      TYPE K     GENERAL COMMENTS

                                                                                                         Inexpensive, strong, and trouble-free fitting method.
                  Soldered                    yes            yes           yes     yes          yes
                                                                                                         Requires some skill.
                                                                                                         Makes repairs and replacement easy. More expensive
                  Compression                 yes              not applicable       no          no
                                                                                                         than solder. Best used on flexible copper.
                                                                                                         Use only with flexible copper pipes. Usually used as a
                  Flare                        no             no           no      yes          yes
                                                                                                         gas-line fitting. Requires some skill.
                  Push-fit fittings            no            yes           yes      no          no       Easy to use. Flexible and inexpensive.

     22       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 22 24/9/18 5:04 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 22 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:22

                                                                                                A                                              B
                                                                                                                             A

                                                                      ASTM rating

                                                 Diameter

                                                                                                                                                   C
                                                                                                                                       D
                                                           Wall thickness grade
                                                                                                                E

       Grade stamp information includes the pipe diameter, the
       wall-thickness grade, and a stamp of approval from the ASTM
       (American Society for Testing and Materials). Type M pipe is
       identified by red lettering, Type L by blue lettering.
                                                                                                     J
                                                                                          I

                                                                                                                         H

                                                                                                                                   F
                                                                                                                     G

       Bend flexible copper pipe with a coil-spring tubing bender                     Specialty tools and materials for working with copper
       to avoid kinks. Select a bender that matches the outside                       include: flaring tools (A), emery cloth (B), coil-spring tubing
       diameter of the pipe. Slip the bender over the pipe using a                    bender (C), pipe joint compound (D), soldering paste (flux)
       twisting motion. Bend pipe slowly until it reaches the correct                 (E), lead-free solder (F), wire brush (G), flux brush (H),
       angle, but not more than 90º.                                                  compression fitting (I), flare fitting (J).

           Elbow cut                                   Fitting socket                               Fitting socket
            away to
          show depth
            of pipe

                                                                             Length of pipe

                                                                                                                                            Tee-fitting
                                                                                                                                           cut away to
                                                                                                                                           show depth
                                                                                                                                             of pipe

       Find the length of copper pipe needed by measuring between the bottom of the copper fitting sockets (fittings shown in cutaway).
       Mark the length on the pipe with a felt-tipped pen.

                                                                                                         PLUMBING TOOLS, MATERIALS & SKILLS                    23

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 23 24/9/18 5:04 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 23 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:23

              Cutting & Soldering Copper
              The best way to cut rigid and flexible copper pipe is
              with a tubing cutter. A tubing cutter makes a smooth,                 SOLDERING TIPS
              straight cut, an important first step toward making a
              watertight joint. Remove any metal burrs on the cut
              edges with a reaming tool or round file.
                   Copper can be cut with a hacksaw. A hacksaw is
              useful in tight areas where a tubing cutter will not
              fit. Take care to make a smooth, straight cut when
              cutting with a hacksaw.
                   A soldered pipe joint, also called a sweated joint,
              is made by heating a copper or brass fitting with a
              propane torch until the fitting is just hot enough to
              melt metal solder. The heat draws the solder into the
              gap between the fitting and pipe to form a watertight
              seal. A fitting that is overheated or unevenly heated
              will not draw in solder. Copper pipes and fittings must             Use caution when soldering copper. Pipes and
                                                                                  fittings become very hot and must be allowed to cool
              be clean and dry to form a watertight seal.
                                                                                  before handling.

                     TOOLS & MATERIALS
                  Tubing cutter with                     Channel-type pliers
                     reaming tip (or                     Copper pipe
                     hacksaw & round file)               Copper fittings                                                     Torch valve
                  Wire brush                             Emery cloth
                  Flux brush                             Soldering paste (flux)
                  Propane torch                          Sheet metal
                  Spark lighter (or matches)             Lead-free solder
                  Round file                             Rag
                  Cloth                                  Eye & ear protection     Prevent accidents by shutting off the torch immediately
                  Adjustable wrench                      Work gloves              after use. Make sure the valve is closed completely.

                                                                                                                             Protect wood from
                                                                                                                             the heat of the
                                                                                                                             torch flame while
                                                                                                                             soldering. Use an
                                                                                                                             old cookie sheet,
                                                                                                                             two sheets of
                                                                                                                             26-gauge metal,
                                                                                                                             or a fiber shield,
                                                                                                                             as shown.

     24

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 24 24/9/18 5:09 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 24 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:24

                  How to Cut Rigid & Flexible Copper Pipe

                                                                                      Cutting wheel
            1

                                                                                  Roller

                                                                                                                                      2
       Place the tubing cutter over the pipe and tighten the handle so    Turn the tubing cutter one rotation so that the cutting wheel
       that the pipe rests on both rollers and the cutting wheel is on    scores a continuous straight line around the pipe.
       the marked line.

                                                                                       Reaming point

                                                                      3       4
       Rotate the cutter in the opposite direction, tightening the        Remove sharp metal burrs from the inside edge of the cut pipe
       handle slightly after every two rotations, until the cut           using a round file or the reaming point on the tubing cutter.
       is complete.

                                                                                           PLUMBING TOOLS, MATERIALS & SKILLS                     25

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 25 24/9/18 5:04 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 25 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:25

                          How to Solder Copper Pipes & Fittings

                    1                                                               2

                                              Emery cloth

              Clean the end of each pipe by sanding with an emery cloth.        Clean the inside of each fitting by scouring with a wire brush
              Ends must be free of dirt and grease to ensure that the solder    or emery cloth.
              forms a good seal.

                    3                                                               4

                        Flux brush

              Apply a thin layer of soldering paste (flux) to the end of each   Apply a thin layer of flux to the inside of the fitting.
              pipe using a flux brush. Soldering paste should cover about 1"
              of pipe end. Don’t use too much flux.

     26       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 26 24/9/18 5:04 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 26 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:26

                       Fitting

                                          Pipe

                                                                      5                                                                 6
       Assemble each joint by inserting the pipe into the fitting so it is   Use a clean dry cloth to remove excess flux before soldering
       tight against the bottom of the fitting sockets. Twist each fitting   the assembled fitting.
       slightly to spread soldering paste.

            7                                                                    8

       Prepare the wire solder by unwinding 8" to 10" of wire from           Open the gas valve and trigger the spark lighter to ignite the
       the spool. Bend the first 2" of the wire to a 90º angle.              torch. Adjust the torch valve until the inner portion of the
                                                                             flame is 1" to 2" long.                              (continued)

                                                                                            PLUMBING TOOLS, MATERIALS & SKILLS                      27

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 27 24/9/18 5:04 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 27 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:27

                    9             Pipe                                               10
                  Fitting

                                 Pipe

              Move the torch flame back and forth and around the pipe and         Heat the other side of the copper fitting to ensure that heat is
              the fitting to heat the area evenly.                                distributed evenly. Touch the solder to the pipe. The solder
                                                                                  will melt when the pipe is at the right temperature.

                  11                                                                 12

                                               Lip of fitting

              When the solder melts, remove the torch and quickly push ½"         Allow the joint to cool briefly, then wipe away excess solder
              to ¾" of solder into each joint. Capillary action fills the joint   with a dry rag.
              with liquid solder. A correctly soldered joint should show a
              thin bead of solder around the lips of the fitting.                 CAUTION: Pipes will be hot. If joints leak after water is
                                                                                  turned on, disassemble and resolder.

     28       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 28 24/9/18 5:04 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 28 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:28

                  How to Solder Brass Valves

            1                                                                    2

       Valves should be fully open during all stages of the soldering        To prevent valve damage, quickly heat the pipe and the
       process. If a valve has any plastic or rubber parts, remove           flanges of the valve, not the valve body. After soldering, cool
       them prior to soldering.                                              the valve by spraying it with water.

                  How to Take Apart Soldered Joints

            1                              Fitting                               2

                                                                      Pipe

                 Pipe

       Turn off the water and drain the pipes by opening the highest and     Use channel-type pliers to separate the pipes from
       lowest faucets in the house. Light your torch. Hold the flame tip     the fitting.
       to the fitting until the solder becomes shiny and begins to melt.

            3                                                                    4

       Remove old solder by heating the ends of the pipe with your           Use emery cloth to polish the ends of the pipe down to bare
       torch. Use a dry rag to wipe away melted solder quickly.              metal. Never reuse fittings.

       CAUTION: Pipes will be hot.

                                                                                             PLUMBING TOOLS, MATERIALS & SKILLS                     29

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 29 24/9/18 5:04 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 29 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:29

                                                                                                 The fittings are manufactured with a ring of
                                                                                             stainless‑steel teeth pointed to allow the fitting to
                                                                                             slide over the end of a pipe and secure it in place. An
                                                                                             EPDM rubber O‑ring makes a watertight connection
                                                                                             around the outside of the pipe, and the O‑ring is pre‑
                                                                                             lubricated to ensure it seals on the surface of the pipe
                                                                                             and remains supple.
              Push-Fit Fittings                                                                  Push‑fit fittings can be used on copper, CPVC, and
                                                                                             PEX‑A and ‑B pipes. When used with PEX pipe, a plastic
                                                                                             sleeve is fitted inside the pipe and stiffens the PEX to
                                                                                             allow the fitting to hold tight. This plastic sleeve must

              A   lso known as “push‑to‑connect,” push‑fit fittings
                   have been around roughly since the turn of the
              latest century. They were originally developed for
                                                                                             be removed from the push‑fit fittings when they are
                                                                                             used with copper and CPVC. In every case, the fittings
                                                                                             themselves are generally rated at about 200 psi and 200°F.
              naval use, which is an indicator of how reliable they                              Still, cost may ultimately affect whether you
              are—when installed correctly and under the right                               choose push‑fit fittings; the fittings are far more
              circumstances. These are the height of ease‑of‑use                             expensive than their more traditional counterparts.
              in plumbing connections, requiring no soldering,                               That’s why most homeowners and professionals tend
              chemicals such as glue or solvent, or even tools.                              to use the fittings for small projects and repairs.

                                                                                        Stainless-steel teeth                        Plastic sleeve (PEX only)

              Push-fit fittings may be used on several
              types of supply pipes and can even
              join dissimilar pipes in the same run.                                        O-ring
                                                                                                                                               Shown cutaway
              The fittings freely spin on a pipe end,
              making their application more versatile.
              Given that you don’t need any tools to                  Push-fit fittings make a watertight seal with a EPDM rubber O-ring. A row of
              install them, these are great options for               stainless-steel teeth grab and hold the pipe in place. Plastic insert sleeves (right) are
              tight spaces that would not allow for a                 employed only when the fitting is used with PEX and should be removed for copper
              soldering iron, torch, or other tools.                  or CPVC joints.

                      DOS FOR USING PUSH-FIT FITTINGS                                                DON’TS FOR USING PUSH-FIT FITTINGS
                  •    Start with a clean cut. The fitting’s seal relies on                     •    Never use a push-fit fitting in a system weatherized
                       solidly sitting on the end of the pipe. Use a copper                          with glycol, such as in a plumbed recreational
                       pipe cutter—not a saw—when cutting copper pipe for                            vehicle. The glycol may react with the O-ring
                       push-fit fittings, and cut PEX with a PEX tubing cutter.                      lubricant and damage the seal.
                  •    Limit reuse. Although manufacturers regularly                            •    Do not use push-fit fittings with any lubricants,
                       specify that these fittings can be reused four or five                        glues, solvents, Teflon tape, or other compounds.
                       times in some cases, most professionals tend to limit
                                                                                                •    Don’t sand the end of copper pipe prior to installing
                       reuse to two or three times. There is concern that the
                                                                                                     a push-fit fitting.
                       lubricant that helps the O-ring maintain a seal could
                       wear away and create leaks after too many reuses.                        •    Never use push-fit fittings with PEX-AL-PEX
                                                                                                     (PEX-A and PEX-B are fine).
                  •    Ream carefully. Clean up the end of any pipe that
                       will be used with these fittings. Even a small burr                      •    Don’t use the fittings for exterior applications where
                       can damage push-fit rubber O-rings.                                           they’ll be consistently exposed to sunlight.

     30       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 30 2/10/18 9:42 AM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 30 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:30

                                                                                                                Push-fit fittings for copper pipe are
                                                                                                                available as couplings, elbows, tees,
             Elbow
                                                                                                                and even shutoff valves. A special tool
                                                                                                                (some have handles and some don’t)
                                                                                                                can be purchased to make it easier to
                                                                                                                disassemble push-fit joints.

                                                                                 Tee fitting

                                                                                                                     TOOLS & MATERIALS
                                                                                  Disconnect tools                 Pipe cutter
                                  Threaded elbow
                                                                                                                   Push-fit fitting
                                                                                                                   Deburr tool or utility knife
                                                                  Reducing                                         Depth gauge or ruler
                              Ball valve                          coupling
                                                                                                                   Marker
                                                                                                                   Disconnect tool (optional)

                  How to Install Push-Fit Fittings

                                                                             1                                                                      2

       Cleanly cut the end of the pipe with a cutter meant for use on                 Remove the fittings’ plastic sleeve if you’re working with any
       the pipe’s material. Clean up the cut end and deburr with the                  pipe other than PEX. Slide the fitting onto the end of the pipe
       manufacturer’s tool. Use the manufacturer’s depth gauge or a                   all the way until you reach the depth gauge mark. Pull on the
       ruler to mark the pipe with the proper fitting depth.                          fitting to ensure it is securely fixed to the pipe.

                                                                                                                OPTION: If you need to remove the
                                                                                                                fitting for any reason, slip the removal
                                                                                                                tool over the pipe, snug it to the bottom
                                                                                                                of the fitting, and slowly pull the tool
                                                                                                                and the fitting off the pipe, twisting both
                                                                                                                as you pull.

                                                                                                        PLUMBING TOOLS, MATERIALS & SKILLS                      31

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 31 24/9/18 5:04 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 31 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:31

              PEX Pipe

              P     EX (cross‑linked polyethylene) pipe is flexible
                    plastic tubing invented in Germany in 1968. It
              quickly became the home water‑supply plumbing
                                                                          for closed‑loop hydronic systems, such as radiant
                                                                          floor heating and ice‑dam melting setups.
                                                                               PEX‑A is the highest quality PEX pipe and the
              of choice across Europe. In America, because of             most flexible. It is most often used with expansion
              concerns about durability and potential pipe failures,      fittings. PEX‑B is the best value, because it is cheaper
              PEX use was limited to radiant heating tubing from          than copper or PEX‑A. It is most often used with
              the 1980s onward. However, the use of PEX pipes in          crimp‑style connecters. Both A and B are extremely
              American home water supply systems has exploded             durable and should last as long as copper piping if not
              over the last fifteen years.                                damaged or exposed to excessive UV light or chlorine.
                   The growing popularity of PEX is due to the fact       A sign of the longevity of the material is that PEX
              that early concerns about reliability of the material       manufacturers regularly warranty their products for
              were misplaced and the fact that PEX is much                fifteen years or longer.
              cheaper than copper, with many advantages over that              PEX can be used in conjunction with other
              traditional material. It is about the same price per        materials, including CPVC and copper. The tubing
              lineal foot as CPVC, but easier to use because there        is sold in most home improvement centers in coils
              is no glue involved in the connections. Although PEX        or lengths (sometimes called “sticks”) in diameters
              use was limited to professionals in the early years,        that include ½, ¾, and 1 inch. You’ll also find a wide
              tools, materials, and especially connection methods         selection of fittings and connection tools and materials.
              have advanced to the point that PEX is a completely
              realistic option for the home DIYer.                        NOTE: DO NOT combine PEX-A and PEX-B in
                   This type of pipe is flexible, making it possible to   the same project. Use tubing and fittings and
              install it in very long, uninterrupted runs. The pipe       connectors from the same manufacturer, as
              can also be routed wherever it needs to go with fewer       competing products are not normally compatible.
              fittings, such as elbows. This can translate to a more
              stable water pressure and decrease possibility of
              leaks. PEX’s flexibility can completely eliminate water         TOOLS & MATERIALS
              hammer and pipe nose. The plastic also has a degree
              of elasticity, which means it is less likely than copper      Tape measure
              to rupture or split if frozen.                                Non-permanent marker
                   PEX comes in three colors: white, red, and blue.
              There is no physical difference between the three,            Connection tool
              but plumbing cold lines with blue and red lines for           Tubing cutter
              hot water allows you to tell at a glance what type of         PEX pipe
              service any line is carrying.                                 Manifolds
                   There are three common types of PEX: A, B, and
              C. PEX‑C is not used for home plumbing (it’s limited          Safety plates (as needed)
              to radiant heat or other hot‑water, non‑potable               PEX fittings
              applications). You also may come across “oxygen”              Utility knife
              barrier PEX and PEX‑AL‑PEX, two types that are not            Plastic manifold hangers
              normally used for home water supply; they are meant

     32       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 32 24/9/18 5:04 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 32 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:32

       PEX Materials

       PEX pipe is manufactured in red, white, and blue. The intention    PEX combines the flexibility of plastic tubing with the
       is to use red for hot water lines and blue for cold water.         durability of rigid supply pipe. It is sold in coils of common
       However, the color does not affect price, and you may decide       supply-pipe diameters.
       to use one color for the entire project.

                     A                          B                     C

                                                                               ¼"           ½"               ¾"                  1"

       PEX is connected to other water supply materials                   Generally, you should use the same diameter PEX as is
       with transition fittings, including CPVC-to-PEX (A),               specified for rigid supply tubing, but in some “home run”
       copper-to-PEX (B), and iron-to-PEX (C).                            installations (see next page) you can use 3⁄8" PEX where ½"
                                                                          rigid copper would normally be used.

                                                                                          PLUMBING TOOLS, MATERIALS & SKILLS                     33

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 33 24/9/18 5:04 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 33 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:33

              System Designs

              Trunk-and-branch systems are configured in much the same           Home run systems rely on one or two central manifolds to
              way as traditional rigid copper or PVC supply systems. A main      distribute the hot and cold water very efficiently. Eliminating
              supply line (the trunk line) carries water to all of the outlets   the branch fittings allows you to use thinner supply pipe in
              via smaller branch lines that tie into the trunk and serve a few   some situations.
              outlets in a common location.

                                                                                                               CHOOSING A
                                                                                                               PEX SYSTEM
                                                                                                           •   For maximum single-fixture
                                                                                                               water pressure:
                                                                                                               Trunk-and-branch

                                                                                                           •   For economy of materials:
                                                                                                               Trunk-and-branch or
                                                                                                               remote manifold

                                                                                                           •   For minimal wait times for
                                                                                                               hot water (single fixture):
                                                                                                               Home run

                                                                                                           •   For minimal wait times for
                                                                                                               hot water (multiple fixtures
                                                                                                               used at same approximate
                                                                                                               time): Trunk-and-branch or
                                                                                                               remote manifold

                                                                                                           •   For ease of shutoff control:
                                                                                                               Home run
              Remote manifold systems are a hybrid between traditional trunk-and-branch systems
              and home run systems. Instead of relying on just one or two manifolds, they employ           •   For lowest number of fittings
              several smaller manifolds downline from a larger manifold. Each smaller manifold                 and joints: Home run
              services a group of fixtures, as in a bathroom or kitchen.

     34       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 34 24/9/18 5:04 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 34 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:34

       PEX Installation
       Check with your local plumbing inspector to verify                      (either flexible water‑heater connector tubing or
       that PEX is allowed in your municipality. PEX has been                  rigid copper) at least 18" long; then join it to PEX
       endorsed by all major plumbing codes in North America,                  with a transition fitting.
       but your municipality may still be using an older set of
       codes. Follow the guidelines below when installing PEX:              • Do not install PEX in areas where there is a
                                                                              possibility of mechanical damage or puncture.
       • Do not install PEX in aboveground exterior                           Always fasten protective plates to wall studs that
         applications, because it degrades quickly from                       house PEX.
         UV exposure.
                                                                            • Always leave some slack in installed PEX lines to
       • Do not use PEX for gas lines.                                        allow for contraction and in case you need to cut
                                                                              off a bad crimp.
       • Do not use plastic solvents or petroleum‑based
         products with PEX (they can dissolve the plastic).                 • Use the same minimum branch and distribution
                                                                              supply‑pipe dimensions for PEX that you’d use
       • Keep PEX at least 12" away from recessed                             for copper or CPVC, according to your local
         light fixtures and other potential sources of high heat.             plumbing codes.

       • Do not attach PEX directly to a water heater. Make                 • You can use push fittings to join PEX to itself or to
         connections at the heater with metallic tubing                       CPVC or copper. See page 30.

                                                                                  GENERAL CODES FOR PEX
       Do not connect                                                         PEX has been endorsed for residential use by all
       PEX directly to a
                                                                              major building codes, although some municipal
       water heater. Use
       metal connector                                                        codes may be more restrictive. The specific design
       tubes. Solder                                                          standards may also vary, but here are some
       the connector
       tubes to the water                                                     general rules:
       heater before
       attaching PEX.                                                         •   For PEX, maximum horizontal support spacing
       Never solder                                                               is 32" and maximum vertical support spacing
       metal tubing
                                                                                  is 10'.
       that is already
       connected to                                                   18"
                                                                              •   Maximum length of individual distribution lines
       PEX lines.
                                                                                  is 60'.

                                                                              •   PEX is designed to withstand 210°F water for
                                                                                  up to 48 hours. For ongoing use, most PEX is
                                                                                  rated for 180 degree water up to 100 pounds per
                                                                                  square inch of pressure.

                                                                              •   Directional changes of more than 90 degrees
                                                                                  require a guide fitting.

                                                                              •   A mid-story guide is required for most PEX
                                                                                  installations in walls. The guide should prevent
                                                                                  movement perpendicular to the pipe direction.

                                                                                            PLUMBING TOOLS, MATERIALS & SKILLS                    35

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 35 24/9/18 5:05 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 35 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:35

              Connectors for PEX systems
              are not interchangeable and
              all require specific crimping
              or connecting tools. The most
              common types you’ll find in
              building centers today are:
              (A) pinching tool with jaws that
              snag a tab on a stainless-steel
              ring, drawing the ring tight
              when the tool is squeezed;
              (B) stainless-steel sleeve
              crimping tool that is similar
              to the full-circle crimping tool
              (right) but uses stainless-
              steel sleeves with flared ends;
              (C) expansion connectors with
              conical tips that fit into the
              PEX and a nylon union ring,                             A
              then temporarily expand it as a                                                                                     C
              barbed fitting is inserted, then
              squeezed tight as the memory
              in the PEX causes it to shrink
                                                                                           B
              back to a nonexpanded state.

                                                                                                          A full-circle crimping tool (A)
                                                                                                          compresses a crimping ring
                                                                                                          (usually copper) onto the PEX
                                                                                                          union to seal the joint. It was
                                                                                                          the original system used by
                                                                                                          most professionals before the
                       C
                                                                                                          PEX options expanded into
                                                                                                          more DIY-friendly systems.
                                                                                                          Crimping tools and rings are
                                                                                                          still used widely and are very
                                                                                                          reliable. With any PEX system
                                                                                                          you’ll need a tubing cutter
                                                                                                          (B) for clean, square cuts,
                                                                                                          and a go/no-go gauge (C)
                                                                                    A                     to test connectors to make
                                                                                                          sure they are fitted properly
                                                                                                          after installation.

                                                                B

              Choosing PEX Pipe and Connectors
              Deciding on a connection method for your PEX                crimp fittings will work with any PEX pipe. The types
              pipes can seem confusing as first, given that some          most commonly used in home plumbing are crimp
              connectors can only work with certain types of PEX.         fittings and expansion fittings. Both are extremely
              There are four possible connection types: push-to-          reliable, but expansion fittings take a bit more practice
              connect fittings (see page 30) will work with any PEX       and expertise. They are also marginally more expensive,
              pipe, compression fittings work only with PEX-AL-PEX,       but the fittings themselves feature a larger internal
              expansion connectors work only with PEX-A, and              diameter, which translates to improved water flow.

     36       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 36 24/9/18 5:05 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 36 23/10/18 11:57 AM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:36

                  How to Make PEX Full-Circle Crimp Connections

                                                                            1               2

       Cut the pipe to length, making sure to leave enough extra                        Inspect the cut end to make sure it is clean and smooth.
       material so the line will have a small amount of slack once the                  If necessary, deburr the end of the pipe with a sharp utility
       connections are made. A straight, clean cut is very important.                   knife. Slip a crimp ring over the end.
       For best results, use a tubing cutter.

            3                                                         4                                            5

       Insert the barbed end of the fitting into                Fit the crimping tool with the appropriate     Test the connection to make sure it is
       the pipe until it is snug against the cut                head for the size pipe and fitting you’re      mechanically acceptable using a go/
       edges. Position the crimp ring so it is 1⁄8"             crimping. Align the jaws of the tool over      no-go gauge. If the ring does not fit into
       to ¼" from the end of the pipe, covering                 the crimp ring (the ring should be exactly     the gauge properly, cut the pipe near
       the barbed end of the fitting. Pinch the                 perpendicular to the pipe) and squeeze         the connection and try again.
       fitting to hold it in place.                             the handles to apply strong, even
                                                                pressure to the ring until you hear a click.

                                                                                                        PLUMBING TOOLS, MATERIALS & SKILLS                     37

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 37 24/9/18 5:05 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 37 2/10/18 10:35 AM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:37

                          How to Make Stainless-Steel Sleeve PEX Connections

                                                                                                                        3

                                                          1                                              2
              Mark and cut the PEX tubing (either type                Slip a stainless-steel sleeve onto the        Insert the fitting or union into the open
              A or type B), then cut it to length using               cut end of the PEX so it is firmly seated     end of the PEX to the required depth.
              a tubing cutter. Hold the PEX firmly                    with the flared grommet-style end flush       Check to make sure the part is properly
              against the registration ridges in the tool             against the end of the PEX.                   seated and square to the tubing.
              jaws to ensure a square cut, and then
              squeeze firmly until the blade slices
              through cleanly.

                                                                                                                    Wrap the jaws of the connector tool
                                                                                                                    around the sleeve, making sure you are
                                                                                                         4          using the jaw opening of the correct
                                                                                                                    diameter (either ½" or ¾"). Squeeze
                                                                                                                    the tool handles together with even
                                                                                                                    pressure, keeping the sleeve centered
                                                                                                                    in the hole of the tool jaws. Squeeze
                                                                                                                    until the tool handles are as close
                                                                                                                    together as the tool will allow.

              Test the sleeve with the go/no-go gauge
              provided with the connector tool to
              make sure it is fastened securely.                          5

     38       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 38 24/9/18 5:05 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 38 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:38

                  How to Make PEX Pinch Connections

            1

                                                                              2
       Press the release button on the pinch connector tool handle        Slip a pinch ring over the cut end of the PEX. Grasp the tab
       to unlock the tool, and test to make sure the ratcheting action    “knuckle” on the pinch ring in the ends of the tool jaws.
       occurs when you squeeze the handles together.                      Partially tighten the ring to keep it from sliding, but do not
                                                                          fully tighten.

                                                                      3
       Insert the fitting or union into the PEX opening so it is fully
       seated. Adjust the pinch ring so it is parallel to the cut end
       of the PEX and 1⁄8" back from the tube end. With the pinch            OPTION: If you are not satisfied with the connection or
       ring knuckle in the tool jaws, squeeze several times to further       need to undo it for any reason, slip the pinch ring knuckle
       tighten the ring—four to six squeezes total is typical. On some       into the slot in the end of the pinch ring removal tool. Hold
       tool models, an on-board alert light will glow when you have          the PEX joint securely and twist the removal tool back and
       achieved the right amount of torque. Release the pinch ring           forth until the ring snaps and can be removed easily.
       from the tool.

                                                                                          PLUMBING TOOLS, MATERIALS & SKILLS                     39

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 39 24/9/18 5:05 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 39 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:39

                          How to Make PEX Expansion Connections

                                                                         1          2

              Fit the expansion connector tool with the head that               Slide the expansion ring onto the end of the PEX pipe (PEX-A
              corresponds to the diameter of the fitting and PEX pipe.          only) until you reach the stop at the end of the ring. The ring
              Lightly grease the head.                                          should be flush against the cut end of the tubing.

                                                                         3          4

              Insert the expansion tool head into the end of the PEX pipe and   When the pipe and expansion sleeve are fully expanded,
              begin opening and closing the expansions jaws. Push the PEX       quickly remove the expansion tool head and slip the fitting
              pipe onto the head as it widens until the edge of the PEX pipe    into the end of the pipe. Allow the pipe to return to its original
              is flush against the base of the expansion head.                  shape, firmly grabbing the fitting’s barbed end, before using.

     40       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 40 24/9/18 5:05 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 40 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:40

       Tips for Working with PEX

       PEX tubing hangers can be attached to framing members to         Install a 2 × 4 brace between wall framing or floor or ceiling
       guide and support the semi-flexible tubing.                      joists to support in-line fittings, such as this two-port manifold.

       Attach plastic corner guides if you are making a 90° turn with   Use a hole-saw slightly larger in diameter than the PEX to drill
       the tubing. The guides smooth out the curve, help prevent the    access holes in framing for making tubing runs. Holes or
       PEX from kinking, and keep it contained too.                     pairs of holes should be at least 1" from the edges of framing
                                                                        members and at least 1" apart.

                                                                                               Attach nail protector plates to the
                                                                                               edges of any framing members the
                                                                                               PEX passes through. To keep them
                                                                                               manageable, use plastic ties to secure
                                                                                               parallel tubes together.

                                                                                               TIP: Leave some slack in the PEX lines
                                                                                               so they can expand or contract slightly
                                                                                               without stressing the connections.

                                                                                        PLUMBING TOOLS, MATERIALS & SKILLS                     41

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 41 24/9/18 5:05 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 41 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:41

              Rigid Plastic Pipe

              C    ut rigid ABS, PVC, or CPVC plastic pipes with a tubing
                   cutter or with any saw. Cuts must be straight to ensure
              watertight joints.
                  Rigid plastics are joined with plastic fittings and solvent
              cement. Use a solvent cement that is made for the type
              of plastic pipe you are installing. For example, do not use
              ABS solvent on PVC pipe. Some solvent cements, called
              “all‑purpose” or “universal” solvents, may not comply with
              local plumbing codes.
                  Solvent cement hardens in about 30 seconds, so test‑fit
              all plastic pipes and fittings before cementing the first joint.
              For best results, the surfaces of plastic pipes and fittings
              should be dulled with emery cloth and liquid primer before
              they are joined. However, there are several new self‑priming
              cements on the market that eliminate the need for a
              separate primer. These save time, effort, and expense.
                  Liquid solvent cements and primers are toxic and
                                                                                        Solvent welding is a chemical bonding process used
              flammable. Provide adequate ventilation when fitting                      to permanently join PVC pipes and fittings. The primer
              plastics, and store the products away from any source                     is always purple but may not be needed if you use a
              of heat.                                                                  self-priming cement.

                     TOOLS & MATERIALS
                  Tape measure                             Utility knife         Fittings                        Rag
                  Felt-tipped pen                          Channel-type pliers   Emery cloth                     Petroleum jelly
                  Tubing cutter (or miter box              Gloves                Plastic pipe primer             Eye & ear protection
                     or hacksaw)                           Plastic pipe          Solvent cement                  Work gloves

                                                                                        Primer and solvent cement are specific to the plumbing
                                                                                        material being used. Avoid using all-purpose or
                                                                                        multi-purpose products. Light to medium body cements
                                                                                        are appropriate for DIYers as they allow the longest
                                                                                        working time and are easiest to use. When working with
                                                                                        large pipe, 3 or 4" in diameter, buy a large-size can
                                                                                        of cement, which has a larger dauber. If you use the
                                                                                        small dauber (which comes with the small can), you
                                                                                        may need to apply twice, which will slow you down and
                                                                                        make connections difficult. (The smaller can of primer
                                                                                        is fine for any other size pipe, since there’s no rush in
                                                                                        applying primer.) Cement (though not primer) goes bad
                                                                                        in the can within a month or two after opening, so you
                                                                                        may need to buy a new can for a new project.

     42       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 42 24/9/18 5:05 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 42 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:42

                  How to Cut Rigid Plastic Pipe

                                              Sanitary tee cut away to show depth of pipe

                                                                                        Elbow cut away to show depth of pipe

                                                      Fitting socket

                                                                                                          Fitting socket

                                                                                Length of pipe

       Find the length of plastic pipe needed by measuring between the bottoms of the fitting sockets (fittings shown in cutaway). Mark
       the length on the pipe with a felt-tipped pen.

                                                                The best cutting tool for PVC and some
                                                                other plastic pipe is a power miter saw
                                                                with a fine tooth woodworking blade.

       Plastic tubing cutters do a fast, neat job
       of cutting. They are not interchangeable                                                              A ratcheting plastic-pipe cutter can cut
       with metal tubing cutters and don’t                                                                   smaller diameter PVC and CPVC pipe
       work on larger-diameter pipe.                                                                         in a hurry.

                                                                                                     PLUMBING TOOLS, MATERIALS & SKILLS                      43

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 43 24/9/18 5:05 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 43 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:43

                          How to Cement PVC Pipe

                    1

                                                                                                                            Fitting sockets

                                                                                     2
              Remove rough burrs on cut ends of plastic pipe using a utility     Test-fit all pipes and fittings. Pipes should fit tightly against
              knife or deburring tool (inset).                                   the bottom of the fitting sockets.

                                                                                     4

                                                                        3
              Mark the depth of the fitting sockets on the pipes. Take pipes     Apply a light coat of plastic pipe primer to the ends of the
              as well as key marks where needed to maintain positioning of       pipes and to the insides of the fitting sockets. Primer dulls
              pipe and fittings apart. Clean the ends of the pipes and fitting   glossy surfaces and ensures a good seal. (Skip this step if
              sockets with emery cloth.                                          using a self-priming cement.)

     44       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 44 24/9/18 5:05 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 44 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:44

            5                                                                 6

       Solvent-cement each joint by applying a thick coat of              Quickly position the pipe and fitting so that the alignment
       solvent cement to the end of the pipe. Apply a thin coat           marks are offset by about 2". Force the pipe into the fitting
       of solvent cement to the inside surface of the fitting socket.     until the end fits flush against the bottom of the socket.
       Work quickly: solvent cement hardens in about 30 seconds.

            7                                                                 8

       Spread solvent by twisting the pipe until the marks are aligned.   Wipe away excess solvent cement with a rag. Do not disturb
       Hold the pipe in place for about 20 seconds to prevent the         the joint for 30 minutes after gluing.
       joint from slipping.

                                                                                          PLUMBING TOOLS, MATERIALS & SKILLS                     45

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 45 24/9/18 5:05 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 45 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:45

              Working with Outdoor Flexible Plastic Pipe

              F   lexible PE (polyethylene) pipe is used for
                  underground cold water lines. Very inexpensive,
              PE pipe is commonly used for automatic lawn
              sprinkler systems and for extending cold water supply
              to utility sinks in detached garages and sheds.
                  Unlike other plastics, PE is not solvent‑cemented
              but is joined using “barbed” rigid PVC fittings and
              stainless‑steel hose clamps. In cold climates, outdoor
              plumbing lines should be shut off and drained
              for winter.

                     TOOLS & MATERIALS
                  Tape measure                           Flexible pipe
                  Tubing cutter                          Fittings
                  Screwdriver or wrench                  Hose clamps
                  Pipe joint compound                    Utility knife          Connect lengths of PE pipe with a barbed PVC fitting. Secure
                                                                                the connection with stainless steel hose clamps.

                                                                               Barbed PVC male-threaded adapter

                                                                         Female-threaded adapter

                           Tee fitting

                                                                                                            Hose clamp
                                                                                     Valve drain
                                                                                                                                 PE pipe

              Connect PE pipe to an existing cold water supply pipe by splicing in a tee fitting to the copper pipe and attaching a
              drain-and-waste shutoff valve and a female-threaded adapter. Screw a barbed PVC male-threaded adapter into the copper fitting,
              then attach the PE pipe. The drain-and-waste valve allows you to blow the PE line free of water when winterizing the system.

     46       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 46 24/9/18 5:05 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 46 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:46

                  How to Cut & Join Outdoor Flexible Plastic Pipe
                                                                      Fit stainless-steel hose clamps over the ends of the flexible
                                                                      pipes being joined.

                                                                          2

            1
       Cut flexible PE pipe with a plastic tubing cutter, or use a
       miter box or sharp knife. Remove any rough burrs with a
       utility knife.

                                                                      Slide the band clamps over the joint ends. Hand tighten each
                                                                      clamp with a screwdriver or wrench.

                                                                          3

       OPTION: To ensure a tighter fit, dab some pipe joint
       compound onto the barbs so they are easier to slide into
       the flexible plastic pipe. Apply pipe joint compound to the
       barbed ends of the tee fitting. Work each end of PE pipe
       over the barbed portions of the fitting and into position.

                                                                                      PLUMBING TOOLS, MATERIALS & SKILLS                     47

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 47 24/9/18 5:05 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 47 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:47

              Pipe Fittings
                                                                         Vent elbow                                                   Vent T (must
                                                                                                                                    connect to waste-

              U
                                                                                                                                     vent stack at a
                    se the photos on these pages to                                                                                   point at least
                    identify the plumbing fittings                                                                                    6" above the
              specified in the project how‑to                                                                                        highest fixture)
              directions found in this book. Each
              fitting shown is available in a variety                                                   Vent pipes

              of sizes to match your needs. Always
              use fittings made from the same
              material as your pipes.
                   Pipe fittings come in a variety of
              shapes to serve different functions                                                      Sanitary tee
              within the plumbing system.
              DWV fittings include:
                   Vents: In general, the fittings used
                                                                           P-trap
              to connect vent pipes have very sharp
              bends with no sweep. Vent fittings
              include the vent tee and vent 90‑degree
              elbow. Standard drain pipe fittings can                                                                               Closet
                                                                                                       Drain pipes
              also be used to join vent pipes.                                                                                      bend
                   Horizontal‑to‑vertical drains:
              To change directions in a drain pipe                                                                                  Low-heel vent 90°
                                                                         Cleanout
              from the horizontal to the vertical,
              use fittings with a noticeable sweep.
              Standard fittings for this use include
                                                                                       Wye fitting       Wye fitting
              waste tee fittings and 90‑degree                                          with 45°          with 45°
              elbows. Wye fittings and 45‑degree                                         elbow             elbow
              and 22½‑degree elbows can also be                                         (combo)

              used for this purpose.
                   Vertical‑to‑horizontal drains: To                                                                                Main waste stack
              change directions from the vertical to
              the horizontal, use fittings with a very                                                Cleanout
              pronounced, gradual sweep. Common
              fittings for this purpose include the
              long‑radius wye tee fitting and some
              wye fittings with 45‑degree elbows.                                                    Wye fitting
                   Horizontal offsets in drains: Wye
              fittings, 45‑degree elbows, 22½‑degree
              elbows, and long sweep 90‑degree
              elbows are used when changing                           This basic DWV tree shows the correct orientation of drain and vent fittings in a
                                                                      plumbing system. Bends in the vent pipes can be very sharp, but drain pipes
              directions in horizontal pipe runs.
                                                                      should use fittings with a noticeable sweep. Fittings used to direct falling waste
              Whenever possible, horizontal drain                     water from a vertical to a horizontal pipe should have bends that are even more
              pipes should use gradual, sweeping                      sweeping. Your local plumbing code may require that you install cleanout fittings
              bends rather than sharp turns.                          where vertical drain pipes meet horizontal runs.

     48       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 48 24/9/18 5:05 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 48 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:48

                    A              B                C            D            E   F               G                 H           I           J

                    A          B               C            D             E       F               G                     H           I           J

                K                          L                              M               N                O                P           Q

       Water supply fittings are available for copper (top), CPVC plastic (center), and PEX (bottom). Fittings for CPVC and copper are
       available in many shapes, including: unions (A), reducers (B), 90º elbows (C), reducing elbows (D), 45º elbows (E), tee fittings
       (F), reducing tee fittings (G), drop-ear elbows (H), threaded adapters (I), and caps (J). Common PEX fittings (bottom) include
       unions (K), PEX-to-copper unions (L), 90º elbows (M), tee fittings (N), plugs (O), drop-ear elbows (P), and threaded adapters
       (Q). Easy-to-install push fittings are also available.

                                                                                                                                            C

                                   A                                                          A
                                                                                                                            B

                                                                      B
                                                                                                                                                E

                                       C

                                                                                                                        D                           F

                                                                      D               G

                                                                                      H

                        E                                                 F

                                                                                      I

       Water supply valves are available in brass or plastic and in a             Support materials for pipes include: plastic pipe hangers (A),
       variety of styles, including: drain-and-waste valves (A), gate             copper J-hooks (B), copper wire hangers (C), riser clamp
       valve (B), full-bore ball valves (C), fixture shutoff valve (D),           (D), plastic pipe straps (E), copper pipe straps (F), flexible
       vacuum breaker (E), and hose bib (F).                                      copper, steel, and plastic pipe strapping (G, H, I). Do not
                                                                                  mix metal types when supporting metal pipes; use copper
                                                                                  support materials for copper pipe and steel for steel and
                                                                                  cast-iron pipes.

                                                                                                      PLUMBING TOOLS, MATERIALS & SKILLS                 49

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 49 24/9/18 5:05 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 49 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:49

                Tee Fittings                                               Sanitary tee
                                                                                          Elbows

                    Low-heel sanitary tee

                                                                                                                                       Vent elbow

                                                                                                                    90° elbow
                                                                                            Long
                                                                                           sweep
                                                                                          90° elbow

                                                                      Vent tee

                                                                                                                                         Closet bend
                                                                                                                4 × 3 hub
                    Sanitary tee                                                          Street elbow         closet bend
                   with additional
                      side inlet
                                                                                                                                             45° elbow
                                                                                            22½° elbow

                                             Double sanitary tee

                Wye Fittings                                                              Specialty Fittings                      Cleanout plug
                                                                                                                     Cap

                   Wye with 45°                                                                    Test caps
                  elbow (combo)
                                                                                                                       P-trap
                                                                                                                      with slip
                                                      Wye with                                                        fittings
                                                    cleanout plug

                                                                                                         Banded                            P-trap with
                                                                                                         coupling                       solvent-cemented
                                                                                                                                             fittings
                                                                                                                    Reducer

                                 Reducing
                                 wye fitting
                                                   Wye fitting
                                                                                             Coupling

                                                                                                                                   Reducing bushing

              Fittings for DWV pipes are available in many configurations, with openings ranging from 1¼" to 4" in diameter. When planning
              your project, buy plentiful numbers of DWV and water supply fittings from a reputable retailer with a good return policy. It is
              much more efficient to return leftover materials after you complete your project than it is to interrupt your work each time you
              need to shop for a missing fitting.

     50       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 50 24/9/18 5:05 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 50 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:50

                  How to Use Transition Fittings
                                                                                                                                           3" no-hub
                                                                                                                                       neoprene coupling

                                                                      1½"-to-1¼"
                                                                        reducing
                                                                       transition

       Connect plastic to cast iron with banded                 Make transitions in DWV pipes with rubber couplings. The two products shown here
       couplings. Rubber sleeves cover ends                     can be used to connect pipes of different materials.
       of pipes and ensure a watertight joint.

          Dielectric union

                                                                                              Plastic pipe

                                                                                                                                            Hot water
                                                                                                                                         transition fitting
               Spacer

                                                                                                 Metal water
                                                  Soldered joint                                heater nipple                                Teflon tape

       Connect copper to galvanized steel with a dielectric union. A                      Connect metal hot water pipe to plastic with a hot water
       dielectric union is threaded onto iron pipe and is soldered                        transition fitting that prevents leaks caused by different
       to copper pipe. A dielectric union has a plastic spacer that                       expansion rates of materials. Metal pipe threads are
       prevents corrosion caused by an electrochemical reaction                           wrapped with Teflon tape. Plastic pipe is solvent-cemented
       between dissimilar metals.                                                         to fitting.

                                                                Connect any supply tube to a fixture
                                                                tailpiece with a coupling nut. The
                     Supply tube
                                                                coupling nut compresses the
                                                                bell-shaped end of the supply tube
                                                                against the fixture tailpiece.

                                                                      Fixture tailpiece

                                      Shutoff valve

                                                                                             Supply tube
                                 Water pipe

                                                                                                                 Specialty supply fittings can be used to
       Connect a water pipe to any fixture                                                  Coupling nut         supply portable water fixtures, such as
       supply tube using a shutoff valve.                                                                        icemakers and hot water dispensers.

                                                                                                             PLUMBING TOOLS, MATERIALS & SKILLS                  51

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 51 24/9/18 5:05 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 51 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:51

              Shutoff Valves

              W      orn‑out shutoff valves or supply tubes can cause
                     water to leak underneath a sink or other fixture.
              First, try tightening the fittings with an adjustable
                                                                                          TOOLS & MATERIALS
                                                                                       Hacksaw                         Felt-tipped pen
              wrench. If this does not fix the leak, replace the
              shutoff valves and supply tubes.                                         Tubing cutter                   Shutoff valves
                   Shutoff valves are available in several fitting types.              Adjustable wrench               Supply tubes
              For copper pipes, valves with compression‑type                           Tubing bender                   Pipe joint compound
              fittings are easiest to install. For plastic pipes, use
              grip‑type valves. For galvanized steel pipes, use valves
              with female threads.
                   Older plumbing systems often were installed
                                                                                          PB plastic
              without fixture shutoff valves. When repairing or
              replacing plumbing fixtures, you may want to install                                                          Braided steel
              shutoff valves if they are not already present.

                                                                  Chromed brass

                                                                      CPVC plastic

                                                                                                        Chromed copper

                                                                                                                                                Vinyl mesh

              Shutoff valves allow you to shut off the water to an individual        Supply tubes are used to connect water pipes to faucets,
              fixture so it can be repaired. They can be made from                   toilets, and other fixtures. They come in 12", 20", and
              durable chromed brass or lightweight plastic. Shutoff valves           30" lengths. PB plastic and chromed copper tubes are
              come in ½" and ¾" diameters to match common water                      inexpensive. Braided steel and vinyl mesh supply tubes are
              pipe sizes.                                                            easy to install.

     52       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 52 24/9/18 5:05 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 52 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:52

                         How to Install Shutoff Valves & Supply Tubes
                                                                       Slide a compression nut and a
                                                                       compression ring over the copper water
                                                                       pipe. Threads of the nut should face the
                                                                       end of the pipe.

                        Coupling
                          nut                                                2

                                                                             Compression ring                                Shutoff
                                                                                                                              valve

                                                                                                                            Compression
                                   Soldered                                                                                    ring
                                    joints

                                    Supply
                   1                 pipes
                                                                                                                                                       Compression
                                                                                                                              3                           nut
              Turn off water at the main shutoff valve.
              Remove old supply pipes. If pipes are
              soldered copper, cut them off just below                                                                    Apply pipe joint compound to
              the soldered joint using a hacksaw or                                                                       the threads of the shutoff valve
              tubing cutter. Make sure the cuts are                                                                       or compression nut. Screw the
                                                                                                Compression nut
              straight. Unscrew the coupling nuts and                                                                     compression nut onto the shutoff valve
              discard the old pipes.                                                                                      and tighten with an adjustable wrench.

                   4                                                                                Fixture
                                                                                                   tailpiece
                                                                                                                                                    Coupling
                                                                                                                                                      nut

                                                                                                                                             Sprayer
                                                                                                                                              tube
                                                                                       Sprayer
                                                                                                                           Compression
                                                                                        hose
                                                                                                                              nut
                                                                         Shutoff
                                                                          valve

mesh 5 6 Bend the chromed copper supply tube Position the supply tube between the Attach the bell-shaped end of the supply to reach from the tailpiece of the fixture tailpiece and the shutoff valve, tube to the fixture tailpiece with a fixture to the shutoff valve using a and mark the tube to length. Cut the coupling nut, then attach the other end tubing bender. Bend the tube slowly to supply tube with a tubing cutter. to the shutoff valve with a compression avoid kinking the metal. ring and nut. Tighten all fittings with an adjustable wrench.

                                                                                                                  PLUMBING TOOLS, MATERIALS & SKILLS                      53

   305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 53                                                                                               24/9/18 5:05 PM
   305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 53                                                                                               24/9/18 5:03 PM
                                                                                                               Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition
                                                       Text                                                                                                         Page:53

                                                                                                                                             Shutoff
                                                                                      Ball valve
                                                                                                                                              valve

                                                                                                   Globe valve                  Gate valve

              Valves & Hose Bibs
                                                                                                                                Hose bib

              V    alves make it possible to shut off water at any
                   point in the supply system. If a pipe breaks or a
              plumbing fixture begins to leak, you can shut off water
                                                                                    With the exception of chromed shutoff valves that are installed
                                                                                    at individual fixtures (see previous pages), valves and hose
              to the damaged area so that it can be repaired. A hose                bibs are heavy-duty fittings, usually with a brass body. They
              bib is a faucet with a threaded spout, often used to                  are installed in-line to regulate water flow. Gate valves and
              connect rubber utility or appliance hoses.                            globe valves are similar and are operated with a wheel-type
                  Valves and hose bibs leak when washers or                         handle that spins. Ball valves are operated with a handle
                                                                                    much like a gas pipe stopcock and are considered by pros to
              seals wear out. Replacement parts can be found
                                                                                    be the most reliable. Hose bibs are spigots with a threaded
              in the same universal washer kits used to repair                      end designed to accept a female hose coupling.
              compression faucets. Coat replacement washers with
              faucet grease to keep them soft and prevent cracking.
                  If you have the opportunity to replace a shutoff                       TOOLS & MATERIALS
              valve, install a ball valve, which has proved itself to be
              the most reliable type.                                                 Screwdriver                      Universal washer kit
                  Remember to turn off the water before                               Adjustable wrench                Faucet grease
              beginning work.

                          How to Fix a Leaky Hose Bib

                                                                                                                 Handle screw

                                                                                                                            Handle

                                                                                     Packing
                                                                                       nut
                                                                                                                  Packing
                                                                      Packing nut    Packing                      washer
                                                                                       ring

                                                                                     Spindle

                                                                                       Stem
                                                                                      washer
                    1                                                                                             Stem
                                                                                                                  screw
                                                                                                                                                 2
              Remove the handle screw and lift off the handle. Unscrew the          Unscrew the spindle from the valve body. Remove the stem
              packing nut with an adjustable wrench.                                screw, and replace the stem washer. Replace the packing
                                                                                    washer, and reassemble the valve.

     54       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 54 24/9/18 5:05 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 54 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:54

             COMMON TYPES OF VALVES

                                               Packing
                                                 nut                                                                                    Packing
                                                                       Packing                                                            nut
                                                                       washer
                                                                                                             Packing
                                                                                                             washer

                                                                                                                                        Spindle
                                                  Spindle

                                                                                    Curved
                                                                                   chamber                  Stem
                                                   Gate
                                                                                                           washer                       Stem
                                                                                                                                        screw

          Gate valves have a movable brass wedge, or “gate,” that                Globe valves have a curved chamber. Repair leaks around
          screws up and down to control water flow. Gate valves may              the handle by replacing the packing washer. If a valve
          develop leaks around the handle. Repair leaks by replacing             does not fully stop water flow when closed, replace the
          the packing washer or packing string found underneath                  stem washer.
          the packing nut.

                                                                                               Packing
                                                                                                 nut

                                                                      Packing
                                                                        nut

                                                                      O-ring       O-rings
                                                                                                                  Valve            Handle
                                                                      Packing
                                                                      washer
                                                                                                                             Aperture

                                                                      Spindle

                                          Packing
                                            ring
                                                                                                 Ball

                                                                       Stem
                                                                      washer

          Shutoff valves control water supply to one or more fixtures.           Ball valves contain a metal ball with an aperture (or
          A shutoff valve has a plastic spindle with a packing washer            controlled hole) in the center. The ball is controlled by a
          and a snap-on stem washer. Repair leaks around the                     handle. When the handle is turned, the hole is positioned
          handle by replacing the packing washer. If a valve does not            parallel to the valve (open) or perpendicular (closed).
          fully stop water flow when closed, replace the stem washer.
          Shutoff valves with multiple outlets are available to supply
          several fixtures from a single supply.

                                                                                                PLUMBING TOOLS, MATERIALS & SKILLS                      55

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 55 24/9/18 5:05 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 55 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:55

                                                                                                     Compression nut                       Compression ring

              Compression Fittings

              C     ompression fittings are used to make connections
                    that may need to be taken apart. Compression
              fittings are easy to disconnect and are often used to
              install supply tubes and fixture shutoff valves. Use
              compression fittings in places where it is unsafe or
              difficult to solder, such as in crawl spaces.                                                            Compression
                   Compression fittings are used most often with                             Compression nut              ring             Copper pipe
              flexible copper pipe. Flexible copper is soft enough to
                                                                                           This compression fitting (shown in cutaway) shows how a threaded
              allow the compression ring to seat snugly, creating a                        compression nut forms a seal by forcing the compression ring
              watertight seal. Compression fittings also may be used                       against the copper pipe. The compression ring is covered with
              to make connections with Type M rigid copper pipe.                           pipe joint compound before assembly to ensure a perfect seal.

                     TOOLS & MATERIALS
                  Felt-tipped pen                                     Adjustable wrenches                        Pipe joint compound or Teflon tape
                  Tubing cutter or hacksaw                            Brass compression fittings

                          How to Attach Supply Tubes to Fixture Shutoff Valves
                          with Compression Fittings
                                                                                              Compression
                                                                                                 nut

                                                                                              Compression
                                                                                                 ring

                   Flexible copper
                     supply tube

                    1                                                     2                                            3
              Bend flexible copper supply tube and                    Slide the compression nut and then the      Apply a small amount of pipe
              mark to length. Include ½" for the                      compression ring over the end of the        joint compound to the threads to
              portion that will fit inside valve. Cut                 pipe. The threads of the nut should face    lubricate them.
              the tube.                                               the valve.

     56       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 56 24/9/18 5:05 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 56 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:56

                                            Socket

                                                  4                                              5                                               6
       Insert the end of the pipe into the fitting              Slide the compression ring and nut          Tighten the compression nut with
       so it fits flush against the bottom of the               against the threads of the valve. Hand      adjustable wrenches. Do not
       fitting socket.                                          tighten the nut onto the valve.             overtighten. Turn on the water and
                                                                                                            watch for leaks. If the fitting leaks,
                                                                                                            tighten the nut gently.

                  How to Join Two Copper Pipes
                  with a Compression Union Fitting

                                                                                                 2                                               3
                                       Compression
                                          nut

                                       Compression
                                          ring

                                                Union

            1
       Slide compression nuts and rings over                    Apply a layer of pipe joint compound or     Hold the center of the union fitting with
       the ends of pipes. Place a threaded                      Teflon tape to the union’s threads, then    an adjustable wrench and use another
       union between the pipes.                                 screw compression nuts onto the union.      wrench to tighten each compression nut
                                                                                                            one complete turn. Turn on the water. If
                                                                                                            the fitting leaks, tighten the nuts gently.

                                                                                                     PLUMBING TOOLS, MATERIALS & SKILLS                     57

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 57 24/9/18 5:05 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_001-057.indd 57 24/9/18 5:03 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:57

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 58 24/9/18 5:18 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 58 24/9/18 5:17 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:58

                                                                      Installing
                                                                      Plumbing Lines

                                                                      I  nstalling new plumbing lines is not as difficult as
                                                                         most homeowners may believe. If you are building
                                                                      a new addition or will be working in brand-new stud
                                                                      walls, you can simplify the job immeasurably by
                                                                      planning ahead and designing your walls to hold the
                                                                      plumbing. The most important design consideration
                                                                      is that a wet wall (a wall containing drain and/or
                                                                      supply plumbing) should be built using 2 × 6 framing
                                                                      members, not 2 × 4. The extra width allows you to
                                                                      cut notches or access holes in the framing members
                                                                      without removing so much material that your walls
                                                                      fail to pass construction codes.
                                                                          In addition to wall thickness, the other chief
                                                                      consideration when planning a new plumbing line is
                                                                      where (and how) it will tie into your existing plumbing
                                                                      system. As a general rule you want to locate the tie-
                                                                      in points so they are as close as possible to existing
                                                                      drain and supply pipes. But you also need to factor in
                                                                      access—if you have an exposed drain pipe in the floor
                                                                      below, you’ll be glad you chose to tie into it rather
                                                                      than a pipe in a finished wall next door, even if it
                                                                      means the new lines are a bit longer.
                                                                          Installing new plumbing lines takes planning,
                                                                      preparation, and a permit. Involve your local
                                                                      plumbing inspector from the outset. He or she will
                                                                      have good suggestions and help steer you in a wise
                                                                      direction. Plus, they will need to visit your home at
                                                                      least once during the process to inspect and approve
                                                                      your work, so it is always a good idea to treat the
                                                                      inspector as a partner.

                                                                      In this chapter:
                                                                      • Installation Basics
                                                                      • Planning Plumbing Routes
                                                                      • Building a Wet Wall

                                                                                                INSTALLING PLUMBING LINES                  59

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 59 24/9/18 5:18 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 59 24/9/18 5:17 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:59

              Installation Basics

              A     major plumbing project is a complicated affair
                    that often requires demolition and carpentry
              skills. Bathroom or kitchen plumbing may be
                                                                              The how-to projects on the following pages
                                                                          demonstrate standard plumbing techniques but
                                                                          should not be used as a literal blueprint for your
              unusable for several days while completing the work,        own work. Pipe and fitting sizes, fixture layout, and
              so make sure you have a backup bathroom or kitchen          pipe routing will always vary according to individual
              space to use during this time.                              circumstances. When planning your project, carefully
                   To ensure that your project goes quickly, always       read all the information in the planning section.
              buy plenty of pipe and fittings—at least 25 percent         Before you begin work, create a detailed plumbing
              more than you think you need. Making several extra          plan to guide your work and help you obtain the
              trips to the building center is a nuisance and can add      required permits. Don’t depend on manufacturer
              many hours to your project. Always purchase from a          specs to plan the installations of fixtures and the
              reputable retailer that will allow you to return leftover   running of pipes; always check local codes. They may
              fittings for credit.                                        vary from the specs and are generally more stringent.

                                                                                                Use 2 × 6 studs to frame “wet walls”
                                                                                                when constructing a new bathroom
                                                                                                or kitchen. Thicker walls provide
                                                                                                more room to run drain pipes and
                                                                                                main waste‑vent stacks, making
                                                                                                installation much easier.

     60       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 60 24/9/18 5:18 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 60 24/9/18 5:17 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:60

       Installing New Plumbing
                                                                                 Use masking tape to mark the
                                                                                 locations of fixtures and pipes on
                                                                                 the walls and floors. Read the layout
                                                                                 specifications that come with each
                                                                                 sink, tub, or toilet, then mark the
                                                                                 drain and supply lines accordingly.
                                                                                 Position the fixtures on the floor, and
                                                                                 outline them with tape. Measure
                                                                                 and adjust until the arrangement is
                                                                                 comfortable to you and meets minimum
                                                                                 clearance specifications. If you are
                                                                                 working in a finished room, prevent
                                                                                 damage to wallpaper or paint by using
                                                                                 self‑adhesive notes to mark the walls.

                                                                                 Consider the location of cabinets when
                                                                                 roughing in the water supply and drain
                                                                                 stub‑outs. You may want to temporarily
                                                                                 position the cabinets in their final
                                                                                 locations before completing the drain
                                                                                 and water supply runs.

                                                                                 Install control valves at the points where
                                                                                 the new branch supply lines meet the
                                                                                 main distribution pipes. By installing
                                                                                 valves, you can continue to supply the
                                                                                 rest of the house with water while you
                                                                                 are working on the new branches.

                                                                                                                (continued)

                                                                                      INSTALLING PLUMBING LINES                  61

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 61 24/9/18 5:18 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 61 24/9/18 5:17 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:61

                     MAXIMUM HOLE & NOTCH CHART
                  FRAMING                                         MAXIMUM         MAXIMUM             The framing member chart shows the
                  MEMBER                                          HOLE SIZE       NOTCH SIZE          maximum sizes for holes and notches that
                                                                                                      can be cut into studs and joists when running
                  2 × 4 loadbearing stud                        17⁄16" diameter    7
                                                                                    ⁄8" deep
                                                                                                      pipes. Where possible, use notches rather
                  2 × 4 non‑loadbearing stud                    2 ⁄8" diameter
                                                                  1
                                                                                  1 ⁄16" deep
                                                                                    7
                                                                                                      than bored holes, because pipe installation is
                                                                                                      usually easier. When boring holes, there must
                  2 × 6 loadbearing stud                        21⁄4" diameter     13⁄8" deep
                                                                                                      be at least 5⁄8" of wood between the edge of
                  2 × 6 non‑loadbearing stud                    35⁄16" diameter   23⁄16" deep         a stud and the hole and at least 2" between
                                                                                                      the edge of a joist and the hole. Joists can
                  2 × 6 joists                                  17⁄8" diameter     7
                                                                                    ⁄8" deep
                                                                                                      be notched only in the end 1⁄3 of the overall
                  2 × 8 joists                                  2 ⁄8" diameter
                                                                  3
                                                                                   1 ⁄4" deep
                                                                                    1
                                                                                                      span; never in the middle 1⁄3 of the joist. When
                                                                                                      two pipes are run through a stud, the pipes
                  2 × 10 joists                                 31⁄16" diameter    11⁄2" deep
                                                                                                      should be stacked one over the other, never
                  2 × 12 joists                                 33⁄4" diameter     17⁄8" deep         side by side.

              Create access panels so that in the future you will be able               Protect pipes from punctures if they are less than 1¼" from the
              to service fixture fittings and shutoff valves located inside             front face of wall studs or joists by attaching metal protector
              the walls. Frame an opening between studs, then trim the                  plates to the framing members.
              opening with wood moldings. Cover the opening with a
              removable plywood panel the same thickness as the wall
              surface, then finish it to match the surrounding walls.

     62       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 62 24/9/18 5:18 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 62 24/9/18 5:17 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:62

       Test‑fit materials before solvent‑cementing or soldering joints.   Support pipes adequately. Horizontal and vertical runs of
       Test‑fitting ensures that you have the correct fittings and        DWV and water supply pipe must be supported at minimum
       enough pipe to do the job, and it can help you avoid lengthy       intervals, which are specified by your local plumbing codes.
       delays during installation.                                        A variety of metal and plastic materials are available for
                                                                          supporting plumbing pipes.

       Use plastic bushings to help hold plumbing pipes securely in       Install extra tee fittings on new drain and vent lines so that
       holes bored through wall plates, studs, and joists. Bushings       you can pressure‑test the system when the building inspector
       can help to cushion the pipes, preventing wear and reducing        reviews your installation. A new DWV line should have these
       rattling. Always use manufacturer‑recommended bushings             extra tee fittings near the points where the new branch drains
       with metal wall studs (inset).                                     and vent pipes reach the main waste‑vent stack.

                                                                                                     INSTALLING PLUMBING LINES                  63

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 63 24/9/18 5:18 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 63 24/9/18 5:17 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:63

              Planning
              Plumbing Routes

              T    he first, and perhaps most important, step when
                   replacing old plumbing is to decide how and where
              to run the new pipes. Since the stud cavities and joist
              spaces are often covered with finished wall surfaces,
              finding routes for running new pipes can be challenging.
                  When planning pipe routes, choose straight, easy
              pathways whenever possible. Rather than running
              water supply pipes around wall corners and through
              studs, for example, it may be easiest to run them
              straight up wall cavities from the basement. Instead
              of running a bathtub drain across floor joists, run it
              straight down into the basement, where the branch
              drain can be easily extended underneath the joists to
              the main waste-vent stack.
                  In some situations, it is most practical to route the
              new pipes in wall and floor cavities that already hold
              plumbing pipes, since these spaces are often framed
              to provide long, unobstructed runs. A detailed map
              of your plumbing system can be very helpful when
              planning routes for new plumbing pipes.
                  The most complicated part of new plumbing
              service is often the venting for the DWV system. All
              fixtures must be vented in a code-approved manner,
              and these codes are at times daunting to learn. Where
              possible, run vent lines through walls or up to the
              attic to tie into existing vents. If that is not allowed,
              you may need to run a vent pipe up through the roof.
              In some cases you can use air admittance valves
              instead of vent pipes.
                  To maximize their profits, plumbing contractors
              generally try to avoid opening walls or changing
              wall framing when installing new plumbing. But the
              do-it-yourselfer does not have these limitations. Faced
              with the difficulty of running pipes through enclosed       Build a framed chase. A chase is a false wall created to
              spaces, you may find it easiest to remove wall surfaces     provide space for new plumbing pipes. It is especially
              or to create a newly framed space for running new pipes.    effective for installing a new main drainage stack. On a
                                                                          two‑story house, chases can be stacked one over the other on
                  On these pages, you will see some common                each floor in order to run plumbing from the basement to the
              methods used to create pathways for replacing old           attic. Once plumbing is completed and inspected, the chase
              pipes with new plumbing.                                    is covered with wallboard and finished to match the room.

     64       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 64 24/9/18 5:18 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 64 24/9/18 5:17 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:64

       Planning Pipe Routes
       Use existing access panels to disconnect fixtures and remove
       old pipes. Plan the location of new fixtures and pipe runs to
       make use of existing access panels, minimizing the amount of
       demolition and repair work you will need to do.

                                                                        Convert a laundry chute into a channel for running new
                                                                        plumbing pipes. The door of the chute can be used to provide
                                                                        access to control valves, or it can be removed and covered with
                                                                        wall materials, then finished to match the surrounding wall.

       Run pipes inside a closet. If they are unobtrusive, pipes can
       be left exposed at the back of the closet. Or, you can frame a
       chase to hide the pipes after the installation is completed.

                                                                        Remove suspended ceiling panels to route new plumbing pipes
                                                                        in joist cavities. Or, you can route pipes across a standard plaster
                                                                        or wallboard ceiling, then construct a false ceiling to cover the
                                                                        installation, provided there is adequate height. Most building
                                                                        codes require a minimum of 7' from floor to finished ceiling.
                                                                                                                               (continued)

                                                                                                     INSTALLING PLUMBING LINES                 65

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 65 24/9/18 5:18 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 65 24/9/18 5:17 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:65

              Use a drill bit extension and spade bit or hole saw to drill       Look for “wet walls.” Walls that hold old plumbing pipes can
              through wall plates from unfinished attic or basement spaces       be good choices for running long vertical lengths of new pipe.
              above or below the wall.                                           These spaces are usually open, without obstacles such as
                                                                                 fireblocks and insulation.

              Probe wall and floor cavities with a long piece of plastic pipe to ensure that a clear pathway exists for running new pipe (left).
              Once you have established a route using the narrow pipe, you can use the pipe as a guide when running larger drain pipes up
              into the wall (right).

     66       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 66 24/9/18 5:18 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 66 24/9/18 5:17 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:66

       Remove flooring when necessary. Because replacing toilet
       and bathtub drains usually requires that you remove sections
       of floor, a full plumbing replacement job is often done in
       conjunction with a complete bathroom remodeling project.

                                                                      Remove wall surfaces when access from above or below the
                                                                      wall is not possible. This demolition work can range from
                                                                      cutting narrow channels in plaster or wallboard to removing
                                                                      the entire wall surface. Remove wall surfaces back to the
                                                                      centers of adjoining studs; the exposed studs provide a nailing
                                                                      surface for attaching repair materials once the plumbing
                                                                      project is completed.

       Create a detailed map showing the planned route for your new plumbing pipes. Such a map can help you get your plans
       approved by the inspector, and it makes work much simpler. If you have already mapped your existing plumbing system, those
       drawings can be used to plan new pipe routes.

                                                                                                 INSTALLING PLUMBING LINES                  67

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 67 24/9/18 5:18 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 67 24/9/18 5:17 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:67

              Sample Plumbing Layouts

                                                                                  1½" vent pipe

                                   2" vent pipe
                                                                                                                               1½" vent pipe

                                                                                                                 11⁄2" drain pipe

                                                               11⁄2" drain pipe

                                  3" main stack
                                                                                                                            2" vent pipe

                                                                                                                                    2" drain pipe
                  Master Bath

                                                                                                                                           Vent pipe

                                                                                                               Drain pipe
                                                         Main vent stack
                  Half Bath

     68       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 68 24/9/18 5:18 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 68 24/9/18 5:17 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:68

                                                                                         Cleanout

                                                                                                          Auxiliary waste‑vent stack
                         Island sink

                                                                                              Auxiliary waste‑vent stack

                                                                                           Drain pipe

                                                                                                                Vent pipe

           Kitchen

                                                                      Vent pipes

                                         Drain pipes

                                                                            Main stack
                                       Basement Bath

                                                                                                                    INSTALLING PLUMBING LINES                  69

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 69 24/9/18 5:18 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 69 24/9/18 5:17 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:69

              Tips for Installing New Plumbing Lines: Supply Lines

              Remove the subfloor completely in the installation area if you     Support supply risers with a ¾"‑thick backer board installed
              are running new supply lines inside the floor cavity. Among        between floor joists. Secure the horizontal supply tubes to
              other advantages, this allows you to dry‑fit the complete layout   the backer with pipe straps. Risers should extend at least 6"
              before soldering or solvent‑welding.                               above the finished floor.

              When soldering copper, tack a piece of metal flashing between      Use ¾"‑to‑½" reducing tees to tap into ¾" branch supply lines.
              wall studs behind the work area to serve as a heat shield.         Most plumbing fixtures require only a ½"‑dia. supply tube.

     70       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 70 24/9/18 5:18 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 70 24/9/18 5:17 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:70

       Use a tubing cutter to remove sections of branch                 Drill access holes directly into a cabinet base to allow supply
       supply lines.                                                    risers to enter the cabinet. The holes should align with access
                                                                        holes for the risers in the subfloor.

       Use a small level to make sure unattached riser pipes are        Dry‑fit copper or CPVC lines as much as possible. Dry‑fitting
       plumb when marking cutting lines on mating horizontal            yields more reliable results for the home DIYer than taking
       branch lines. If you’re using PEX, you only need a 90° bracket   measurements as you go. There is no need to dry‑fit PEX,
       attached to the joist face to run the PEX up to the fixture      because you should leave ample slack in the lines as you
       without a fitting.                                               work, which will accommodate any imprecise measurements.

                                                                                                    INSTALLING PLUMBING LINES                  71

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 71 24/9/18 5:18 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 71 24/9/18 5:17 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:71

              Tips for Installing New Plumbing Lines: Drain and Vent Lines

              Drain and vent lines may be located in exterior walls, but if      If installing a large whirlpool tub, cut away the subfloor to expose
              you live in a cold climate the walls must be well insulated with   the full length of the joists under the tub, then screw or bolt a
              ample insulation between the pipes and the exterior. Avoid         second joist, called a sister, against each existing joist. Make
              running supply lines in an exterior wall in cold climates.         sure both ends of each joist are supported by load‑bearing walls.

              Lay large sections of plywood across the joists to create a        Use levels to check your work when installing new lines. This is
              stable work surface when installing plumbing lines in an           especially important for meeting minimum slope requirements.
              open floor.                                                        It’s also good practice to ensure that visible lines stay parallel.

     72       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 72 24/9/18 5:18 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 72 24/9/18 5:17 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:72

              TIPS FOR INSTALLING NEW PLUMBING LINES: GAS SUPPLY PIPES
          Working with Gas Pipe                                                    Gas Consumption of Household Appliances
          Running gas supply lines and making gas hookups are                      APPLIANCE                     AVG. BTU’S                    GAS CONSUMPTION
          similar jobs to working with drain and supply plumbing.                                                PER HOUR                      PER HOUR*
          Given the extremely dangerous nature of handling natural
                                                                                   Clothes dryer                 35,000                        35 cu. ft.
          gas and propane, however, you should approach these
          jobs with extreme caution. In fact, many jurisdictions                   50‑gallon water heater        50,000                        50 cu. ft.
          do not allow homeowners to install gas pipe unless
                                                                                   Range/oven                    65,000                        65 cu. ft.
          they happen to be certified in that area of expertise.
          Making the hookup from supply lines to gas fixtures is                   Furnace                       200,000                       200 cu. ft.
          less regulated, but still dangerous. The availability of
                                                                                   *Based on output rate of 1,000 BTU per cubic foot of fuel per hour. Your actual rate will
          new flexible gas connectors has made the task simpler
                                                                                   likely differ. Check with your energy company.
          and eliminated some of the most troublesome aspects,
                                                                                   Determine the flow rate for a branch line by adding the
          including the use of flare fittings. If you choose to
                                                                                   gas consumption per hour (use above data only if specific
          attempt any projects with gas connections, be sure to                    information is not printed on your appliance label) of each
          pay attention to the materials you’ll use. Whether it is                 appliance. Although appliances may not run concurrently, it
          the copper supply tubes or the tape used to lubricate                    is advisable to select pipe size based on 100% flow rate. Note
          threaded connections, gas lines employ an entirely                       that distance traveled also plays an important role in selecting
          different set of gas‑rated pipes, fittings, and materials.               pipe size diameter (½", ¾", 1", 1¼", or 1½").

          Wrap the male pipe threads with                       Turn off the gas at the gas meter using                Disconnect the existing appliance. If
          gas‑rated Teflon tape before joining to               an adjustable wrench. The valve                        a flexible stainless‑steel connector
          fittings. Wind the tape clockwise (as you             does not have a stop, so it can rotate                 was used, discard it, as they can
          face the hole in the pipe), and wrap two              indefinitely. The gas is off when the bar              only be installed once. Remove the
          or three windings. Alternatively, apply               is perpendicular to the pipe.                          gas stub‑out or flexible copper line
          pipe joint compound to the threads.                                                                          back to the supply line.

          Attach a male‑threaded‑to‑flare                       Attach the appliance connector tube to                 Hook up the appliance by attaching
          adapter to the valve. Use two                         the valve. Make sure to buy a connector                the other flare nut to the threaded
          adjustable wrenches—one holding                       with ends that match the valve and                     gas inlet port on the appliance. Plug
          the valve in place and one                            the appliance port. In most cases, you                 in the appliance’s power cord. Turn
          tightening the fitting.                               may now use flexible stainless‑steel                   on gas at the main meter and at the
                                                                connectors instead of soft copper tubing               stop valve, and test the flare fittings
                                                                that requires flaring. But soft copper                 for leaks. Once you’re certain all the
                                                                is allowed if you have the equipment                   joints are good, carefully slide the
                                                                to make a flare fitting joint and want to              appliance into place.
                                                                save a few dollars.

                                                                                                                               INSTALLING PLUMBING LINES                       73

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 73 24/9/18 5:18 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 73 24/9/18 5:17 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:73

                                                                                      Install cleanouts at the ends of
                                                                                      branch drain lines to create access
                                                                                      points for augers in the event you
                                                                                      need to remove a clog.

              If a floor joist interferes with the toilet drain, cut away a
              short section of the joist and box‑frame the area with double
              headers. The framed opening should be just large enough to
              install the toilet and sink drains.

                     CONNECTING NEW VENT PIPES TO A MAIN STACK

                  In the attic, cut into the main waste‑vent stack and install a   Use elbows, vent tee fittings, reducers, and lengths of pipe
                  vent tee fitting using banded couplings. The side outlet on      as needed to link the new vent pipes to the test tee fitting
                  the vent tee should face the new 2" vent pipe running down       on the main waste‑vent stack. Vent pipes can be routed
                  to the bathroom. Attach a test tee fitting to the vent tee.      in many ways, but you should make sure the pipes have a
                                                                                   slight downward angle to prevent moisture from collecting
                  NOTE: If your stack is cast iron, make sure to adequately        in the pipes. Support the pipes every 4' or as required by
                  support it before cutting into it.                               local codes.

     74       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 74 24/9/18 5:18 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 74 24/9/18 5:17 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:74

       Tips for Installing New Plumbing Lines: Basement Bath

       Score cutting lines into the concrete surfaces of the                      Use a jackhammer to break up and remove the basement
       basement foundation floor before attempting to break out                   foundation floor in the installation area so you can run new
       the concrete with a jackhammer (recommended) or cold                       drain/sewer pipelines from the bathroom to the main drain.
       chisel and mallet. This helps prevent the migration of                     Wear a dust mask, hearing protection, and eye protection. It’s
       cracks outside of the work area and makes for an overall                   also a good idea to cordon off the work areas from the rest of
       neater job.                                                                your home with sheet plastic to keep dust from traveling.

                                                           Cleanout

                                                                      1" spacer

       Replace the entire sweep elbow where the drain stack joins                 After you’ve made all your new drain line connections, test the
       the sewer line. The union in the new sweep should have an                  line by dumping water down the risers to make sure there are no
       opening to accommodate the new drain line.                                 leaks. Then, cover the new drain lines with a course of drainage
                                                                                  rock followed by a layer of fresh concrete that’s at least 4" thick.

                                                                                                               INSTALLING PLUMBING LINES                 75

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 75 24/9/18 5:18 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 75 24/9/18 5:17 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:75

              Building a Wet Wall

              A    wet wall is simply a wall
                    that contains plumbing for
              water supply and drainage. To
              accommodate the drain and vent
              pipes, which range from 1½ to
              3 inches in diameter for branch
              lines, the wall framing needs to be
              built with 2 × 6 or larger dimensional
              lumber. You can also attach furring
              strips (usually 2 × 2) to existing 2 × 4
              framing members to increase wall
              thickness. The chart on the next page
              describes how deeply you are allowed
              to notch wall-framing members under
              various load conditions, as well as the
              maximum-diameter holes you may
              drill for running plumbing and wiring.
                  Building a new wet wall or
              converting an existing wall to house
              new plumbing requires a building
              permit and an onsite inspection once
              all of the hookups are made. Do not
              install any wall coverings until after
              your plumbing and wiring have been
              inspected and approved.

                     TOOLS & MATERIALS
                  Circular saw             Jigsaw
                  Wrecking bar             Basic
                     or pry bar               plumbing tools
                  Drill/driver             Reciprocating saw
                  Caulk gun                Protective plates
                  Adhesive                 Plumbing pipes
                  Hammer                      & hangers
                  8d finish or             Dust mask
                     casing nails          Eye & ear
                  Masking tape                protection
                  Hole saw                 Work gloves

     76       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 76 24/9/18 5:18 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 76 24/9/18 5:17 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:76

              SIZING FOR WATER‑DISTRIBUTION PIPES
          FIXTURE                   UNIT RATING                                                                   MAXIMUM LENGTH (FT.)—
                                                           SIZE OF                  SIZE OF                        TOTAL FIXTURE UNITS
                                                           SERVICE PIPE        DISTRIBUTION PIPE
          Bathtub                            2
                                                           FROM STREET        FROM WATER METER          40       60       80     100      150     200

          Clothes washer                     2
                                                           ⁄4"
                                                           3                         1
                                                                                      ⁄2"               9        8        7       6         5      4
          Dishwasher                         2
                                                           ⁄4"
                                                           3                         3
                                                                                      ⁄4"               27       23       19     17        14     11
          Kitchen sink                       2
                                                           ⁄4"
                                                           3
                                                                                      1"                44       40       36     33        28     23
          Shower                             2
                                                           1"                         1"                60       47       41     36        30     25
          Sillcock                           3
                                                           1"                        11⁄4"             102       87       76     67        52     44
          Toilet                             3

          Utility sink                       2

          Vanity sink                        1
          Water‑distribution pipes are the main pipes extending from the water meter throughout the house, supplying water to the
          branch pipes leading to individual fixtures. To determine the size of the distribution pipes, you must first calculate the total
          demand in “fixture units” (above, left) and the overall length of the water‑supply lines, from the street hookup through the
          water meter and to the most distant fixture in the house. Then, use the second table (above, right) to calculate the minimum
          size for the water‑distribution pipes.

              SIZING FOR BRANCH PIPES & SUPPLY TUBES
                                   MINIMUM                         MINIMUM
          FIXTURE                                                                                            PIPE SUPPORT INTERVALS
                                BRANCH‑PIPE SIZE                SUPPLY‑TUBE SIZE

          Bathtub                        1
                                          ⁄2"                         1
                                                                       ⁄2"               TYPE                VERTICAL‑RUN             HORIZONTAL‑RUN
                                                                                         OF                    SUPPORT                   SUPPORT
          Clothes washer                 1
                                          ⁄2"                         1
                                                                       ⁄2"               PIPE                  INTERVAL                  INTERVAL

          Dishwasher                     1
                                          ⁄2"                         1
                                                                       ⁄2"               Copper                   10'                       6'

          Kitchen sink                   1
                                          ⁄2"                         1
                                                                       ⁄2"               CPVC                     10'                       3'

          Shower                         1
                                          ⁄2"                         1
                                                                       ⁄2"               Iron                     15'                       5'

          Sillcock                       3
                                          ⁄4"                         NA                 PEX                      5'                        3'

          Toilet                         1
                                          ⁄2"                         3
                                                                       ⁄8"               PVC                      10'                       4'

          Utility sink                   1
                                          ⁄2"                         1
                                                                       ⁄2"               Steel                    12'                      10'

          Vanity sink                    1
                                          ⁄2"                         3
                                                                       ⁄8"

          Water heater                   3
                                          ⁄4"                         NA
          Branch pipes are the water‑supply lines that run from the                      Minimum intervals for supporting pipes are determined by the
          distribution pipes toward the individual fixtures. Supply                      type of pipe and its orientation in the system. Remember that
          tubes are the vinyl, chromed copper, or braided tubes that                     the measurements shown above are minimum requirements.
          carry water from the branch pipes to the fixtures.

                                                                                                                        INSTALLING PLUMBING LINES               77

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 77 24/9/18 5:18 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 77 24/9/18 5:17 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:77

                          How to Build & Plumb a Wet Wall
              Clear the work
              area. If you
              are remodeling                    1
              an existing
              wall to contain
              plumbing for a
              new bathroom,
              you’ll need
              to completely
              remove the wall
              coverings so you
              can fur out the
              wall studs. This
              project requires
              a building permit
              and at least one
              onsite inspection.
              Shut off power at
              the main service
              panel before
              cutting into walls.

                                                                                                        3
                   Begin removing wall coverings
                   on the entire wall. There are
                   many ways to go about this.
                   One is to set your circular
                   saw to a cutting depth equal
                   to the wall covering thickness
                   and make a few starter cuts.
                   Remove any cover plates on
                   the wall before you start.

                      2

                                                                                                                       4
                                                                      Next, use a wrecking bar to pry the          Remove old drywall screws or nails that
                                                                      wallcovering loose. Work in sections that    remain in the wall‑framing members.
                                                                      are large but manageable. Immediately
                                                                      discard the material you remove.

     78       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 78 24/9/18 5:19 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 78 24/9/18 5:17 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:78

                                                                                                                                        6

            5
       Cut 2 × 2 furring strips to length. Start with the sole plate of    Attach the furring strips to the wall‑framing members with 8d
       the wall. Apply a bead of construction adhesive to the 2 × 2.       finish or casing nails. Drive a nail every 12 to 16".

                                                                               8

            7
       Install the vertical furring strips next using nails and            If you are installing a drain for a tub or shower, mark out the
       construction adhesive. Finally, attach furring strips to the wall   location of the drain on the subfloor. Remove floor coverings
       cap plate. Reroute wiring in the wall according to your plan.       first. Mark a centerpoint for the drainage pipe onto the sole
       If you are keeping receptacles or switches in the same place,       plate. The pipe should align with the location for the drain trap.
       you’ll still need to move the boxes forward in the wall cavity so   If your plan calls for it, drill additional holes for fixture drains,
       the edges will be flush with the new wall surface.                  such as the wall sink stub‑out being installed in this wall.

                                                                                                                       Feed sections of
                                                                                                                       drain pipe up through
                                                                                                           10          the holes in the sole
                                                                                                                       plate and floor (if you
                                                                                                                       are tying in to the
                                                                                                                       plumbing on the floor
                                                                                                                       below—the easiest
                                                                                                                       way to tap into the
                                                                                                                       existing plumbing
                                                                                                                       system). Connect
                                                                                                                       the drain line to
                                                                                                                       a drainage stack,
                                                                                                                       maintaining a slope of
                                                                                                                       at least ¼" per 1'. It is
            9                                                                                                          always a good idea to
                                                                                                                       include a cleanout on
                                                                                                                       the new branch line.
       Drill holes for the drain pipes using a hole saw that’s slightly
       larger than the outside diameter of the new pipe. In most
       cases, a 2"‑diameter pipe is adequate for this type of branch
       drain, so a 2½" hole saw is a good choice.                                                                                  (continued)

                                                                                                         INSTALLING PLUMBING LINES                 79

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 79 24/9/18 5:19 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 79 24/9/18 5:17 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:79

                                                                                       12

                  11
              Cut notches in the wall‑framing members to hold the horizontal        Cut the horizontal lines to length and set them into the
              plumbing in the drain lines. See the chart on page 77. Cut no         notches. You can hold them in place with tape if they don’t
              deeper than needed to hold the pipes.                                 stay put.

                  13

                                                                                       14
              Attach a 90° elbow to the end of the new horizontal line so it        With the drain pipes seated in the fitting below the floor (but
              aligns with the drain pipe coming up through the floor. The           not cemented), mark the free ends of the vertical pipes for
              other end of horizontal pipe is fitted with a T‑fitting so the vent   cutting at the points where they will join the fittings on the
              line can be extended up through the cap plate and ceiling.            horizontal line. Dry‑fit this union. Do not cement yet.

                                                                                                                                              16

                  15
              Remove the subfloor in the section you’ve laid out for the            Reach into the hole in the subfloor and mark the vertical pipe
              drain. Cut with a jigsaw using a starter hole if you need to. If      for cutting to accept a T‑fitting. The tee should have a slight
              you’ve planned the drain location wisely it will not fall over a      sweep downward. Normally, the open end of the tee is sized
              floor joist.                                                          for a 1½"‑diameter drain tube to run from the vertical drain
                                                                                    line to the drain trap.

     80       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 80 24/9/18 5:19 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 80 24/9/18 5:17 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:80

                                                                                          18

           17
       Remove the drain pipes and cut them to the lengths                              Cement the reducing tee into the drain line for the tub, making
       you’ve marked.                                                                  sure to orient the sweep correctly and to align the opening
                                                                                       with the drain‑trap location.

                                                      Cement a reducing tee
                                                      into the drain line for
                                                      the sink stub‑out.

                                                                                          20
                                                                                       Cement the drain lines into the drain fittings from below.
                                                                                       Solvent‑cement the branch drain line components on the floor
           19                                                                          below, tying the line into the main drain stack or another large
                                                                                       branch drain.

                                                                Install cold and hot water‑supply lines,
                                                                connecting from the floor below.
                                                                                                                 23
                                                                                                  22

             21                                                                                               Solder supply stub‑outs onto the new
                                                                                                              water lines. Install protective metal
       Connect the vent pipe from the wet wall                                                                plates on the wall studs to cover pipe
       with another vent line in the attic, or, if                                                            (and electrical cable) penetrations.
       you prefer, run it out through the roof                                                                Have your work inspected and, when
       and flash and cover it according to your                                                               approved, you may go ahead and
       local plumbing codes.                                                                                  install wall coverings.

                                                                                                                   INSTALLING PLUMBING LINES                  81

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 81 24/9/18 5:19 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_058-081.indd 81 24/9/18 5:17 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:81

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 82 24/9/18 5:46 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 82 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:82

                                                                      Installing
                                                                      Fixtures & Faucets

                                                                      P    lumbing fixtures are where the theory and
                                                                           abstract principles that seem invisible when
                                                                      you’re adding pipes or replumbing a room become
                                                                      real and tangible in day-to-day use. Installing fixtures
                                                                      is the payoff for all the other plumbing work you do.
                                                                      Not only do these deliver water to essential areas
                                                                      of the house, such as bathrooms and kitchens, but
                                                                      fixtures are also often decorative elements that bring
                                                                      fresh sparkle to kitchens and bathrooms.
                                                                          Follow these instructions and you won’t need a
                                                                      lot of expertise, specialized tools, or even time. Every
                                                                      project in this section—including replacing a water
                                                                      heater—is well within the wheelhouse of even a fairly
                                                                      inexperienced DIYer.

                                                                      In this chapter:
                                                                      • Toilets                       • Wet Rooms
                                                                      • Kitchen Faucets                 & Curbless Showers
                                                                      • Kitchen Drains                • Alcove Bathtubs
                                                                        & Traps                       • Sliding Tub Doors
                                                                      • Dishwashers                   • Jetted Tub
                                                                      • Garbage Disposals             • Bidets
                                                                      • Icemakers                     • Water Softeners
                                                                      • Water Heaters                 • Pedestal & Console
                                                                      • Lavatory Faucets                Sinks
                                                                      • Hands-Free                    • Traditional Vanity
                                                                        Bathroom Faucets              • Vanity Top with
                                                                      • Lavatory Drains                 Integral Sink
                                                                      • Shower Kits                   • Kitchen Sinks
                                                                      • Glass-Wall Shower             • Standpipe Drains
                                                                      • Custom                        • Freestanding Tubs
                                                                        Shower Bases                  • Pot Filler

                                                                                           INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   83

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 83 24/9/18 5:46 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 83 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:83

                                                                                                         TOOLS & MATERIALS

              Toilets                                                                                 Adjustable wrench
                                                                                                      Bucket and sponge
                                                                                                      Channel‑type pliers
                                                                                                      Hacksaw
              A    s water becomes an increasingly scarce commodity around the
                    country, low-flow toilets have become the norm everywhere. These
              environmentally friendly fixtures have been on the market long enough
                                                                                                      Penetrating oil
                                                                                                      Pliers
              that manufacturers have worked out most of the problems that plagued                    Putty knife
              first-generation low-flow toilets. The baseline for what qualifies as “low-
                                                                                                      Rubber gloves
              flow” is less than 1.6 gallons of water per flush, the number mandated by
              federal law. Even if you want the most efficient toilet possible, keep an               Screwdriver
              eye out for the EPA’s WaterSense label—indicating the fixture meets very                Supply tube
              strict flushing guidelines.                                                             Teflon tape
                  Whenever you’re looking to replace an existing toilet or buy a new one              Toilet seat bolts
              for a bathroom addition, pay careful attention to the details. Although
              toilets look remarkably similar and all perform the same function,                      Toilet seat
              there are several variations in shape, size, construction, and flushing                 Towels
              technology. Choose based on which best meets your budget and your                       Utility knife
              own preferences—but choose wisely, because toilets are some of the                      Wax ring with or without flange
              longest-lasting fixtures in your home.

              Replacing a toilet is simple, and the newer models of         Gravity‑assisted toilets are now designed with taller tanks and
              water-saving toilets have overcome the performance problems   steeper bowl walls to increase the effects of gravity.
              of earlier models.

     84       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 84 24/9/18 5:46 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 84 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:84

       Choosing a New Toilet
       The selection of toilet styles continues to grow
       by leaps and bounds as manufacturers look to
       accommodate the variety of home styles and personal
       preferences. Regardless of their look or construction,
       new toilets are inevitably much more efficient than
       older models. The basic considerations remain the
       same, however. You’ll be choosing from among several
       different options for technology and seating specifics.
           Two‑piece toilets have a separate water tank
       and bowl.
           One‑piece toilets have a tank and bowl made of
       one seamless unit.
           Elongated bowls are roughly 2 inches longer than
       regular bowls.
           Elevated toilets have higher seats, generally
                                                                                    Two‑piece toilets remain the most common choice for
       18 inches rather than the standard 15 inches.                                homeowners. But you don’t have to go with traditional
           You have a choice of two basic types of flush                            two-piece styling; the modern, squared-off style of this toilet
       mechanisms: gravity- and pressure-assisted.                                  is just one of many eye-catching designs available. Keep in
           Gravity‑assisted toilets allow water to rush down                        mind that the cheapest models are compact with a low seat
       from an elevated tank into the toilet bowl. Federal                          that may be difficult for some people to use. Round-bowl
                                                                                    toilets generally cost less than elongated-bowl models.
       law mandates that new toilets consume no more
       than 1.6 gallons of water per flush, less than half the
       volume used by older styles.                                                    Dual‑flush systems feature two flush buttons on
           Pressure‑assisted toilets rely on either compressed                      the top of the tank, allowing you to select either an
       air or water pumps to boost flushing power.                                  8-ounce flush for liquids or a 1.6-gallon flush for solids.

                                                       Large-diameter flush valve

          Narrow trapway

       Some high‑end toilets are designed to get maximum pressure                   Pressure‑assisted toilets are relatively expensive, but they can
       out of a small amount of water. Many employ narrower                         reduce your water usage significantly by eliminating multiple
       trapways (the path water travels through the bowl) in                        flushes. The flush mechanism of a pressure-assisted toilet
       conjunction with large-diameter flush valves. Some models                    boosts the flushing power by using either compressed air or
       use as little as 1.2 gallons of water per flush.                             water pumps.

                                                                                                           INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   85

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 85 24/9/18 5:46 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 85 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:85

                          How to Remove a Toilet

                                                                                        2

                                                   Coupling nut

                                   Stop valve

                    1
              Remove the old supply tube. First, turn off the water at the          Grip each tank bolt nut with a box wrench or pliers and loosen it
              stop valve. Flush the toilet, holding the handle down for a           as you stabilize each tank bolt from inside the tank with a large
              long flush, and sponge out the tank. Use a wet/dry vac to             slotted screwdriver. If the nuts are stuck, apply penetrating oil
              clear any remaining water out of the tank and bowl. Unthread          to the nut and let it sit before trying to remove them again. You
              the coupling nut for the water supply below the tank using            may also cut the tank bolts between the tank and the bowl with
              channel-type pliers.                                                  an open-ended hacksaw. Remove and discard the tank.

                                                                                         PRYING UP WAX RINGS
                                                                          3

                                                                                       Removing an old wax ring is one of the more disgusting
                                                                                       jobs you’ll encounter in the plumbing universe (the one
                                                                                       you see here is actually in relatively good condition).
              Remove the nuts that hold the bowl to the floor. First, pry off          Work a stiff putty knife underneath the plastic flange of
              the bolt covers with a screwdriver. Use a socket wrench,                 the ring (if you can) and start scraping. In many cases
              locking pliers, or your channel-type pliers to loosen the nuts           the wax ring will come off in chunks. Discard each chunk
              on the tank bolts. Apply penetrating oil and let it sit if the nuts      right away—they stick to everything. If you’re left with a
              are stuck, then take them off. As a last resort, cut the bolts off       lot of residue, scrub with mineral spirits. Once clean, stuff
              with a hacksaw by first cutting down through one side of the             a rag-in-a-bag in the drain opening to block sewer gas.
              nut. Tilt the toilet bowl over and remove it.

     86       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 86 24/9/18 5:46 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 86 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:86

                  How to Install a Toilet
       Clean and inspect the old closet flange. Look for breaks or
       wear. Also inspect the flooring around the flange. If either the        INSTALLATION TIP
       flange or floor is worn or damaged, repair the damage. Use
       a rag and mineral spirits to completely remove residue from
       the old wax ring. Place a rag-in-a-bag into the opening to
       block odors.

            1

                                                                             If you will be replacing your toilet flange or if your
                                                                             existing flange can be unscrewed and moved, orient
                                                                             the new flange so the slots are parallel to the wall. This
                                                                             allows you to insert bolts under the slotted areas, which
                                                                             are much stronger than the areas at the ends of the
                                                                             curved grooves.

       Insert new tank bolts (don’t reuse old ones) into the openings
       in the closet flange. Make sure the heads of the bolts are
       oriented to catch the maximum amount of flange material. To
       firmly hold the bolts upright, slide on the plastic washers and
       press them down.

                                                                      2

                                                                                                                                       3
                                                                          Remove the wax ring and apply it to the underside of the
                                                                          bowl, around the horn. Remove the protective covering. Do
                                                                          not touch the wax ring. It is very sticky. Remove the rag-in-a-
                                                                          bag. If you have an older 4-inch flange, place the ring on the
                                                                          flange rather than the toilet to make sure it is centered.
                                                                                                                                (continued)

                                                                                                 INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   87

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 87 24/9/18 5:46 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 87 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:87

                                                                                                          Install the flush valve. Some tanks
                                                                                                          come with a flush valve and a fill valve
                                                                                                          preinstalled. For models that do not
                                                                                                          have this, insert the flush valve through
                                                                                                          the tank opening and tighten a spud
                                                                                                          nut over the threaded end of the valve.
                                                                                                          Place a foam spud washer on top of the
                                                                                                          spacer nut.

                                                                                                                                                5
                                                                                                                         Spacer nut

                                                                                                4
              Lower the bowl onto the flange, taking care not to disturb the wax ring. The holes in the
              bowl base should align perfectly with the tank bolts. Add a washer and tighten a nut onto
              each bolt. Hand-tighten each nut and then use channel-type pliers to further tighten the
              nuts. Alternate tightening the nuts until the bowl is secure. Do not overtighten.
                                                                                                                                       Spud washer
              NOTE: Some disagreement exists among plumbers as to whether you should seal
              the joint between the bowl and the floor. Most codes require that you do. The
              easiest and least visible way to seal it is to apply a thick bead of clear silicone
              caulk to the bottom rim of the bowl before you set it on the floor. Another option is
              to apply a bead of caulk between the bowl and the floor after the toilet is installed.

                                                                                                    Intermediate nut goes between tank and bowl

                                          Threaded fill
                                          valve shank

                                                                        6                                                                      7
              Adjust the fill valve as directed by the manufacturer to set         With the tank lying on its back, thread a rubber washer onto
              the correct tank water level height and install the valve            each tank bolt and insert it into the bolt holes from inside the
              inside the tank. Hand tighten the nylon lock nut that secures        tank. Then, thread a brass washer and hex nut onto the tank
              the valve to the tank (inset) and then tighten it further with       bolts from below and tighten them to a quarter turn past hand
              channel-type pliers.                                                 tight. Do not overtighten.

     88       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 88 24/9/18 5:46 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 88 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:88

       Position the tank on the bowl, spud washer on opening, bolts
       through bolt holes. Put a rubber washer, followed by a brass
       washer and a wing nut, on each bolt and tighten these evenly.          9

                                                                      8

          Intermediate nut                                                You may stabilize the bolts with a large slotted screwdriver
                                                                          from inside the tank, but tighten the nuts, not the bolts. You
                                                                          may press down a little on a side, the front, or the rear of
                                                                          the tank to level it as you tighten the nuts by hand. Do not
                                                                          overtighten and crack the tank. The tank should be level and
                                                                          stable when you’re done.

           10                                                                11

       Hook up the water supply by connecting the supply tube to the      Attach the toilet seat by threading the plastic or brass bolts
       threaded fill valve with the coupling nut provided. Turn on the    provided with the seat through the openings on the back of
       water and test for leaks. Do not overtighten.                      the rim and attaching nuts.

                                                                                                 INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   89

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 89 24/9/18 5:46 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 89 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:89

                                                                                                      TOOLS & MATERIALS
                                                                                                   Adjustable wrench
              Kitchen Faucets                                                                      Basin wrench
                                                                                                       or channel‑type pliers
                                                                                                   Hacksaw

              M     ost new kitchen faucets feature single-handle control levers and
                    washerless designs that rarely require maintenance. Additional
              features include brushed metallic finishes, detachable spray nozzles, and
                                                                                                   Faucet
                                                                                                   Putty knife
              push-button or touch controls.                                                       Screwdriver
                  Connect the faucet to hot and cold water lines with easy-to-install              Silicone caulk
              flexible supply tubes made from vinyl or braided steel. If your faucet has           Scouring pad
              a separate sprayer, install the sprayer first. Pull the sprayer hose through         Scouring cleaner
              the sink opening and attach it to the faucet body before installing
              the faucet.                                                                          Plumber’s putty
                  Where local codes allow, use plastic tubes for drain hookups. A wide             Flexible vinyl or braided steel
              selection of extensions and angle fittings lets you easily plumb any                     supply tubes
              sink configuration. Manufacturers offer kits that contain all the fittings           Drain components
              needed for attaching a garbage disposal or dishwasher to the sink                    Penetrating oil
              drain system.

                                                                                                Modern kitchen faucets tend to be
                                                                                                single-handle models, often with useful
                                                                                                features such as a pull-out head that
                                                                                                functions as a sprayer. Most models
                                                                                                come with an optional mounting plate
                                                                                                that conceals sink holes when mounted
                                                                                                on a predrilled sink flange.

     90       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 90 24/9/18 5:46 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 90 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:90

       Choosing a New Kitchen Faucet
       You’ll find many options when choosing a new                     water temperature easily with just one hand. Another
       kitchen faucet. The best place to start the process              difference is in the faucet body. Some faucets have the
       is with your sink. In the past, most faucets were                taps and the spout mounted onto a faucet body so
       mounted directly to the sink deck, which had three               the spacing between the tailpieces is preset. Others,
       or four predrilled holes to accommodate the faucets,             called widespread faucets, have independent taps and
       spout, sprayer, and perhaps a liquid soap dispenser              spouts that can be configured however you please, as
       or an air gap for your dishwasher. Modern kitchen                long as the tubes connecting the taps to the spouts
       faucets don’t always conform to this setup, with many            reach. This type is best if you are installing the faucet in
       of them designed to be installed in a single hole in             the countertop (a common way to go about it with new
       the sink deck or in the countertop. If you plan to keep          countertops, such as solid surface, quartz, or granite).
       your old sink, look for a faucet that won’t leave empty              In the past, kitchen faucets almost always had a
       holes in the deck. Generally, it’s best to replace like for      remote pull-out sprayer. The sprayer was attached to
       like, but unfilled stainless sink holes can be filled with       the faucet body with a hose directly below the mixing
       snap-in plugs or a soap dispenser.                               valve. While this type of sprayer is still fairly common,
           The two most basic kitchen faucet categories are             many faucets today have an integral pull-out spout
       single-handle and two-handle. Single-handle models are           that is very convenient and less prone to failure than
       much more popular now because you can adjust the                 the old-style sprayers.

                                                                                                      Single‑handle faucets may require
                                                                                                       four holes, as this model does
                                                                                                        with its side sprayer and
                                                                                                         matching soap/lotion dispenser.

       A single‑handle, high arc faucet
       with traditional remote sprayer. The
       mounting plate is decorative and optional.

                                                                        A single‑handle faucet with
                                                                        pull‑out spray head
                                                                        requires only one hole
                                                                        in your sink deck or
                                                                        countertop—a real
                                                                        benefit if your sink is not
                                                                        predrilled or if it is an
                                                                        undermount model.

       Two‑handled faucets are less common but remain popular
       choices for traditional kitchens. The gooseneck spout also has
       a certain elegance, but avoid this type if you have a shallow
       sink that’s less than 8" deep.

                                                                                              INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   91

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 91 24/9/18 5:46 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 91 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:91

                          How to Remove an Old Faucet
                                                                               Spray the mounting nuts that hold the faucet or faucet handles
                                                                               (on the underside of the sink deck) with penetrating oil for
                                                                      1        easier removal. Let the oil soak in for a few minutes. If the nut
                                                                               is rusted and stubbornly stuck, you may need to drill a hole in
                                                                               its side, then tap the hole with a hammer and screwdriver to
                                                                               loosen it.

                                                                                   2
                                                                                                                                 Mounting nut

                      Sprayer hose

              To remove the old faucet, start by clearing out the cabinet
              under the sink and laying down towels. Turn off the hot and
              cold stop valves and open the faucet to make sure the water
              is off. Detach the sprayer hose from the faucet sprayer nipple
              and unscrew the retaining nut that secures the sprayer base
              to the sink deck. Pull the sprayer hose out through the sink
              deck opening.

                  3

              Unhook the supply
              tubes at the stop
              valves. Don’t reuse
              old chrome supply
              tubes. If the stops
              are missing or
              unworkable, replace
              them. Then remove
              the coupling nuts
              and the mounting
              nuts on the tailpieces                                               4
              of the faucet with
              a basin wrench or
                                                                               Pull the faucet body from the sink. Remove the sprayer base
              channel-type pliers.
                                                                               if you wish to replace it. Scrape off any putty or caulk with a
                                                                               putty knife, and clean off the sink with a scouring pad and a
                                                                               nonabrasive cleaner.

     92       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 92 24/9/18 5:46 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 92 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:92

                  How to Install a Pullout Kitchen Sink Faucet

            1
                                                                                 Pullout hose

                                                                                                Threaded shank

                                                                                                          Hose end

                                                                                  2
       Install the base plate (if your faucet has one) onto the sink flange   Retract the pullout hose by drawing it out through the faucet
       so it is centered. Have a helper hold it straight from above as        body until the fitting at the end of the hose is flush with the
       you tighten the mounting nuts that secure the base plate from          bottom of the threaded faucet shank. Insert the shank and
       below. Make sure the plastic gasket is centered under the base         the supply tubes down through the top of the deck plate.
       plate. These nuts can be adequately tightened by hand.

          3

                                                       Washer
                                                                                                                             Hose weight

                   Mounting nut

                                                       Retainer screw

         Cabinet back removed for clarity                                         4
       Slip the mounting nut and washer over the free ends of the             Slide the hose weight onto the pullout hose (the weight helps
       supply tubes and pullout hose, then thread the nut onto the            keep the hose from tangling, and it makes it easier to retract).
       threaded faucet shank. Hand tighten. Tighten the retainer
       screws with a screwdriver to secure the faucet.                                                                              (continued)

                                                                                                      INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                  93

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 93 24/9/18 5:46 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 93 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:93

              Connect the end of the pullout hose to the outlet port on the
              faucet body using a quick connector fitting.

                                                                          5           Water supply tube

                      Output port

                                                                                 6
                                                                              Hook up the water supply tubes to the faucet inlets. Make sure
                                                                              the tubes are long enough to reach the supply risers without
                                                                              stretching or kinking.

              Connect the supply tubes to the supply risers at the stop
              valves. Make sure to get the hot lines and cold lines
              attached correctly.

                    7

                                                                                                                                          8
                                                                              Attach the spray head to the end of the pullout hose and turn
                                                                              the fitting to secure the connection. Turn on the water supply
                                                                              and test.

                                                                              TIP: Remove the aerator in the tip of the spray head and run
                                                                              hot and cold water to flush out any debris.

     94       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 94 24/9/18 5:46 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 94 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:94

             VARIATION: ONE‑PIECE FAUCET WITH SPRAYER

                         Friction washer

                                                                                          Tailpiece

                                                                                        Supply tube

                                                                 Mounting nut
                                                                                      Coupling

          Clean around the sink holes and slip the faucet’s washer              Connect the supply tubes to the tailpieces. Make sure the
          onto the base. Place the faucet and, working from                     tubes are long enough to reach the stop valves and that
          underneath, slip a friction washer onto each tailpiece.               the coupling nuts will fit over the tubes and tailpieces.
          Hand-tighten the mounting nuts. Tighten the nuts fully with
          channel-type pliers. Wipe up any squeeze-out on the sink
          deck with a wet rag.

                                                                                              Plumber's putty

                                                                                   Friction washer

                                                                                  Mounting nut
              Sprayer tailpiece

          Apply a ¼" bead of plumber’s putty to the underside of                Tighten the sprayer tailpiece mounting nut with channel-
          the sprayer base. With the base threaded onto the hose,               type pliers, and clean up any excess putty. Screw the
          insert the tailpiece through the sink deck opening. From              sprayer hose onto the nipple on the bottom of the faucet.
          underneath, slip the friction washer over the sprayer                 Hand-tighten and then give a quarter turn more with
          tailpiece and screw the mounting onto the tailpiece.                  channel-type pliers. Turn on the water, remove the faucet’s
                                                                                aerator, and flush out any debris.

                                                                                                      INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   95

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 95 24/9/18 5:46 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 95 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:95

                                                                                    TOOLS & MATERIALS
                                                                                  Flat screwdriver                Teflon tape
                                                                                  Spud wrench                     Washers
                                                                                  Trap arm                        Waste tee fitting
                                                                                  Mineral spirits                 P‑trap

              Kitchen Drains & Traps                                              Cloth
                                                                                  Strainer kit
                                                                                                                  Saw
                                                                                                                  Miter box
                                                                                  Plumber’s putty

              K    itchen traps, also called sink drains or trap
                   assemblies, are made of 1½-inch pipes (also
              called tubes), slip washers, and nuts, so they
              can be easily assembled and disassembled. Most                              A
              plastic types can be tightened by hand, with no
              wrench required. Pipes made of chromed brass                                B
              will corrode in time, and rubber washers will
              crumble, meaning they need to be replaced. Plastic
              pipes and plastic washers last virtually forever. All                                                   E
              traps are liable to get bumped out of alignment;
              when this happens, they should be taken apart                               C

              and reassembled.                                                                    F          G
                  A trap’s configuration depends on how many
              bowls the sink has, whether or not you have a
              garbage disposal and/or a dishwasher drain line, and                            D
              local codes. On this page we show three of the most
              common assembly types. Tee fittings on these traps
              often have a baffle, which reduces the water flow                Kitchen sink drains include a strainer body (A), tailpiece (B),
              somewhat. Check local codes to make sure your trap               waste tee (C), P-trap (D), outlet drain line (E), trap arm (F),
              is compliant.                                                    and wall stub-out with coupling (G).

                                  A

                                                                                                                      B
                                          C

                                                                      B

                                                                                                         C

             D

                                                                                                                  A

              In this arrangement, the dishwasher drain hose (A) attaches to   A “center tee” arrangement has a single P-trap (A) that is
              the garbage disposal (B), and a trap arm (C) leads from the      connected to a waste tee (B) and the trap arm (C).
              disposal to the P-trap (D).

     96       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 96 24/9/18 5:46 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 96 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:96

              DRAIN KITS                                                            TIPS FOR CHOOSING DRAINS
          Kits for installing a new sink drain include all the pipes,
          slip fittings, and washers you’ll need to get from the sink
          tailpieces (most kits are equipped for a double bowl                         Heavy plastic
          kitchen sink) to the trap arm that enters the wall or floor.
          For wall trap arms, you’ll need a kit with a P-trap. Both
          drains normally are plumbed to share a trap. Chromed
          brass or PVC with slip fittings let you adjust the drain                                                          Chromed brass
          more easily and pull it apart and then reassemble if
          there is a clog. Some pipes have fittings on their ends
          that eliminate the need for a washer. Kitchen sink drains
          and traps should be 1½" o.d. pipe—the 1¼" pipe is
          for lavatories and doesn’t have enough capacity for a                       Light-duty plastic
          kitchen sink.
                                                                                  Wall thickness varies in sink drain pipes. The thinner
             Chromed brass                                       Slip nuts        plastic material is cheaper and more difficult to obtain a
             P-trap system                                                        good seal with than the thicker, more expensive tubing.
                                                                        Drain     The thin product is best reserved for lavatory drains,
                                                                      tailpiece   which are far less demanding.
               Wall escutchen

                                    Slip nut washers

                 Trap arm

                                                  P-trap
             Plastic system                                                       Slip joints are formed by tightening a male-threaded
                                                                                  slip nut over a female-threaded fitting, trapping and
               Slip nuts                                                          compressing a beveled nylon washer to seal the joint.

               Slip nut washers

                                           Drain tailpiece

                 Trap arm

                                                                                  Use a spud wrench to tighten the strainer body against
                                                                                  the underside of the sink bowl. Normally, the strainer
                                                                                  flange has a layer of plumber’s putty to seal beneath it
                                       P-trap                                     above the sink drain and a pair of washers (one rubber,
                                                                                  one fibrous) to seal below.

                                                                                                       INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                  97

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 97 24/9/18 5:47 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 97 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:97

                          How to Hook Up a Kitchen Sink Drain

                    1                                                                           Apply plumber’s putty around the perimeter
                                                                                                of the drain opening and seat the strainer
                                                                                                assembly into it. Add washers below as
                                                                                                directed, and tighten the strainer locknut with
                                                                                                a spud wrench (see photo, previous page) or
                                                                                                by striking the mounting nubs at the top of the
                                                                                                body with a flat screwdriver.

                         Slip nut washer

                                                                                              2

                                                                      Threaded outlet

                                                          Tailpiece

              If you are replacing the sink strainer body, remove the old
              one and clean the top and bottom of the sink deck around
              the drain opening with mineral spirits. Attach the drain
              tailpiece to the threaded outlet of the strainer body, inserting
              a nonbeveled washer between the parts if your strainer kits
              include one. Lubricate the threads or apply Teflon tape so you
              can get a good, snug fit.

                                                                                                                 Drain tail pieces

                                                                                            Drain stub-out

                                                                                                   Trap arm

                                                                                            4          Escutcheon

                                                                                  3     Attach the trap arm to the male‑threaded drain stub‑out in the
                                                                                        wall using a slip nut and beveled compression washer. The
              You may need to cut a trap arm or drain tailpiece to length.              outlet for the trap arm should point downward.
              Cut metal tubing with a hacksaw. Cut plastic tubing with a
              handsaw, power miter saw, or a hand miter box and a backsaw               NOTE: The trap arm must be lower on the wall than any of the
              or hacksaw. You can use a tubing cutter for any material.                 horizontal lines in the set-up, including lines to dishwasher,
              Deburr the cut end of plastic tubing with a utility knife.                disposal, or the outlet line to the second sink bowl.

     98       THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 98 24/9/18 5:47 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 98 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:98

                                                                           Waste tee

                                                                                                                            Outer drain pipe

                                                                                   Trap arm
            Waste tee

            5                                                                6
       Attach a waste tee fitting to the drain tailpiece, orienting      Join the short end of the outlet drain pipe to the tailpiece for
       the opening in the fitting side so it will accept the outlet      the other sink bowl, and then attach the end of the long run
       drain line from the other sink bowl. If the waste tee is          to the opening in the waste tee. The outlet tube should extend
       higher than the top of the trap arm, remove it and trim the       into the tee ½"—make sure it does not extend in far enough
       drain tailpiece.                                                  to block water flow from above.

                                                                              VARIATION: DRAIN IN FLOOR

                                            Outer drain pipe

                                                                              Waste tee
            Waste tee                                                                                      Bottom

                                                     Trap arm

                                                                                                              Outlet pipe
                                                                              Top of S-trap

                      P-trap                                                                                   Drain

                                                                           If your drain stub‑out comes up out of the floor or cabinet
                                                                           base instead of the wall, you probably have a two-
            7                                                              part S-trap instead of a P-trap in your drain line. This
                                                                           arrangement is illegal in some areas, because a heavy
                                                                           surge of waterflow from a nearby fixture can siphon the
       Attach the long leg of a P‑trap to the waste tee and attach the     trap dry, rendering it unable to block gases. Check with
       shorter leg to the downward-facing opening of the trap arm.         your local plumbing inspector to learn if S-traps are
       Adjust as necessary and test all joints to make sure they are       allowed in your area.
       still tight, and then test the system.

                                                                                                  INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   99

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 99 24/9/18 5:47 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 99 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:99

              Dishwashers                                                                                 TOOLS & MATERIALS
                                                                                                       Screwdrivers

              A    dishwasher that’s past its prime may be inefficient in more ways than
                   one. If it’s an old model, it probably wasn’t designed to be very efficient
              to begin with. But more significantly, if it no longer cleans effectively, you’re
                                                                                                       Adjustable wrench
                                                                                                       2' level
              probably spending a lot of time and hot water pre-rinsing the dishes. This               ¾" discharge tube
              alone can consume more energy and water than a complete wash cycle                       ½" flexible supply tubing
              on a newer machine. So even if your old dishwasher still runs, replacing it              Cable connector
              with an efficient new model can be a good green upgrade.                                 Teflon tape
                  In terms of sizing and utility hookups, dishwashers are generally quite
              standard. If your old machine is a built-in and your countertops and cabinets            Hose clamps
              are standard sizes, most full-size dishwashers will fit right in. Of course, you         Wire connectors
              should always measure the dimensions of the old unit before shopping for a               Carpet scrap
              new one to avoid an unpleasant surprise at installation time. Also be sure to            Bowl
              review the manufacturer’s instructions before starting any work.

              Replacing an
              old, inefficient
              dishwasher is a
              straightforward
              project that
              usually takes
              just a few hours.
              The energy and
              water savings
              start with the first
              load of dishes
              and continue
              with every load
              thereafter.
              Newer units
              also do a better
              job of cleaning
              your dishware
              and glassware.

   100        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 100 24/9/18 5:47 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 100 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:100

                  How to Replace a Dishwasher
                                                                           Disconnect old plumbing connections. First unscrew the front
                                                                           access panel. Once the access panel is removed, disconnect
                                                                           the water supply line from the L-fitting on the bottom of the
                                                                           unit. This is usually a brass compression fitting, so just turning
                                                                           the compression nut counterclockwise with an adjustable
                                                                           wrench should do the trick. Use a bowl to catch any water
                                                                           that might leak out when the nut is removed.

                                                                               2                      L-fitting

            1
       Start by shutting off the electrical power to the circuit at the
       main service panel. Also, turn off the water supply at the
       shutoff valve, usually located directly under the floor or in the
       cabinet beneath the kitchen sink.

       NOTE: Most local codes now require that dishwashers be on
       a GFCI-protected circuit. If yours is not, it’s always a good
       idea to replace the regular receptacle with a GFCI-protected
       model or to replace the circuit breaker at the main panel
       with a GFCI breaker.

       Disconnect old wiring connections. The dishwasher
       has an integral electrical box at the front of the unit
       where the power cable is attached to the dishwasher’s
       fixture wires. Take off the box cover and remove the
       wire connectors that join the wires together.

                                                                               4
                                                                           Disconnect the discharge hose, which is usually connected to
                                                                           the dishwasher port on the side of the garbage disposal. To
                                                                           remove it, just loosen the screw on the hose clamp and pull
                                                                           it off. You may need to push this hose back through a hole in
                                                                           the cabinet wall and into the dishwasher compartment so it
          3                                                                won’t get caught when you pull out the dishwasher.
                                                                                                                                 (continued)

                                                                                                  INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   101

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 101 24/9/18 5:47 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 101 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:101

                    5

                                                                                           6
              Detach the unit from the cabinets before you pull it out.                First, read the appliance’s installation instructions carefully,
              Remove the screws that hold the brackets to the underside                and then prepare the new dishwasher to be installed. Tip it on
              of the countertop. Then put a piece of cardboard or old                  its back and attach the new L-fitting into the threaded port
              carpet under the front legs to protect the floor from getting            on the solenoid. Apply some Teflon tape to the fitting threads
              scratched, and pull the dishwasher out.                                  before tightening to allow the coupling to be tightened fully.

                                                                                   7                      Leveling leg
                               Retainer nut

                                                                 Cable connector

                                     Power supply to appliance

                                                                                           8
              Prepare for the wiring connections. Like the old dishwasher,             Install a leveling leg at each of the four corners while the
              the new one will have an integral electrical box for making the          new dishwasher is still on its back. Just turn the legs into
              wiring connections. To gain access to the box, just remove               the threaded holes designed for them. Leave about ½" of each
              the box cover. Then install a cable connector on the back                leg projecting from the bottom of the unit. These will have to
              of the box and bring the power cable from the service panel              be adjusted later to level the appliance. Tip the appliance up
              through this connector. Power should be shut off at the main             onto the feet, and slide it into the opening. Check for level in
              service panel at all times.                                              both directions and adjust the feet as required.

   102        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 102 24/9/18 5:47 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 102 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:102

                                                                                        Push an adapter over the disposal’s discharge nipple and
                                                     Countertop build-up strip          tighten it in place with a hose clamp. If you don’t have a
                                                                                        disposal, replace one of the drain tailpieces with a dishwasher
                                                                                        tailpiece, and clamp the discharge tube to its fitting.
            Discharge hose

                                                                                                       Discharge tube from dishwasher

                                                                                          Adapter

                                                                            9
                                                                                                Drain
       Once the dishwasher is level, attach the brackets to the
       underside of the countertop to keep the appliance from
       moving. Then pull the discharge hose into the sink cabinet
       and install it so there’s a loop that is attached with a bracket
       to the underside of the countertop. This loop prevents waste                                                            Disposal
       water from flowing from the disposal back into the dishwasher.

       NOTE: Some codes require that you install an air gap fitting                                                                               10
       for this purpose. Check with your local plumbing inspector.

             TUBE CHOICES
                                                                       11                Brass bushing
          Codes still allow flexible copper
          supply tubes such as the one
          shown in the next step, but a
          flexible dishwasher supply tube,
          such as reinforced, braided
          stainless steel, is a better choice
          in just about any situation. Copper
          tubes may crimp and either burst
          or restrict water flow when you
          move the dishwasher.
                                                                            Compression nut

                                                                                         Supply tube

                                                                            L-fitting
                                                                                                                  12
                                                               Adjust the L‑fitting on the dishwasher’s        Complete the electrical connections
                                                               water inlet valve until it points directly      by clamping the cable and joining
                                                               toward the water supply tubing. Then            the wires with wire nuts, following
                                                               lubricate the threads slightly with a           manufacturer’s instructions. Replace
                                                               drop of dishwashing liquid and tighten          the electrical cover, usually by hooking
                                                               the tubing’s compression nut onto the           it onto a couple of prongs and driving
                                                               fitting, keeping the brass bushing              a screw. Restore power and water, and
                                                               between the nut and the L-fitting.              test. Replace the toe-kick.
                                                               Use an adjustable wrench to turn the
                                                               nut clockwise.

                                                                                                                INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                  103

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 103 24/9/18 5:47 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 103 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:103

                                                                                         TOOLS & MATERIALS

              Garbage Disposals                                                        Screwdriver
                                                                                       Channel‑type pliers
                                                                                                                        Putty knife
                                                                                                                        Mineral spirits
                                                                                       Spud wrench (optional)           Plumber’s putty

              G     arbage disposals are standard equipment in                         Hammer                           Wire caps
                    the modern home, and most of us have come                          Hacksaw or tubing cutter         Hose clamps
              to depend on them to macerate our plate leavings                         Kitchen drain supplies           Threaded wye fitting
              and crumbs so they can exit the house along with                         Drain auger                      Electrical tape
              waste water from the sink drain. If your existing
              disposal needs replacing, you’ll find that the job is
              relatively simple, especially if you select a replacement                 Choose a switch option that meets your family’s
              appliance that is the same model as the old one.                       safety needs. A “continuous feed” disposal may be
              In that case, you can probably reuse the existing                      controlled by a standard on-off switch on the wall.
              mounting assembly, drain sleeve, and drain plumbing.                   Another option is a disposal that stays on only
                   Disposals are available with power ratings between                when the switch is actively pressed. A “batch feed”
              1
               ⁄3 and 1 horsepower (HP); ¾ HP is the most common.                    disposal can turn on only when a lid is locked onto it,
              More powerful models bog down less under load and                      eliminating the possibility of harming fingers. Some
              the motors last longer because they don’t have to                      models are controlled at the lid, without a wall switch.
              work as hard. They are also costlier.                                  Continuous food disposals are the most common.

                                                                                                         Dedicated GFCI-protected power
                                                                                                        preferred but may not be required

                               Drain tailpiece

                                                                       Wye fitting

                                                                                                                  Armored cable

                             Sink P-trap
                                                                                      Disposal P-trap

              A properly functioning garbage disposal that’s used correctly can help reduce clogs. Some plumbers use separate P-traps for the
              disposal and the drain outlet tube, as shown here. Others contend that configuring the drain line with a single P-trap minimizes
              the chance that a trap will have its water seal broken by suction from the second trap.

   104        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 104 24/9/18 5:47 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 104 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:104

         Upper mounting ring

                                                                       Sink sleeve
                                                                                                                Flange

                                                                                                                Sleeve

                                                                                         Mounting screw
      Backup ring

                                                                                                                Fiber gasket

      Dishwasher
                                                                                                                Backup ring
        nipple
                                                                                     Lower mounting ring

                                                                                                                   Upper
                                                                                            Grinding ring
                                                                                                                mounting ring

        Sound
      insulation
                                                                                                                Snap ring

                                                                                                              The disposal is attached directly to
                                                                                                              the sink sleeve, which comes with the
                                                                                                              disposal and replaces the standard sink
                                                                                                              strainer. A snap ring fits into a groove
      Discharge                                                                                               around the sleeve of the strainer body
       opening                                                                                                to prevent the upper mounting ring and
                                                                                                              backup ring from sliding down while the
                                                                                                              upper mounting ring is tightened against
                                                                                                              the backup ring with mounting screws.
                                                                                                              Use a fiber gasket compressor when the
                                                          Motor                                               mounting screws are tightened to create
                                                                                                              a better seal under the flange.
       Drain
      chamber                                                                                  Impellers

                                                                                                                                             Baffle

                                   A garbage disposal grinds food waste so
                                   it can be flushed away through the sink
                                                                                                                            Waste tee                 Waste tee with baffle
                                   drain system. A quality disposal has a
                                   ½‑horsepower or larger self‑reversing
                                   motor. Other features to look for include                                  Kitchen and drain tees are required to
                                   foam sound insulation, a grinding ring,                                    have a baffle if the tee is connected to
                                   and overload protection that allows the                                    a dishwasher or disposal. The baffle
                                   motor to be reset if it overheats. Better                                  is intended to prevent discharge from
                                   garbage disposals have a five‑year                                         finding its way up the drain and into
                                   manufacturer’s warranty.                                                   the sink.

                                                                                                              INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                     105

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 105 24/9/18 5:47 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 105 2/10/18 10:54 AM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:105

                          How to Replace a Garbage Disposal
              Remove the old disposal if you have one. You’ll need to
              disconnect the drain pipes and traps first. If your old disposal
              has a special wrench for the mounting lugs, use it to loosen
              the lugs. Otherwise, use a screwdriver. If you do not have
              a helper, place a solid object directly beneath the disposal
              to support it before you begin removal. Important: Shut off
              electrical power at the main service panel before you begin
              removal. Disconnect the wire leads, cap them, and stuff them
              into the electrical box.

                   Mounting lug

                                                                                             2

                                                                                              Clear the drain lines all the way to the branch drain
                                                                                              before you begin the new installation. Remove the trap
                                                                                              and trap arm first.
                                                                                1

                    3                                                                                                                              4
                                                                 Upper mounting ring

                                                                                                                                Sink sleeve

                                         Lower mounting ring

                                          Snap ring

              Disassemble the mounting assembly, and then separate                     Press the flange of the sink sleeve for your new disposal
              the upper and lower mounting rings and the backup ring.                  into a thin coil of plumber’s putty that you have laid around
              Also remove the snap ring from the sink sleeve. See photo,               the perimeter of the drain opening. The sleeve should be
              previous page.                                                           well-seated in the coil.

   106        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 106 24/9/18 5:47 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 106 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:106

       Slip the fiber gasket and then the backup ring onto the sink sleeve, working from
       inside the sink base cabinet. Make sure the backup ring is oriented the same way it
       was before you disassembled the mounting assembly.

            5
                                                                          Fiber gasket

                          Sink sleeve

                                                                       Backup ring

                                                                                                        6
                                                                                                    Insert the upper mounting ring onto
                                                                                                    the sleeve with the slotted ends of the
                                                                                                    screws facing away from the backup
                                                                                                    ring so you can access them. Then,
                                                                                                    holding all three parts at the top of the
                                                                                                    sleeve, slide the snap ring onto the
                                                                                                    sleeve until it snaps into the groove.

            7                                                                    8
           Tighten the three mounting                                        Make electrical connections before you attach the disposal
           screws on the upper                                               unit on the mounting assembly. Shut off the power at the
           mounting ring until the tips                                      service panel if you have turned it back on. Remove the
           press firmly against the                                          access plate from the disposal. Attach the white and black
           backup ring. It is the tension                                    branch circuit wires from the electrical box to the white and
           created by these screws that                                      black wires (respectively) inside the disposal. Twist a small
           keeps the disposal steady                                         wire cap onto each connection and wrap it with electrical tape
           and minimizes vibration.                                          for good measure. Also attach the green ground wire from the
                                                                             box to the grounding terminal on your disposal.
                                                                                                                                   (continued)

                                                                                                    INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   107

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 107 24/9/18 5:47 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 107 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:107

                    9

                                                                                   10
              Knock out the plug in the disposal port if you will be            Hang the disposal from the mounting ring attached to the sink
              connecting your dishwasher to the disposal. If you                sleeve. To hang it, simply lift it up and position the unit so
              have no dishwasher, leave the plug in. Insert a large             the three mounting ears are underneath the three mounting
              flathead screwdriver into the port opening and rap it with        screws, and then spin the unit so all three ears fit into the
              a mallet. Retrieve the knock-out plug from inside the             mounting assembly. Wait until after the plumbing hookups
              disposal canister.                                                have been made to lock the unit in place.

                                                                                   12

                                                                                   Drain stub-out

                                                                                        Wye fitting

                                                                       11
              Attach the discharge tube to the disposal according to the        Attach a wye fitting at the drain stub‑out. The wye fitting
              manufacturer’s instructions. It is important to get a very good   should be sized to accept a drain line from the disposal and
              seal here or the disposal will leak. Go ahead and spin the        another from the sink. Adjust the sink drain plumbing as
              disposal if it helps you access the discharge port.               needed to get from the sink P-trap to one opening of the wye.

   108        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 108 24/9/18 5:47 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 108 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:108

       Install a trap arm for the disposal in the open port of the
       wye fitting at the wall stub-out. Then, attach a P-trap or a
       combination of a tube extension and a P-trap so the trap will
       align with the bottom of the disposal discharge tube.

           13

           Outlet from sink

                                                                                    P-trap

                 Wye fitting
                                                                               14
                                                                            Spin the disposal so the end of the discharge tube is lined up
                   Trap arm
                                                                            over the open end of the P-trap, and confirm that they will fit
                                                                            together correctly. If the discharge tube extends down too far,
                    P-trap                                                  mark a line on it at the top of the P-trap and cut at the line with
                                                                            a hacksaw. If the tube is too short, attach an extension with a
                                                                            slip joint. You may need to further shorten the discharge tube
                                                                            first to create enough room for the slip joint on the extension.
                                                                            Slide a slip nut and beveled compression washer onto the
                                                                            discharge tube and attach the tube to the P-trap.

                               Dishwasher discharge tube

                                                                       15                                                             16
       Connect the dishwasher discharge tube to the inlet port located      Lock the disposal into position on the mounting ring assembly
       at the top of the disposal unit. This may require a dishwasher       once you have tested to make sure it is functioning correctly
       hookup kit. Typically, a hose clamp is used to secure                and without leaks. Lock it by turning one of the mounting lugs
       the connection.                                                      until it makes contact with the locking notch.

                                                                                                    INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                  109

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 109 24/9/18 5:47 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 109 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:109

                                                                          Before

              Icemakers

              M      ost expensive refrigerators
                     come with icemakers as
              standard equipment, and practically
              every model features them as
              an option (a refrigerator with an
              icemaker usually costs about $100
              more). It is also possible to purchase
              an icemaker as a retrofit feature for
              your old fridge.
                  Hooking up an existing icemaker                          After
              to a cold-water supply involves
              drilling holes and connecting to
              a cold-water pipe. Most often, a
              pipe can be found in the basement
              below the kitchen, perhaps under
              the kitchen sink. To make the
              connection, some local codes allow
              the installation of a saddle tee valve,
              but many do not, and a compression
              tee valve is not difficult to install,
              as we show. In many kitchens
              the flexible line running from the
              valve to the fridge is copper, but
              reinforced icemaker tubing is easier
              to install and less likely to kink or
              crack. To be sure everything fits, you
              can buy a connection kit from the
              refrigerator manufacturer.
                  If you have an older refrigerator                    A built-in icemaker is easy to install as a retrofit appliance in most modern
                                                                       refrigerators. If you want to have an endless supply of ice for home use, you’ll
              with no icemaker and you’d like it to                    wonder how you ever got along without one.
              have one, all is not lost. Inspect the
              back of the unit, behind the freezer
              compartment. If your refrigerator                             TOOLS & MATERIALS
              has the required plumbing to
              support an icemaker, you will see a                         Screwdrivers               Electric drill &            Open‑end or
              port or a port that is covered with                         Nut drivers                   assorted bits               adjustable wrench
              backing. In that case, all you need                                                    Icemaker kit                Tee fitting
                                                                          Needle‑nose pliers
              to do is take the make and model                                                          (or icemaker                or saddle valve
              information to an appliance parts                           Duct or masking tape
                                                                                                        tubing with              Long ½" drill bit
              dealer, and they can sell you an                            Channel‑type pliers           ferrules and nuts)
              aftermarket icemaker. Plan to spend                                                                                Electrician’s tape
                                                                          Putty knife
              $100 to $200.

   110        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 110 24/9/18 5:47 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 110 2/10/18 10:55 AM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:110

             HOW ICEMAKERS WORK
          An icemaker receives its supply of water for making
          cubes through a ¼" copper supply line that runs from
          the icemaker to a water pipe. The supply line runs
          through a valve in the refrigerator and is controlled by a
          solenoid that monitors the water supply and sends the
          water into the icemaker itself, where it is turned into ice
          cubes. The cubes drop down into a bin, and as the ice
          level rises, they also raise a bail wire that’s connected
          to a shutoff. When the bin is full, the bail wire will be
          high enough to trigger a mechanism that shuts off the
          water supply.

          Aftermarket automatic icemakers are simple to install as
          long as your refrigerator is icemaker ready. Make sure to
          buy the correct model for your appliance and do careful
          installation work—icemaker water supply lines are very
          common sources for leaks.

       Retrofit icemaker kits come with almost everything you need to install an icemaker in your refrigerator. The flexible icemaker
       supply line needs to be purchased separately. Larger home centers keep retrofit icemakers for the more popular model in stock.
       You can find units for most pre-plumbed refrigerators through appliance parts stores or online.

                                                                                              INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   111

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 111 24/9/18 5:47 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 111 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:111

                          How to Connect an Icemaker

                    1                                                            2

              Locate a nearby cold‑water pipe, usually in the basement or    From below, fasten icemaker tubing to the end of the drill
              crawl space below the kitchen. Behind the refrigerator and     bit by wrapping it firmly with electrician’s tape. From above,
              near the wall, use a long ½" bit to drill a hole through the   carefully pull the bit up to thread the tubing into the kitchen.
              floor. Do not pull the bit out.

                       Supply tube to icemaker
                                                                                                                                         4

                                                            Saddle valve

                  3

              Shut off the water and open nearby faucets to drain
              the line. Cut into a cold-water pipe and install a
                                                                             Connect the tubing. Arrange the tubing behind the fridge so
              compression tee valve or a saddle valve. Tighten all the
                                                                             you have about 6' of slack, making it easy to pull the fridge
              nuts, close the valve and nearby faucets, and restore
                                                                             out for cleaning. Insert the tubing into the valve and tighten
              water to test for leaks.
                                                                             the nut. To finish the installation, connect the tubing to the
                                                                             refrigerator. Keep the tubing neatly coiled and kink-free for
                                                                             future maintenance.

   112        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 112 24/9/18 5:47 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 112 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:112

                  How to Install a Retrofit Icemaker
       Remove all the contents from the refrigerator and freezer.
       Unplug the unit and pull it away from the wall so you can
       access the back easily. On the back of the refrigerator, remove
       or pierce the protective sheet that covers the port for the                                              Harness connector cover
       water inlet tube, following any directions printed on the sheet.

       NOTE: If you cannot locate these openings your refrigerator
       is not preplumbed for an icemaker.

            1

                                                                                                                Plastic plugs

                                                                                 2
                                                                             Inside the freezer compartment, remove the plastic plugs and
                                                                             covers in the upper left. Use a plastic putty knife to pry plugs
                                                                             from the access holes (the model seen here has three: one
                                                                             on the back wall and two on the side wall). This model also
                                                                             has a plastic cover over the harness connector opening that is
                                                                             removed by unscrewing a small hex screw.

       Join the water inlet tube to the water supply tubing that came
       with the kit, slipping the foam sealing gasket onto the threads
       of the water inlet tube. Hand-tighten the compression fitting
       and then tighten one-half-turn with a wrench or pliers. Do not
       overtighten. Insert the water inlet into the opening on the back
       of the appliance until the flange on the inlet tube is seated
       squarely at the mouth of the opening.

            3
                            Water inlet tube

                      Sealing gasket

                                                                                 4
                                                             Supply tubing
                                                                             Remove the access panel at the bottom of the backside of the
                                                                             refrigerator. The icemaker kit will include a water valve that
                                                                             is connected to both the water supply and the system wiring
                                                                             (the wiring harness). You’ll find it easier if you make these
                                                                             connections prior to mounting the valve onto the appliance.
                                                                             First, insert the free end of the icemaker supply tubing you
                                                                             connected at the top into the port on the water valve.
                                                                                                                                   (continued)

                                                                                                    INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   113

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 113 24/9/18 5:47 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 113 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:113

                                                                                 5

                 Supply tubing                      Wiring harness

                                Water valve

                                                                                         6
                                               Insert the electrical prongs on
                                               the water valve into the slots
                                                                                     Secure the water valve to the back of the refrigerator at the
                                               on the wiring harness so the
                                                                                     spot indicated in the instruction manual. There should be pre-
                                               connections are fully made.
                                                                                     punched holes that align with the screw holes in the mounting
                                                                                     flange of the water valve. Use self-tapping screws to attach
                                                                                     the valve.

                                                                                 7
                                                                                                       Attach the other end of the supply
                                                                                                       tubing to a cold water supply line from
                                                                                                       the home water supply system. You
                                                                                                       may use either a saddle valve (piercing
                                                                                                       or nonpiercing) or a tee valve with a
                                                                                                       shutoff (inset). Most professionals would
                                                                                                       recommend the tee valve as these are
                                                                                                       regarded as less prone to leakage.

                                                                                                                                                8

              Attach a cold water supply tube to the inlet port on the water
              valve. Use flexible, reinforced tubing, such as the stainless
              steel reinforced tubing seen here. Tighten the nut on the
              supply tube with channel-type pliers.

   114        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 114 24/9/18 5:47 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 114 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:114

       Inside the freezer compartment, locate the tip of the water inlet
       tube that was inserted into the back of the refrigerator.

            9

                                                  Mounting holes

           Wiring harness

                                                    Water inlet tube          10
                                                                           Set the icemaker unit inside the freezer. Some models (such
                                                                           as this one) have a small, adjustable leveling bracket that
                                                                           should be attached to the bottom of the unit first. Connect the
                                                                           plug from the icemaker unit securely into the wiring harness.

       The icemaker unit is supported by two hanger screws driven
       into the predrilled holes in the side wall of the freezer
       compartment. Drive the hanger screws partway into the holes,
       leaving enough screw shank exposed that you can fit the
       hanger mounts on the icemaker over the screw heads.

           11

                                                                              12
                                                                           Hang the icemaker on the mounting screws. Adjust the leveling
                                                                           bracket until you can see that the unit is level. Tighten the
                                                                           mounting screws only until the unit is snug against the side
                                                                           wall. Make sure the water inlet tube is aligned over the fill cup
                                                                           at the back of the unit. Position the ice container underneath
                                                                           the icemaker and follow the manufacturer’s directions for
                                                                           testing. Reattach the back acess panel, and return the
                                                                           appliance to position.

                                                                                                  INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   115

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 115 24/9/18 5:48 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 115 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:115

              Water Heaters

              A     lthough it may seem daunting, replacing your
                     water heater is not much more complicated than
              replacing a garbage disposal or kitchen faucet. Even if
              you decide to upgrade your unit, or go to an entirely
              new technology, the plumbing is still relatively simple
              and doable. You should keep in mind that the modern
              equivalent of your existing water heater may be a
              very different size; always measure before swapping a
              water heater out and before shopping for a new one.
                   The best long-term value for your money can be
              found in an Energy Star–rated unit. Because the water
              heater runs so much in any home, a little energy
              cost savings over the long haul will add up to more
              than the higher cost when you buy the unit. And
              think to the future when you’re shopping. You can
              now choose from among “smart” water heaters that
              can be connected and controlled via Wi-Fi and your
              smartphone or home control console.
                   It is a commonly held belief that a water heater
              should last around 8 to 12 years. The longevity depends           A water heater is one of the most important and heavily used
              on many factors, including initial quality, usage levels,         plumbing appliances in any house. Professionals recommend
              maintenance diligence, and other miscellaneous factors,           replacing a water heater that is more than ten years old.
              such as hardness of water. While it is everyone’s goal to
              get as much use out of our major appliances as possible,          While you don’t want to run out of hot water every
              it is also undeniable that the best time to replace a             morning, you also don’t want to pay to heat more
              water heater is before it leaks and fills your basement           water than you use. Base your choice on how well
              with water. It’s a bit of a gamble, but once your old             your current water heater is meeting your demand.
                                                                                                                                                                  N
              heater starts showing signs of wear and perhaps even                   Follow local codes when choosing the pipe and
              acting up a bit, go ahead and make the change.                    fittings for both gas and water. Make sure there is a gas
                   Water heaters for primary duty in residences range           shutoff within 5 feet of the water heater. Also, there
              in size from 30 gallons to 65 gallons. For a family of            should be a union between the shutoff and the water
              four, a 40- or 50-gallon model should be adequate.                heater so pipes can be easily dismantled for service.

                     TOOLS & MATERIALS
                  Tubing cutter                            Screwdriver          Discharge tube                   Gas supply pipe & fittings
                  Hacksaw                                  MAPP torch kit       Garden hose                      Copper soldering supplies
                  Pipe wrenches (2)                        Appliance dolly      Drain pan                        Leak detector solution
                  Adjustable wrench                        Water heater         Pipe thread lubricant            Ball‑type water
                  Channel‑type pliers                      T & P relief valve   Vent pipe elbow                     shutoff valve

   116        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 116 24/9/18 5:48 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 116 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:116

                                                                            Use armored cable or wires housed in metal conduit to bring
                                                                            electrical power to electric water heaters. The armored
                                                                            cable or conduit should enter the top of the unit through a
                                                                            conduit clamp.

       The nameplate on the side of a water heater lists tank capacity,
       insulation R-value, and working pressure (pounds per square
       inch). More efficient water heaters have an insulation R-value of
       7 or higher. The nameplate for an electric water heater includes
       the voltage and the wattage capacity of the heating elements
       and thermostats. New water heaters also have a yellow energy
       guide label that lists typical yearly operating costs.

                                  Union fitting or connector coupling          Flexible copper
                                                                                   gas line

                                                                Regulator

                                                  Gas port                        Flare nut
                                  Nipple

                                  Tee fitting                                   Brass union

                                           3" or 6" nipple

                                                                                    Black
                                                                                    pipe
    Nipple
                                     Sediment trap                                threaded
                                                                                   nipple

        Cap

                                                                                Union fitting

       Install a sediment trap between the gascock and the gas
       port on your gas water heater. A sediment trap is simply a
       vertical pipe nipple that is installed at the base of the union
       to allow any impurities in the fuel to collect rather than being
       drawn into the combustion chamber through the port. In               If your house has soft copper gas supply lines, use a flare
       most cases it is easier to locate the sediment trap at the           fitting to connect an additional threaded nipple from the black
       water heater connection point, not the gascock fitting on the        pipe assembly that connects to the water heater regulator. If
       supply pipe.                                                         you have black pipe supply lines, use a union fitting.

                                                                                                   INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   117

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 117 24/9/18 5:48 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 117 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:117

                                        Gas Water Heater                                             Electric Water Heater
                                                                                       A                        E
                              K

                     A
                                                                                                                                  F
                                    B
                                                                                   B

                                                                          F
                                                                                                                                          G

                                                                          G

                                                                               C
                                                                                                                                      H

                 C                                                        H
                                                                                                                                      I

                                                                                                                                      J

                  D
                                                                               D
                                                                                                                                      K
                                                                          I
                     E

                                                                          J

                                                                                                                            L

                                                                                                                                  M

                                     Gas water heater parts include:                              Electric water heater parts can include:
                                         (A) Draft hood and vent                                          (A) Cold water inlet pipe
                                        (B) Cold water inlet pipe                                         (B) Cold water inlet valve
                                                  (C) Tank                                                      (C) Insulation
                                               (D) Dip tube                                                     (D) Draincock
                                              (E) Gas burner                                              (E) Hot water outlet pipe
                                           (F) Hot water outlet                                    (F) Temperature/pressure relief valve
                                  (G) Temperature/pressure relief valve                                        (G) Power cable
                                              (H) Anode rod                                       (H) Upper heating element thermostat
                                              (I) Thermostat                                             (I) Upper heating element
                                            (J) Thermocouple                                                     (J) Bracket
                                        (K) Cold water inlet valve                                     (K) Lower heating thermostat
                                                                                                         (L) Lower heating element
                                                                                                                 (M) Gasket
              Gas water heaters operate on either propane or natural gas      Electric water heaters require 240-volt service, which might
              and are generally very economical to run. They do cost a bit    overload your service panel if you are replacing a gas heater
              more than electric heaters up front. The installation on the    with an electric model. Their primary advantages are that they
              next page features a gas water heater. Check with your local    are cheaper to purchase (but not to operate) and they do not
              building department to find out if homeowners are allowed to    require that you make gas connections.
              install gas appliances in your municipality.

   118        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 118 24/9/18 5:48 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 118 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:118

                  How to Remove a Water Heater

            1

                                                                                                                                        2
       Shut off the gas supply at the stopcock installed in the gas line     Drain the water from the old heater by hooking a garden hose
       closest to the water heater. The handle of the stopcock should        up to the sillcock drain and running it to a floor drain. If you
       be perpendicular to the gas supply pipe. Also shut off the            don't have a floor drain, drain the water into buckets. For your
       water supply. Shut off power to the water heater if it is electric.   personal safety, wait until the water heater has been shut off
                                                                             for a couple of hours before draining it.

            3
       Disconnect the gas supply from the water heater. To do so, loosen the flare fitting with two wrenches or
       pliers in a soft copper supply line, or loosen the union fitting with two pipe wrenches for black pipe supply
       lines (right).                                                                                                              (continued)

                                                                                                    INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   119

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 119 24/9/18 5:48 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 119 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:119

                    4                                                             5

              Disconnect the vent pipe from the draft hood by withdrawing     Cut the water supply lines. Prior to cutting, shut off the cold
              the sheet metal screws connecting the parts. Also remove        water supply either at the stop valve downline from the heater
              vent pipes up to and including the elbow so you may inspect     or at the water meter. Replace the shutoff valve with a new
              them for corrosion buildup and replace if needed.               ball-type shutoff valve.

                                                                                      INSTALL A RELIEF VALVE

                    6
                                                                                    Prepare the new water heater for installation. Before you
              Remove the old water heater and dispose of it properly. Most          put the water heater in place, add a T & P relief valve at
              trash collection companies will haul it away for $20 or $30.          the valve opening. Make sure to read the manufacturer’s
              Don’t simply leave it out at the curb unless you know that is         instructions and purchase the recommended valve type.
              allowed by your municipal waste collection department. A              Lubricate the threads and tighten the valve into the
              two-wheel truck or appliance dolly is a big help here. Water          valve opening with a pipe wrench.
              heaters usually weigh around 150 pounds.

   120        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 120 24/9/18 5:48 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 120 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:120

                  How to Install a Gas Water Heater
                                                                                  Attach a discharge tube to the T & P relief valve. You may use
                                                                                  either copper pipe or CPVC drain pipe. Cut the tube so the
                                                                                  free end is between 1½ and 6" above the floor. If you have
                                                                                  floorcoverings you wish to protect, add a 90° elbow and a
                                                                                  copper drain tube that leads from the discharge tube to a
                                                                                  floor drain.

                                                                                                                                              2

                       Hose bib

                                                                       Drip pan

            1
       Remove the old unit and position the new unit in the
       installation area. A drip pan is required if the water heater
       is installed where a leak could cause damage. This usually
       means anywhere except a crawlspace or an unfinished
       basement. If the water heater is not level, level it by shimming
       under the bottom with a metal or composite shim.

                                                                                                                                     Option

                                                                                      4
                                                                                  Attach approved supply connectors to
                                                                                  the inlet and outlet ports at the top
                                                                                  of the appliance. Flexible connectors
            3                                                                     are much easier to work with, but you
                                                                                  may use copper tubing if you prefer. If
                                                                                  using copper, you’ll need a red-coded
       Attach the draft hood for the flue to the top of the unit with the         copper nipple for the outlet port and a
       provided hardware. Attach any other connector parts that are               blue-coded copper nipple for the inlet
       not preattached according to the manufacturer’s instructions.              port (inset).                                         (continued)

                                                                                                         INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   121

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 121 24/9/18 5:48 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 121 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:121

                                                                              Assemble the vent and attach the end to the draft hood for
                                                                              the flue.

                                                                                  6

                    5
              Join the supply connectors to the supply tubing with approved
              couplings. If the supply line feeding the water heater has no
              shutoff valve nearby, it is recommended that you add one. As
              long as there is a shutoff on the incoming supply side you do
              not need one on the outgoing (hot water) line.

                                                                                                                                          7
                                                                              Begin making the gas connections. Working with gas pipes
                                                                              and tubing is dangerous, and you should only attempt it if
                                                                              you have considerable experience in this skill area. If you are
              OPTION: If you are running a new vent, you will most            not comfortable working with gas pipe, hire a plumber to take
              likely need to use an elbow fitting and adjustable              on this part of the job. Begin by screwing the male-threaded
              fittings to achieve the configuration you need. The new         union securely into the gas regulator port. Wrap gas-approved
              vent should be inspected and approved by your local             lubricating tape around the threads first. Tighten with
              building department.                                            channel-type pliers, taking care not to overtighten or cause
                                                                              undue pressure on the regulator.

   122        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 122 24/9/18 5:48 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 122 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:122

            8

                                                                                                                                     9
       Connect a flexible gas supply tube to the port on a shutoff      Turn on the gas supply and test the gas connections with testing
       valve on the gas supply line. The shutoff must be within         solution (inset) to make sure there are no leaks—do not use
       six feet of the appliance. Connect the other end to the          dish soap or any other products that may contain chlorides.
       union at the regulator. Wrap the threads in each threaded        Make sure the tank drain valve is closed, then turn on the water
       connection with three or four tight courses of gas-rated         supply and check for water leaks. Once you have determined
       lubricating tape first. Include a sediment trap in the hook-up   there are no plumbing leaks, light the pilot light (the instructions
       (see page 117).                                                  are always printed on a label near the pilot light).

              HOOKING UP ELECTRIC WATER HEATERS

          The fuel supply connection is the only part of installing     Temperature adjustments on electric water heaters are
          an electric water heater that differs from installing a gas   made by tightening or loosening a thermostat adjustment
          heater, except that electric heaters do not require a vent.   screw located near the heating element. Always shut off
          The branch circuit wires (240 volts) are twisted together     power to the unit before making an adjustment. In this
          with mating wires in the access panel located at the top of   photo you can see how close the live terminals for the
          the unit.                                                     heating element are to the thermostat.

                                                                                                INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                  123

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 123 24/9/18 5:48 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 123 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:123

              Tankless Water Heater
              A tankless water heater, as its name indicates, does
              not keep a tankful of hot water at all times. It heats
              water only when a hot-water faucet is opened, and
              so is also called an “on-demand” water heater. A
              tankless unit can cost a good deal more initially than
              a standard tank unit, but it typically saves enough in
              energy costs to pay back the investment within three
              to five years. Another advantage: you’ll never run out
              of hot water.
                  Consult with your salesperson to choose a
              unit large enough to supply all the hot water you
              may simultaneously need. The model shown, for
              instance, is rated at nearly 200,000 BTUs and can
              supply up to 9.5 gallons per minute (GPM), enough
              hot water for two or three faucets (including
              shower faucets) or appliances at a time. In
              addition to a whole-house unit such as this, you
              may also purchase a smaller “point-of-use” unit
              to supply hot water for, say, a single bathroom.
              Many of these units are small enough to fit inside
              a cabinet.
                  The following pages show installing a gas-fired
              condensing tankless water heater, which is more
              efficient than non-condensing units. It requires
              running two PVC vent pipes out the wall or roof.
                  This is a pretty ambitious project but within
              reach of a do-it-yourselfer with good plumbing skills.
              Consult with your local building department and get
              a permit before starting work. You will likely need to
              have the project inspected.
                  Select a suitable location, perhaps right where                     A tankless water heater can be installed near the old water
              the old tank unit was. Always read and follow the                       heater’s location to minimize new water and gas pipe runs. It
              manufacturer’s installation instructions. It should be                  takes up far less space than a standard tank heater. The unit
              near the main cold-water supply pipe and a hot-water                    shown on the following pages is a gas-fired condensing unit,
                                                                                      which requires two vent pipes; non-condensing units have only
              pipe leading to the house’s faucets and appliances.
                                                                                      one vent pipe. Vent pipes run outside the house at a downward
              You will need an electrical receptacle and gas supply                   slope. There are connections and valves for a gas supply, a
              line to run vent pipes out the wall or up through                       cold-water supply, and a hot-water line to the house, and the
              the roof.                                                               unit can simply be plugged into a 120-volt electrical receptacle.

                     TOOLS & MATERIALS
                  Tankless water heater                    Tubing cutter              Pipe straps                      Solder & flux
                     with thermostat                       Saw for cutting PVC pipe   Screws                           Black gas pipe
                  Drill with screwdriver bit               Propane torch              PVC pipe                            with pipe dope
                     & hole saw                                                                                        Shutoff valves
                                                           Level                      PVC primer & cement
                  Channel‑type pliers                                                                                     for water & gas
                                                           Electrical tools           Copper supply pipe
                  Pipe wrench                                                                                          T & P valve

   124        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 124 24/9/18 5:48 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 124 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:124

                  How to Install a Tankless Water Heater
       Position the water heater away from
       combustible materials and where it can                                                Exhaust vent pipe
       be easily accessed for servicing. Mount
       the unit securely to a wall using the
       brackets provided, driving screws into
       studs. If the wall is masonry, use masonry
       screws or lag screws with shields.

            1
                                                                                                                                                     Air intake pipe

                                                                                                                        Condensate drain fitting

                                                                                                                             Tube to floor drain

                                                                       2
                                                               Plan the path for the exhaust vent pipe and the air intake pipes, which must exit the
                                                               house at a recommended location (if the exit location is a house wall, the distance
                                                               from windows and eaves must meet manufacturers’ requirements). Cut PVC pipe
                                                               and assemble with fittings using primer and cement. If you live in a cold climate,
                                                               on the air intake pipe, install a condensate drain fitting at a convenient point for
                                                               running the drain tube to a floor drain.

                                                                                             Minimum clearance above
          3                                                                                   anticipated snow level                                Cap

                                                                                                    Adjustable roof flashing

                                                                                                                Support clamp

                                                                                                                Air intake pipe
                                                                                                                                                Exhaust
                                                                                                        Slope                                  vent pipe

                                                                                         Support                                          Condensation
                                                                                         hanger                                              drain
       Run the pipes out of the house. Make sure all
       horizontally run pipes slope slightly downward, and                           If venting out a wall is not feasible, you may need to run the
       support pipes with straps. Using the parts from a                             pipes up and out the roof. In this case, all horizontal runs
       “termination kit,” cut two holes for the pipes, slip on                       should be sloped upward, so condensed water runs back into
       interior flanges, and run the pipes through the flanges                       the water heater. In the attic, join the two pipes together with
       and out the wall. On the outside, attach a termination                        a wye fitting. Run the pipe out the roof, slip on adjustable roof
       cap with screws, and caulk the edges.                                         flashing, cut the pipe to the approved height above the roof,
                                                                                     and add an approved cap to the top of the pipe.
                                                                                                                                              (continued)

                                                                                                                INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                  125

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 125 24/9/18 5:48 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 125 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:125

                                                                                   Turn on the valves to run cold water briefly through the unit
                                                                                   to be sure water flows freely. Close the unit’s shutoff valve,
                                                                                   then remove and clean the
                                            Service valve kit                      water heater’s internal filter
                                                                                   (inset). If there is a good
                                                                                   deal of debris, repeat this
                                                                                   process until the debris
                                                                                   is gone.

                                                                                                            5

                    4
              Hook up the cold‑water connections. If your house has
              copper piping, do not use heat to sweat pipes or fittings that
              are connected to the tankless heater, or you could damage
              internal parts. Buy the service valve kit made for your unit.
              Install a cold-water shutoff valve prior to the connection parts.
              Connect the cold-water parts. Allow them to cool (if you
              sweated copper), then connect to the unit’s valve.

                            Relief valve
                                                                                       7

                                                                         6                                                     Drain valve

              Connect the other parts of the service valve kit. This includes      Connect to the house’s hot‑water line. Provide for a drain valve
              another valve for the hot water, as well as a relief valve. Extend   as shown, so you can drain the tank for service. As with the
              the relief valve’s pipe down to a point near where it can run        cold-water line (step 4), if the pipes are copper, do not heat
              to a floor drain. Also run a drain tube from the unit to a floor     any pipes or fittings while they are connected to the heater.
              drain or utility sink.

   126        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 126 24/9/18 5:48 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 126 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:126

                                                                             9

                                                                                                                       To tankless heater

            8
       Hook up the gas connection. Working with black gas pipe,          Connect the thermostat. Connect two-wire thermostat cable
       install a gas shutoff valve just below the unit, then install a   to the unit (inset) and run it to a convenient location for
       union so you can easily disconnect the pipes for servicing.       controlling the water heater. Attach the thermostat’s plate to
       Connect the other pipes as shown; make sure to include a          the wall and run the cable through it. Attach the wires to the
       vertical sediment trap. Turn on the gas and test with leak        back of the thermostat’s cover, and snap on the cover.
       detector solution to make sure there are no leaks.

                                                                                                   11

           10
       Test the water heater. Turn on the water supply and plug the unit into an electrical     Program the thermostat. Turn off the gas
       receptacle. Make sure you know which circuit breaker controls the water heater.          and water to the water heater by closing
       When there is a demand for hot water (from a faucet or appliance), the water heater      the shutoff valves, and follow the
       will turn on automatically and an electric spark will ignite the gas.                    manufacturer’s instructions for setting
                                                                                                the water temperature.

                                                                                                INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   127

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 127 24/9/18 5:48 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 127 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:127

              Lavatory Faucets

              B    athroom faucets come in four basic mounting
                   styles: centerset, single hole, wall mounted, and
              widespread. The type you choose depends largely on
                                                                           TOOLS & MATERIALS
                                                                         Heatproof grease                Adjustable wrench
              the sink or faucet body you are using—the new faucet
              may need to match the existing fixture. But in any         Teflon tape                     Basin wrench
              case, the range of designs available in all mounting       Measuring tape                  Channel‑type pliers
              styles is astounding.                                      Loctite                         Screwdriver
                  Widespread faucets have a clean, sophisticated         Pipe‑joint compound             Standing flashlight
              look. They come in three pieces instead of one: a hot
                                                                         Plumber’s putty                 Eye & ear protection
              tap, a cold tap, and a spout. Each piece is mounted
              separately in its own hole in the sink. The hot and        New 3‑piece faucet              Work gloves
              cold taps (valves) are connected to the spout with         Supply lines
              reinforced flexible hoses. If your lavatory doesn’t
              have a predrilled flange, the great advantage to the
              widespread configuration is that you gain flexibility       Single-body and centerset faucets are designed to fit
              in locating your spout and handles (probably a bigger    into standard hole configurations. Make sure you know
              advantage for tubs than for lavatories). Even models     your sink’s dimensions before buying the faucet: the
              made for bathroom lavatories, such as the one you see    most important dimension is the hole spread: 4 inches
              here, offer many creative configuration options.         on center and 8 inches on center are most common.

                   An increasingly popular subset
                   of single-hole faucets are
                   touch faucets or motion-sensing
                   faucets, such as the one shown
                   here. Easy to install, these are
                   also less challenging for anyone
                   with motor-skill difficulties or
                   serious disabilities to use.

   128        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 128 24/9/18 5:48 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 128 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:128

             BASIC LAVATORY FAUCET TYPES

          Widespread faucets allow you to customize the locations         Single‑body faucets are faster and easier to install and are
          and orientation of the faucets and spout in your sink deck.     extremely reliable.

                                                                               Pop-up stopper lift rod                Spout
                                                            Index caps       Handle screw
                                   Spout
                                                                                     Handle                         Aerator
                                                              Handles

                                                                                Tailpiece
                Aerator                                                                                                 Tailpiece

                                                                                                                  ½" coupling nuts
                    Spout                                                            Lift rod
                  tailpiece
                                                               Faucet
                                                               valves
                     T-fitting                                                         Clevis

                               Flex tube                                                                                  Pivot rod

                                                                               Supply risers

                                                              Supply                                                     Stop valves
                                                               risers

          Widespread faucets come in three pieces: a spout and two        The tailpieces of a standard deck‑mounted, one-piece
          valves. Supply risers carry hot and cold water to the valves,   bathroom sink faucet are 4" apart on center. As long as
          which are turned to regulate the amount of water going to       the 2 outside holes in the back of your sink measure 4"
          the spout, where the water is mixed. Water travels from the     from center to center, and you have a middle hole for a
          valves to the spout through flex tubes, which in turn attach    pop-up stopper, you can put in any standard one-piece
          to the spout tailpiece via a T-fitting. Three-piece faucets     bathroom faucet with a pop-up stopper. The faucet is
          designed to work with a pop-up stopper have a clevis and        secured to the sink with mounting nuts that screw onto
          a lift rod. The handles attach with handle screws that are      the tailpieces from below. Also get two flexible stainless-
          covered with index caps. An aerator is screwed on the           steel supply risers for sinks long enough to replace the old
          faucet spout after debris is flushed from the faucet.           tubes. These typically attach to the stop valves with 3⁄8"
                                                                          compression-sized coupling nuts and to the faucet with
                                                                          standard faucet coupling nuts. But take your old tubes and
                                                                          the old compression nuts from the stop valves to the store
                                                                          to ensure a match. The clevis, lift rod, and pivot rod are
                                                                          parts of the pop-up stopper assembly. The handles attach
                                                                          with handle screws that are covered with index caps.

                                                                                                 INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   129

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 129 24/9/18 5:48 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 129 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:129

                          How to Install a Widespread Faucet

                                                                                                  NOTE: Shown from behind
                                                                                             with backsplash cut away for clarity.

                                                                       1           2
              Shut off the water to the existing faucet and open the valves    Clean away any existing plumber’s putty or sealant from the
              to drain the water. Disconnect the water supply tubes from       surface of the sink, then lay a new bead of plumbers putty
              the faucet, and remove the old faucet by unscrewing the          around each of the three openings. Install the two valves into
              mounting nuts.                                                   the sink cutout openings by inserting the spout and valves
                                                                               and then threading the mounting screws onto the tailpieces
              NOTE: Removing the old faucet and installing the new one         from below the sink.
              may be easiest if you remove the sink from the vanity.

                                                                       3           4
              Exact mounting procedures vary; our faucet has retainer          Repeat this procedure to install the center spout. Make sure
              screws that are tightened after the mounting nut is threaded     the spout is aligned correctly to be perpendicular to the back
              over the tailpieces. This secures the valves and spout tightly   of the sink.
              to the sink.

   130        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 130 24/9/18 5:48 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 130 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:130

                                                                       5       6
       Tighten the spout mounting nut securely. A basin wrench             Attach the water connection tubes from the valve tailpieces to
       will make this easier, since access to the mounting nut may         the spout tailpiece. Thread the mounting nuts by hand, then
       be difficult.                                                       tighten slightly with channel-type pliers or an adjustable wrench
                                                                           (in tight quarters, this can also be done with a basin wrench).

                                                                       7       8
       Connect water‑supply tubes from the water shutoff valves to         Attach the drain‑stopper linkage to the push rod and to the
       the water-supply tubes on the faucet-valve tailpieces using an      stopper pivot lever.
       adjustable wrench (or basin wrench, where access is limited).
       In standard practice, the hot water normally connects to
       the left faucet valve and the cold water to the right. Turn
       on the water and test the faucet. If any fittings leak, tighten
       them slightly until they are watertight.

                                                                                                  INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   131

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 131 24/9/18 5:48 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 131 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:131

                     VARIATION: HOW TO INSTALL A SINGLE‑BODY FAUCET
                                                                                                           High‑quality faucets come with
                                                                                                           flexible plastic gaskets that create a
                                                                                                1          durable watertight seal at the bottom
                                                                                                           of the faucet where it meets the
                                                                                                           sink deck. However, an inexpensive
                                                                                                           faucet may have a flimsy-looking
                                                                                                           foam seal that doesn’t do a good
                                                                                                           job of sealing and disintegrates after
                                                                                                           a few years. If that is the case with
                                                                                                           your faucet, discard the seal and
                                                                                                           press a ring of plumber’s putty into
                                                                                                           the sealant groove on the underside
                                                                                                           of the faucet body.

                  Insert the faucet tailpieces through the holes in the sink.
                  From below, thread washers and mounting nuts over the
                  tailpieces, then tighten the mounting nuts with a basin
                  wrench until snug. Put a dab of pipe joint compound on
                  the threads of the stop valves and thread the metal nuts
                  of the flexible supply risers to these. Wrench tighten about
                  a half-turn past hand tight. Overtightening these nuts will
                  strip the threads. Now tighten the coupling nuts to the
                  faucet tailpieces with a basin wrench.

                       2
                              Coupling nut

                              Flexible sink
                                                                                        3
                              supply riser
                                                                                    Slide the lift rod of the new faucet into its hole behind the
                                                                                    spout. Thread it into the clevis past the clevis screw. Push
                                                                                    the pivot rod all the way down so the stopper is open. With
                                                                                    the lift rod also all the way down, tighten the clevis to the
                                                                                    lift rod.

                       4
                                                        Grease the fluted valve
                                                        stems with faucet grease,
                                                        then put the handles in
                                                        place. Tighten the handle
                                                        screws firmly, so they
                                                        won’t come loose during
                                                        operation. Cover each
                                                        handle screw with the
                                                        appropriate index cap—
                                                        Hot or Cold.                    5
                                                                                    Unscrew the aerator from the end of the spout. Turn the hot
                                                                                    and cold water taps on full. Turn the water back on at the
                                                                                    stop valves and flush out the faucet for a couple of minutes
                                                                                    before turning off the water at the faucet. Check the riser
                                                                                    connections for drips. Tighten a compression nut only until
                                                                                    the drip stops. Replace the aerator.

   132        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 132 24/9/18 5:48 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 132 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:132

                                                                           TOOLS & MATERIALS
                                                                         Faucet and hardware           Flashlight
                                                                         Adjustable wrenches           Eye & ear protection
                                                                         Channel‑type pliers           Work gloves
                                                                         Teflon tape
       Hands-Free
       Bathroom Faucets                                                model we selected for this installation project uses an
                                                                       electrical field sensor that reacts to the stored charge
                                                                       in every human body, called capacitance. Whether
                                                                       motion or touch activated, these home faucets rely

       I f you’ve ever washed your hands in an airport
         bathroom, chances are you’ve already come across
       a hands-free faucet. Developed to conserve water and
                                                                       on an electrical field created by a solenoid connected
                                                                       to the faucet body. When a human hand disrupts
                                                                       the electrical field, the faucet turns on or off. Touch
       stop the spread of disease, these faucets have quickly          faucets operate the same, but the faucet body itself is
       become ubiquitous in commercial facilities across the           the electrical field.
       country and around the world.                                       For most of these types of faucets, water
           But now homeowners can enjoy the benefits of                temperature and flow rate are set manually before the
       hands-free faucets in their own bathrooms. Although             faucet is “programmed.” Then it’s a case of tapping the
       not as widely available as standard faucets, different          faucet body or waving a hand near it to start or stop
       hands-free units are beginning to appear in the                 the flow.
       aisles of large home centers and hardware stores                    Although these faucets are pricier than standard
       nationwide. These feature varying technologies                  manual models, they represent a leap forward for
       depending on the manufacturer.                                  people with motor-skill difficulties or for preventing
           The most common type of commercial hands-free               disease spread between family members using
       bathroom faucet relies on an infrared motion sensor,            a busy bathroom in a crowded house. The good
       much like those in home-security systems. When                  news is that they are not much more challenging to
       something solid passes within the sensor’s range, the           install than a standard faucet—with the exception
       faucet turns on for a predetermined period of time.             of units that are hardwired into the home’s electrical
       Home units operate a little differently. They include           system. Hardwired units should be installed by a
       motion-sensing and “touch-on, touch-off ” units. The            licensed professional.

                                                                                          A touch‑on, touch‑off faucet such as
                                                                                          this can save water, make life easier
                                                                                          for children and physically challenged
                                                                                          users, and they come in a nice
                                                                                          selection of style and finish options.

                                                                                            INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   133

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 133 24/9/18 5:48 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 133 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:133

                          How to Install a Hands-Free Faucet
              Check the parts in the box against the
              instruction-sheet part list. Remove
              the center from the base gasket as                       1
              necessary, and thread the base’s LED
              wire through the hole in the gasket.
              Seat the gasket into the groove in the
              insulator base and ensure that it is snug
              and level.

              NOTE: If your vanity deck has multiple
              holes, you’ll need to use the supplied
              escutcheon plate. Run the LED wire
              through the escutcheon hole and
              seat the insulator base on top of the
              escutcheon (make sure the LED light
              is facing forward).

              Slide the mounting bracket into place
              under the sink, on the mounting
              post. Be sure that the LED wire and                      2
              supply lines are not crimped by the
              bracket. The mounting bracket needs
              to be oriented correctly; check the
              manufacturer’s instructions to ensure
              it’s situated in the right way and
              secured with the metal side down.

              Ensure the LED wire is not crimped,
              and thread the mounting-post nut
              on the mounting post. Hand-tighten.                      3
              Check again that the faucet body is
              positioned correctly on the top of the
              sink and the LED light is facing forward.
              Tighten the mounting nut with a
              wrench or with the tool supplied by the
              manufacturer, as shown here.

   134        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 134 24/9/18 5:49 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 134 2/10/18 10:56 AM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:134

                                                                               5

                                                                       4
       Insert the outlet tube into the top of the solenoid until it is     Slide the feeder hose into the bottom of the solenoid until
       snugly attached. Secure the tube in place with the metal clip       it is snug. Snap the attachment clip in place to secure the
       provided. These clips can often be attached more than one           hose, and again pull gently on the hose to make sure the clip
       way, so check the instructions to make sure you’ve installed the    is secure.
       clip correctly. Then, lightly pull on the solenoid to ensure the
       tube is firmly attached and won’t come free under pressure.

                                                                               7

                                                                       6
       Touch the cold supply knob or another ground with your hand         Slide the solenoid ground wire onto the mounting post and
       to dissipate any residual static charge. Remove the protective      secure it in place with a nut. Tighten the nut with a wrench,
       cap or endpiece from the end of the LED wire hanging from           ensuring that the wires don’t twist together. Put the batteries in
       the faucet. Plug the prong of the wire into the hole in the         the battery box, and then connect the wire from the solenoid
       solenoid. Make sure it is all the way in (on this model, you        to the connection on the battery box. Secure the battery box to
       push until you hear a click).                                       the cabinet floor, wall, or underside of the sink according to the
                                                                           manufacturer’s directions and the type of vanity you have.

                                                                                                  INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   135

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 135 24/9/18 5:49 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 135 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:135

              Lavatory Drains

              P    op-up stoppers are chrome-plated, long-legged
                   plugs in bathroom sinks that are opened and closed
              with a knob behind the spout. The stopper itself is
                                                                        assemblies, assuming they use one, but you may also
                                                                        purchase one by itself. This will include everything from
                                                                        the stopper to the pipe that drops into the trap. Choose
              just the visible part of a behind-the-scenes assembly     a pop-up stopper assembly that’s heavy brass under
              that makes sure the stopper sits and stands on cue.       the chrome finish. This will hold up better to time and
              New faucets come with their own pop-up stopper            abuse than a plastic or light-gauge metal model.

              Installing a lavatory drain
              is a bit trickier than
              installing a kitchen-sink
              drain because most
              have a pop-up stopper
              with linkage.

   136        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 136 24/9/18 5:49 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 136 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:136

                                                                                                                   Pop-up stoppers keep objects from
                                                                                                                   falling down the drain, and they make
                                                                                                                   filling and draining the sink easy. When
                           Stopper                                                Surface of
                                                             Flange
                                                                                                                   you pull up on the lift rod, the clevis
                                                                                  sink basin
                                                                                                                   strap is raised, which raises the pivot
                                                                                                                   rod, which seesaws on the pivot ball
                                                                                                                   and pulls the pop-up stopper down
              Pop‑up                                                                                               against the flange. This blocks water
                                                                 Hollow channel
           stopper body
                                                                for overflow water                                 through the sink drain, but water may
              Rubber                                                                                               still overflow into the overflow channel
              gasket                                                                                               drain through overflow ports in the
                                                                                           Clevis                  pop-up body. This is a nice feature
                                                                                            strap                  if you leave the water running in a
                                                                                  Underside                        plugged basin by mistake.
          Nylon                                                                    of sink
                                                                       Lock nut
          washer

                                                                           Pivot ball gasket

                                                                            Pivot ball and rod

               Drain
             tailpiece

                                                                   Retaining nut           Spring clip
                                                                                         on the pivot rod

                                                                                                                   The lavatory drain trap holds water that
                                                                                                                   seals the drain line and prevents sewer
                                                                                                                   gases from entering the home. Each
                                                                                                                   time a drain is used, the standing trap
                                                                                                                   water is flushed away and replaced by
                                                                   Sink                                            new water. The shape of the trap and
         Supply tube                                                                                               fixture drain line resembles the letter P,
                                                                                                                   so sink traps are called P-traps.

                                                          Clevis

                                                           Drain stopper
                                                             pivot rod

                                           Fixture
                                          drain line

                                             Drain trap

           Shutoff valve

                                                    Standing water

                                                                                                                   INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   137

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 137 24/9/18 5:49 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 137 2/10/18 11:46 AM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:137

                          How to Replace a Pop-Up Stopper

                    1                         Lock nuts
                                                                            Pop-up drain                                    Bottom of sink            2
                                                                              tailpiece
                                                                                                 Clevis

                                                                                                                                                 Stopper
                                                                                              Spring clip                                         body
                                                                                                                      Cap
                        Trap arm

                                                                                                                         Ball-and-
                                                                                                                         pivot rod

                                              Trap J-bend

              Put a basin under the trap to catch water. Loosen the nuts                   Unscrew the cap holding the ball‑and‑pivot rod in the pop-up
              at the outlet and inlet to the trap J-bend by hand or with                   body and withdraw the ball. Compress the spring clip on
              channel-type pliers, and remove the bend. The trap will slide                the clevis, and withdraw the pivot rod from the clevis.
              off the pop-up body tailpiece when the nuts are loose. Keep
              track of washers and nuts and their up/down orientation by
              leaving them on the tubes.

                    3                                                                                                                                 4

                                                                                              Wrap tape
                                                                                             in clockwise
                                                                                               direction

                                                                                                                        Stopper
                                                                                                                         body

                            Stopper
                                                                       Flange

              Remove the pop‑up stopper. Then, from below, remove the                      Clean the drain opening above and below, and then thread the
              lock nut on the stopper body. If needed, keep the flange from                locknut all the way down the new pop-up body followed by the
              turning by inserting a large screwdriver in the drain from the               flat washer and the rubber gasket (beveled side up). Wrap three
              top. Thrust the stopper body up through the hole to free                     layers of Teflon tape clockwise onto the top of the threaded
              the flange from the basin, and then remove the flange and the                body. Make a ½"-diameter snake from plumber’s putty, form it
              stopper body.                                                                into a ring, and stick the ring underneath the drain flange.

   138        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 138 24/9/18 5:49 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 138 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:138

                                                                       5                                                              6

                                                                                                    Stopper in drain

                   Plumber’s
                     putty

       From below, face the pivot-rod opening directly back toward         Drop the pop‑up stopper into the drain hole so the hole at the
       the middle of the faucet and pull the body straight down            bottom of its post is closest to the back of the sink. Put
       to seat the flange. Thread the locknut/washer assembly              the beveled nylon washer into the opening in the back of the
       up under the sink, then fully tighten the locknut with              pop-up body with the bevel facing back.
       channel-type pliers. Do not twist the flange in the process,
       as this can break the putty seal. Clean off the squeezeout of
       plumber’s putty from around the flange.

                                  Clevis                               7                                                              8
                          Adjust so clevis
                            is vertical
                                                                                                                    Clevis screw

       Put the cap behind the ball on the pivot rod, as shown.             Loosen the clevis screw holding the clevis strap to the lift
       Sandwich a hole in the clevis with the spring clip and thread       rod. Push the pivot rod all the way down (which fully opens
       the long end of the pivot rod through the clip and clevis.          the pop-up stopper). With the lift rod also all the way down,
       Put the ball end of the pivot rod into the pop-up body opening      tighten the clevis screw to the rod. If the clevis runs into the
       and into the hole in the stopper stem. Screw the cap onto the       top of the trap, cut it short with your hacksaw or tin snips.
       pop-up body over the ball.                                          Reassemble the J-bend trap.

                                                                                                   INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                  139

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 139 24/9/18 5:49 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 139 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:139

              Shower Kits

              T    he fastest and easiest way to create
                   a new shower in your bathroom is
              to frame in the stall area with lumber
              and drywall and then install a shower
              enclosure kit. Typically consisting of
              three fiberglass or plastic walls, these
              enclosure kits snap together at the
              corners and nestle inside the flanges
              of the shower pan (also called the
              receptor) to create nearly foolproof
              mechanical seals. Often, the walls are
              formed with shelves, soap holders,
              and other conveniences.
                  If you are on a tight budget, you
              can find extremely inexpensive
              enclosure kits to keep costs down.
              You can even create your own custom
              enclosure using waterproof beadboard
              panels and snap-together connectors.
              Or, you can invest in a higher grade
              kit made from thicker material that
              will last much longer. Some kits are
              sold with the receptor (and perhaps
              even the door) included. The kit
              shown here is designed to be attached
              directly to wall studs, but others
                                                                       A paneled shower surround is inexpensive and easy to install. Designed
              require a backer wall for support. The                   for alcove installations, they often are sold with matching shower pans
              panels are attached to the backer with                   (called receptors). A shower surround requires a minimum of 80" of clear ceiling
              high-tack panel adhesive.                                height and 24" of clear opening area in front of the shower.

                     TOOLS & MATERIALS
                  Tape measure                    Strap wrench              Hacksaw                  Showerhead                  Jigsaw
                  Pencil                          Adjustable wrench         Masking tape             Faucet                      Duct tape
                  Hammer                          Pliers                    Silicone caulk           Plumbing supplies           Miter box
                  Carpenter’s square              Drill/driver                  & caulk gun          Panel adhesive              Eye & ear protection
                  Screwdrivers                    Center punch              Shower enclosure kit     Spud wrench                 Work gloves
                  Pipe wrench                     File                      Pan (receptor)           Large‑head
                  Level                           Utility knife             Shower door                 roofing nails

   140        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 140 24/9/18 5:49 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 140 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:140

                  How to Install a Shower Enclosure
       Mark out the location of the shower, including any new
       walls, on the floor and walls. Most kits can be installed
       over cementboard, but you can usually achieve a more
       professional-looking wall finish if you remove the wallcovering
       and floor covering in the installation area. Dispose of the
       materials immediately, and thoroughly clean the area.

            1
                                                                                                                             Sill plate

                                                                             2
                                                                         If you are adding a wall to create the alcove, lay out the
                                                                         locations for the studs and plumbing on the new wood sill
                                                                         plate. Also lay out the stud locations on the cap plate that
                                                                         will be attached to the ceiling. Refer to the enclosure kit
                                                                         instructions for exact locations and dimensions of studs.
                                                                         Attach the sill plate to the floor with deck screws and panel
                                                                         adhesive, making sure it is square to the back wall and the
                                                                         correct distance from the side wall.

                                                                                                                       New wall stud

                                                                                                                                  4

                                                                                 Install the 2 × 4 studs at the outlined locations.
                                                                                 Check with a level to make sure each stud
            3                                                                    is plumb, and then attach them by driving
                                                                                 deck screws toenail style into the sill plate and
                                                                                 cap plate.
       Align a straight 2 × 4 right next to the sill plate and make a
       mark on the ceiling. Use a level to extend that line directly
       above the sill plate. Attach the cap plate at that point.                                                               (continued)

                                                                                                 INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                  141

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 141 24/9/18 5:49 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 141 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:141

                                              Drain location

                    5                                                                  6
              Cut an access hole in the floor for the drain, according to the      Install a drain pipe and branch line, and then trim the drain
              installation manual instructions. Drill openings in the sill plate   pipe flush with the floor. If you are not experienced with
              of the wet wall (the new wall in this project) for the supply        plumbing, hire a plumber to install the new drain line.
              pipes, also according to the instructions.

                                          Faucet body
                                                                          7

                                                      Cross brace

                                          Ball valves

                                 Supply riser                                          8
              Install new supply risers as directed in the instruction manual      If the supply plumbing is located in a wall (old or new) that
              (again, have a plumber do this if necessary). Also install cross     is accessible from the non-shower side, install framing for a
              braces between the studs in the wet wall for mounting the            removable access panel.
              faucet body and shower arm.

   142        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 142 24/9/18 5:49 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 142 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:142

            9                                                             OPTION: To stabilize the receptor, especially if the floor
                                                                          is uneven, pour or trowel a layer of thinset mortar into
                                                                          the installation area, taking care to keep the mortar out
       Attach the drain tailpiece that came with your receptor to         of the drain access hole. Do not apply mortar in areas
       the underside of the unit, following the manufacturer’s            where the receptor has feet that are intended to make full
       instructions precisely. Here, an adjustable spud wrench is         contact with the floor.
       being used to tighten the tailpiece.

                                                                       Lay out the locations for the valve hole or holes in the end
                                                                       wall panel that will be installed on the wet wall. Check your
                                                                       installation instructions. Some kits come with a template
                                                                       marked on the packaging carton. Cut the access hole with
                                                                       a hole saw and drill or with a jigsaw and fine-tooth blade.
                                                                       If using a jigsaw, orient the panel so the good surface is
                                                                       facing down.

                                                                                                                                   11

        10

       Set the receptor in place, check to make
       sure it is level, and shim it if necessary.
       Secure the receptor with large-head
       roofing nails driven into the wall stud
       so the heads pin the flange against the
       stud. Do not overdrive the nails.

                                                                                                                             (continued)

                                                                                              INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   143

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 143 24/9/18 5:49 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 143 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:143

                                                                                  Remove the end wall so you can prepare the installation area
                                                                                  for them. If your kit recommends panel adhesive, apply it to
                                                                                  the wall or studs. In the kit shown here, only a small bead of
                                                                                  silicone sealant on the receptor flange is required.

                                                                                     13

                Clip
             connectors

                                                                       12
              Position the back wall so there is a slight gap (about 1⁄32")
              between the bottom of the panel and the rim of the receptor—set
              a few small spacers on the rim if need be. Tack a pair of roofing
              nails above the top of the back panel to hold it in place (or use
              duct tape). Position both end walls and test the fits. Make clip
              connections between panels (inset) if your kit uses them.

                                                                                     15

                  14
              Reinstall the end panels, permanently clipping them to the          Once the panels are positioned correctly and snapped
              back panel according to the kit manufacturer’s instructions.        together, fasten them to the wall studs. If the panels have
              Make sure the front edges of the end panels are flush with the      predrilled nail holes, drive roofing nails through them at each
              front of the receptor.                                              stud at the panel tops.

   144        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 144 24/9/18 5:49 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 144 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:144

       Install wallcovering material above the enclosure panels and
       anywhere else it is needed. Use cementboard, and maintain a
       gap of ¼" between the shoulders of the top panel flanges and
       the wallcovering.

                                                                       16

                                                                                                                                     17
                                                                            Finish the walls, and then caulk between the enclosure panels
                                                                            and the wallcoverings with tub-and-tile caulk.

           18

                                                                               19
       Install the faucet handles and escutcheon, and caulk around          You can make an access panel out of plywood framed with
       the escutcheon plate. Install the shower arm escutcheon              mitered case molding or buy a ready-made plumbing panel.
       and showerhead.                                                      Attach the panel to the opening created in step 8.

                                                                                                  INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   145

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 145 24/9/18 5:49 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 145 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:145

                          How to Install a Hinged Shower Door
                                                                                  Identify which side jamb will be the hinge jamb and which will
                                                                                  be the strike jamb according to the direction you want your
                  1                                                               hinged door to swing. Prepare the jambs for installation as
                                                                                  directed in your instructions.

                                                                                      2

              Measure the width of the shower opening. If the walls of the
              shower slope inward slightly before meeting the base, take
              your measurement from a higher point at the full width of
              the opening so you don’t cut the door base too short. Cut the
              base piece to fit using a hacksaw and a miter box. File the cut
              ends if necessary to deburr them.

                                                                                  Remove the bottom track and prepare the shower base curb
                                                                                  for installation of the base track, following the manufacturer’s
                                                                                  directions. Permanently install the bottom track. Bottom
                                                                                  tracks (not all doors have them) are usually attached to
                                                                                  the side jambs or held in place with adhesive. Never use
                                                                                  fasteners to secure them to the curb.

                                                                                      4

                    3
              Place the base jamb on the curb of the shower base. If the
              joint where the wall meets the curb is sloped, you’ll need to
              trim the corners of the base piece to follow the profile. Place a
              jamb carefully onto the base, and plumb it with a level. Then,
              mark a drilling point by tapping a centerpunch in the middle
              of each nail hole in each jamb. Remove the jambs, drill pilot
              holes, and then attach the jambs with the provided screws.

   146        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 146 24/9/18 5:49 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 146 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:146

            5                                                                 6
       Working on the floor or another flat surface, attach the door      Attach the hinge to the door panel, according to the
       hinge to the hinge jamb, if required. In most systems, the hinge   manufacturer’s instructions. Attach any cap fitting that keeps
       is fitted over the hinge jamb after you attach it to the wall.     water out of the jamb.

                                                                                                                                  Sweep

            7                                                                 8
       Fit the hinge jamb over the side jamb and adjust it as directed    Install the magnetic strike plate and any remaining caps or
       in your instruction manual. Once the clearances are correct,       accessories, such as towel rods. Also attach the sweep that
       fasten the jambs to hang the door.                                 seals the passage, if provided.

                                                                                                 INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   147

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 147 24/9/18 6:02 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 147 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:147

              Glass-Wall Shower

              O     ne method for creating a quick shower stall is
                    with a glass-wall kit, ideal for small bathrooms.
              It tucks neatly into the corner of your bathroom and
              can make use of either a custom-built shower pan
              (see page 154) or a prefabricated shower pan like
              that commonly used in framed-in alcoves. Many
              such showers come with the base pan as part of the
              kit, while with others you will need to buy or build a
              separate shower pan.
                  The kit we’ve used to demonstrate a glass-wall
              shower installation includes the shower pan, three
              wall pieces (two flat panels and a corner shelf/
              connector unit), and the glass panels and frames
              for the sliding door. All connectors and hardware
              are included, but this isn’t the case with all such
              kits. When buying a shower kit, always examine the
              components and read the instructions carefully to
              see if additional parts and materials are needed.
                  The key to smooth installation with a wall-kit
              shower is making sure the wall panels, frames,
              and shower pan fit squarely in the corners and against
              the existing walls. Walls that are out of square or not
              perfectly flat can complicate this job, so correcting
              faulty walls is time well spent if you’re installing a
              glass-wall shower.
                  Any shower kit will require very diligent and
              careful sealing of the joints using siliconized
              latex caulk and silicone sealant. Do not rush
              this step, as it is crucial to achieving a workable,
              leak-free shower.

                     TOOLS & MATERIALS
                  Glass‑wall shower kit                    Straightedge              Carpenter’s square               Clean cloths
                      with shower pan                      Utility knife             Hammer                           Plastic wall anchors
                  Tape measure                             Silicone sealant          Center punch                     Ear & eye protection
                  Pencil or marker                         Wall (panel) adhesive     Phillips screwdriver             Work gloves
                  4' level                                 Siliconized latex caulk   Masking tape
                  Drill with bits & hole saw               Caulk gun                 Mineral spirits

   148        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 148 24/9/18 5:49 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 148 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:148

                  How to Install a Glass-Wall Shower

            1                                                                  2

       Prepare the floor drain and install a prefabricated shower pan
       in the corner of the room, following the instructions on steps
       5 to 10 on pages 150 to 151. Make sure the outside diameter
       of the drain pipe matches the requirements of the shower
       pan (ours required a 23⁄8" outside diameter for the drain pipe).
       The shower pan must sit perfectly level on the floor and
       tight against the wall studs on the two adjoining walls for the
       installation to proceed smoothly.

                                                                       3

                                                                           Draw centerlines along the top of the outer thresholds of the
                                                                           shower pan. Position one of the metal wall channels vertically
                                                                           against the wall, so the bottom edge is centered on the
                                                                           centerline. Use a level to adjust the wall channel for plumb,
                                                                           then mark the mounting-hole locations on the wall through
                                                                           the holes in the wall channel.

       Drill holes and drive plastic wall anchors for the metal shower
       channels. The plastic wall anchors are included in most
                                                                               5
       shower kits.

            4

                                                                           Fill the gaps between the shower base and the wall with
                                                                           siliconized latex caulk. Install the other wall channel in the
                                                                           same way, and seal the remaining gap between the shower
                                                                           pan and the wall. Lightly sand the top face of the shower pan
       Position the wall channels in place and secure them to the          curbs with the sandpaper included in the kit. This will create
       wall with mounting screws driven through the mounting holes         a better bonding surface when you seal the pan at the end of
       and into the wall anchors.                                          the project.                                         (continued)

                                                                                                  INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   149

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 149 24/9/18 5:49 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 149 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:149

                                                          6                7                                             8

              Prepare the walls in whatever manner                     To prepare the side wall that will contain    Use the template to mark the opening
              recommended by the kit instructions.                     the plumbing fixtures, cut a cardboard        on the wall panel that will hold the
              Test-fit the side panels and the                         template to the same size as the wall         shower plumbing fixtures, then use
              corner panel by taping them in place                     panel and place the template against          an appropriately sized hole saw to cut
              temporarily with masking tape, with the                  the wall. Mark the location of the            openings in the wall panel. Make sure
              shiny side of the panels facing out. The                 shower and faucet on the template.            to align the wall panel correctly when
              wall panels should butt against the wall                 Make an X against this side of the            marking: the shiny side will face into
              channels and rest flat against the shower-               cardboard for reference. Remove the           the shower.
              pan curbs. If the wall panels don’t line                 cardboard template, then use a utility
              up correctly, it indicates that the wall                 knife to cut away openings for the
              channels are out of plumb or the shower                  plumbing stub-outs on the template.
              pan is not level. The corner panel should                Test-fit the cardboard template against
              slightly overlap the side wall panels,                   the wall, making sure the plumbing
              by about ½". Some trimming may be                        pipes fit correctly.
              necessary if the overlap is greater.

                  9a                                                     9b                                                                             9c

              Beginning with the panel without plumbing cutouts, spread a continuous ¼" bead of panel adhesive along the four edges of
              the back of the wall panel, no closer than 2" to the edges. Leave gaps at the ends so air can escape when you press the panels
              against the wall. Also apply an S-shaped continuous bead to the center of the panel. Position the panel against the wall so the
              bottom rests firmly against the shower-pan curb and side edges are against the wall channel and the corner of the room. Press
              the panel against the wall firmly, and smooth it with even hand pressure until the panel is perfectly flat. Repeat with the wall
              that has plumbing cutouts, making sure to apply a bead of panel adhesive around the cutouts. Finally, apply panel adhesive
              to the back of the corner panel and press it into place. (Some shower models may have a connecting rod that joins the corner
              panel to the shower-pan unit.) If any excess adhesive has squeezed out around the edges of the panel, clean it away with a rag
              moistened with mineral spirits.

   150        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 150 24/9/18 5:49 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 150 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:150

                                                                                  Following the kit instructions, begin
                                                                                  assembling the doorframes. With our
                                                                       10         kit, the first step is to attach the center
                                                                                  guide to the bottom rail using the
                                                                                  screws included with the kit.

                                                                                  Stand the sliding door panels upright
                                                                                  so the hanging brackets are at the top.
                                                                       11         Install the rollers on the same side of
                                                                                  the door panels as the door stops.

                                                                                  Most shower kits have both stationary
                                                                                  glass panels and sliding panels. Begin
                                                                       12         by installing the first stationary panel by
                                                                                  inserting it into the wall channel so the
                                                                                  roller channel at the side of the top rail
                                                                                  is facing inside the shower stall. Now
                                                                                  insert the sliding door panel on this
                                                                                  side, so that the rollers engage the roller
                                                                                  channel inside the top rail. Repeat this
                                                                                  step with the opposite-side stationary
                                                                                  panel and sliding door panel. Secure
                                                                                  the top and bottom rails of the glass
                                                                                  panels to the side channels and to one
                                                                                  another using the corner connectors
                                                                                  included with the kit.

                                                                                                                  (continued)

                                                                                  INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   151

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 151 24/9/18 5:49 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 151 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:151

              Install the seal strips on the back of
              both sliding door panels, as per the kit
              instructions. These pliable strips will                  13
              allow the door to form a watertight seal
              against the stationary panels.

              Make small adjustments to the entire
              assembly to center it on the top face
              of the shower pan curbs. Once you’ve                     14
              positioned it correctly, so that the entire
              unit is plumb and the bottoms of the
              stationary panels are flat and level on
              the shower pan, drill holes in the frame
              through the adjustment holes in the
              glass frames and secure the unit to the
              wall channels with the provided screws.
              Test the doors and, if necessary, make
              small adjustments by loosening and
              then reattaching the roller screws at
              the top of the doors. Allow the shower
              unit to sit in place for 12 hours before
              beginning the waterproofing step.

   152        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 152 24/9/18 5:49 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 152 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:152

                                                                                  Waterproofing the shower requires the
                                                                                  use of two different but similar-sounding
                                                                       15         products: siliconized latex caulk and
                                                                                  silicone sealant. First, apply siliconized
                                                                                  caulk to the seams between the wall
                                                                                  panels and corner panel, between
                                                                                  the wall panels and the metal wall
                                                                                  channels, the seam where the wall
                                                                                  panels and corner panel meet the
                                                                                  shower pan, and along the tops of the
                                                                                  wall panels. Apply silicone sealant to the
                                                                                  heads of all screws in the upright panel
                                                                                  frames. From inside of the shower,
                                                                                  apply silicone sealant along the seams
                                                                                  where the bottom rails lie on the shower
                                                                                  pan curb and along the bottoms of the
                                                                                  wall channels and glass panel upright
                                                                                  frames. Also apply silicone sealant
                                                                                  around the center guide. Apply silicone
                                                                                  sealant around the joint where the
                                                                                  bottom rails butt up against the bottom
                                                                                  connector. Finally, apply sealant to the
                                                                                  heads of any exposed screws.

                                                                                  Let the caulked and sealed seams
                                                                                  dry completely. To complete your
                                                                       16         shower, make the plumbing hookups
                                                                                  of the shower faucet spray head and
                                                                                  the shower valve. Test the shower to
                                                                                  check for leaks.

                                                                                  INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   153

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 153 24/9/18 5:49 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 153 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:153

                                                                             TOOLS & MATERIALS
                                                                           Tape measure                    Thinset mortar
                                                                           Circular saw                    16d galvanized
                                                                           Hammer                             common nails
                                                                           Utility knife                   15# building paper

              Custom Shower Bases                                          Stapler
                                                                           2' level
                                                                                                           3‑piece shower drain
                                                                                                           PVC primer & cement
                                                                           Mortar mixing box               Galvanized finish nails
                                                                                                           Galvanized metal lath
              B    uilding a custom-tiled shower base lets you             Trowel
                   choose the shape and size of your shower rather         Wood float                      Thick‑bed floor mortar
              than having its dimensions dictated by available             Felt‑tip marker                 Latex mortar additive
              products. Building the base is quite simple, though                                          CPE waterproof
                                                                           Ratchet wrench
              it does require time and some knowledge of basic                                                membrane &
              masonry techniques because the base is formed                Expandable stopper
                                                                                                              preformed dam corners
              primarily using mortar. What you get for your time           Drill
                                                                                                           CPE membrane
              and trouble can be spectacular.                              Tin snips                          solvent glue
                  Before designing a shower base, contact your local
                                                                           Torpedo level                   CPE membrane sealant
              building department regarding code restrictions and to
              secure the necessary permits. Code requirement will have     Tools & materials               Cementboard & materials
              a major influence on the size and position of the base.          for installing tile
                                                                                                           Utility knife
                  Custom shower bases are designed to be surfaced          2 × 4 & 2 × 10 framing
                                                                                                           Straightedge
              with tile: usually ceramic, porcelain, or glass. Choose          lumber
              your tile before finalizing the design of the base so
              you can minimize cutting where possible. Consider
              that larger floor tile (6 × 6 inches or longer) is less    maintenance than smaller tiles, such as mosaic. At
              likely to develop leaks in the grout lines because         the same time, however, the existence of more grout
              there are fewer, and it also requires less cleaning and    lines makes the surface less slippery when wet.

                   Making a custom
                   shower base gives
                   you many options for
                   the shape and size of
                   your shower.

   154

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 154 24/9/18 5:49 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 154 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:154

       Cross-Section of a Shower Pan

                        Top of CPE membrane

                                                                   No fasteners below
                                                                 top of CPE membrane

                                                                                                   Mortar

                                                                                      Metal lath

                                                                             Mortar

                                                          CPE membrane

                                                                                                                                                Subfloor
                                                                                                    Mortar
                                                                                                                                   Building paper

                                                                  3-piece drain                      Tile spacers          Metal lath

       A custom shower pan is a fairly intricate, multi-layered construction, but choosing to build one gives you the ultimate
       design flexibility.

              TIPS FOR BUILDING A CUSTOM SHOWER BASE
          A custom-tiled shower base is built in three layers to ensure proper water drainage: the pre-pan, the shower pan, and the
          shower floor. A mortar pre-pan is first built on top of the subfloor, establishing a slope toward the drain of ¼" for every 12"
          of shower floor. Next, a waterproof chlorinated polyethylene (CPE) membrane forms the shower pan, providing a watertight
          seal for the shower base. Finally, a second mortar bed reinforced with wire mesh is installed for the shower floor, providing
          a surface for tile installation. If water penetrates the tiled shower floor, the shower pan and sloped pre-pan will direct it to
          the weep holes of the 3-piece drain.

          One of the most important steps in building a custom-tiled shower base is testing the shower pan after the CPE membrane
          has been installed. This allows you to locate and fix any leaks to prevent costly damage.

                                                                                                               INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   155

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 155 24/9/18 5:49 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 155 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:155

                          How to Build a Custom-Tiled Shower Base

                    1                                                              2
              Remove building materials to expose subfloor and stud            Staple 15# building paper to the subfloor of the shower base.
              walls. Cut three 2 × 4s for the curb and fasten them to the      Disassemble the 3-piece shower drain and glue the bottom
              floor joists and the studs at the shower threshold with 16d      piece to the drain pipe with PVC cement. Partially screw the
              galvanized common nails. Also cut 2 × 10 lumber to size and      drain bolts into the drain piece, and stuff a rag into the drain
              install in the stud bays around the perimeter of the shower      pipe to prevent mortar from falling into the drain.
              base. Install (or have installed) drain and supply plumbing.

                                                                       3                                                                   4

              Mark the height of the bottom drain piece on the wall farthest   Staple galvanized metal lath over the building paper; cut a hole
              from the center of the drain. Measure from the center of the     in the lath ½" from the drain. Mix thinset mortar to a fairly dry
              drain straight across to that wall, then raise the height mark   consistency using a latex additive for strength; mortar should
              ¼" for every 12" of shower floor to slope the pre pan toward     hold its shape when squeezed (inset). Trowel the mortar onto
              the drain. Trace a reference line at the height mark around      the subfloor, building the pre-pan from the flange of the drain
              the perimeter of the entire alcove using a level.                piece to the height line on the perimeter of the walls.

   156        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 156 24/9/18 5:50 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 156 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:156

       Continue using the trowel to form the                   Measure the dimensions of the shower floor, and mark it out on a sheet of CPE
       pre-pan, checking the slope using                       waterproof membrane using a felt-tipped marker (be sure to use a high-quality
       a level and filling any low spots with                  CPE shower liner; less-expensive PVC liners become brittle in time and can develop
       mortar. Finish the surface of the                       leaks). From the floor outline, measure out and mark an additional 8" for each
       pre-pan with a wood float until it is                   wall and 16" for the curb end. Cut the membrane to size using a utility knife and
       even and smooth. Allow the mortar to                    straightedge. Be careful to cut on a clean, smooth surface to prevent puncturing the
       cure overnight.                                         membrane. Lay the membrane onto the shower pan.

            5                                                          6

       Measure to find the exact location of the drain and mark it
       on the membrane, outlining the outer diameter of the drain
       flange. Cut a circular piece of CPE membrane roughly 2"
       larger than the drain flange, then use CPE membrane solvent
       glue to weld it into place and reinforce the seal at the drain.

            7

                                                                                         8
                                                                                    Apply CPE sealant around the drain. Fold the membrane along
                                                                                    the floor outline. Set the membrane over the pre-pan so the
                                                                                    reinforced drain seal is centered over the drain bolts. Working
                                                                                    from the drain to the walls, carefully tuck the membrane tight
                                                                                    into each corner, folding the extra material into triangular flaps.
                                                                                                                                          (continued)

                                                                                                            INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                  157

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 157 24/9/18 5:50 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 157 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:157

                                                                                                                                     Dam corner

                  9                                                                                                                            10
              Apply CPE solvent glue to one side, press the flap flat, then        At the shower curb, cut the membrane along the studs so it
              staple it in place. Staple only the top edge of the membrane to      can be folded over the curb. Solvent glue a dam corner at
              the blocking; do not staple below the top of the curb or on the      each inside corner of the curb. Do not fasten the dam corners
              curb itself.                                                         with staples.

                                                                        11            12
              At the reinforced drain seal on the membrane, locate and mark        Use a utility knife to carefully cut away only enough of the
              the drain bolts. Press the membrane down around the bolts,           membrane to expose the drain and allow the middle drain
              then use a utility knife to carefully cut a slit just large enough   piece to fit in place. Remove the drain bolts, then position
              for the bolts to poke through. Push the membrane down over           the middle drain piece over the bolt holes. Reinstall the bolts,
              the bolts.                                                           tightening them evenly and firmly to create a watertight seal.

   158        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 158 24/9/18 5:50 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 158 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:158

       Test the shower pan for leaks overnight. Plug the drain and
       fill the shower pan with water, to 1" below the top of the
       curb. Mark the water level and let the water sit overnight. If
       the water level remains the same, the pan holds water. If the
       level is lower, locate and fix leaks in the pan using patches of
       membrane and CPE solvent.

                                                                       13

                                                                               14
                                                                            Install cementboard on the alcove walls using ¼" wood shims
                                                                            to lift the bottom edge off the CPE membrane. To prevent
                                                                            puncturing the membrane, do not use fasteners in the
                                                                            lower 8" of the cementboard. Cut a piece of metal lath to fit
                                                                            around the three sides of the curb. Bend the lath so it tightly
                                                                            conforms to the curb. Pressing the lath against the top of the
                                                                            curb, staple it to the outside face of the curb. Mix enough
                                                                            mortar for the two sides of the curb.

       Apply thinset mortar to the edges of the curb, using a straight
       board as a guide. When the mortar has set, remove the board
       and apply thinset to the top of the curb.

                                                                       15

                                                                               16
                                                                            Attach the drain strainer piece to the drain, adjusting it to a
                                                                            minimum of 1½" above the shower pan. On one wall, mark
                                                                            1½" up from the shower pan, then use a level to draw a
                                                                            reference line around the perimeter of the shower base.
                                                                            Because the pre-pan establishes the ¼" per foot slope, this
                                                                            measurement will maintain that slope.
                                                                                                                                  (continued)

                                                                                                   INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   159

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 159 24/9/18 5:50 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 159 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:159

                17

                                                                                      18
              Spread tile spacers over the weep holes of the drain to              Continue to add mortar, building the floor to the reference line
              prevent mortar from plugging the holes. Mix the floor mortar,        on the walls. Use a level to check the slope, and pack mortar
              then build up the shower floor to roughly half the planned           into low spots with a trowel. Leave space around the drain
              thickness of this layer. Cut metal lath to cover the mortar bed,     flange for the thickness of the tile. Float the surface until it is
              keeping it ½" from the drain (see photo in step 18).                 smooth and slopes evenly to the drain. When finished, allow
                                                                                   the mortar to cure overnight before installing the tiles.

                                                                                                                             Bullnose cap

                                                                                                      Built-up curb

                                                                                                                                   Shower pan

                  19
              Install the tile. At the curb, cut the tiles for the inside to
              protrude ½" above the unfinished top of the curb, and cut the            OPTION: Apply bullnose cap tiles to the top of the curb,
              tiles for the outside to protrude 5⁄8" above the top, establishing       sloping them toward the shower slightly. Make sure cap
              a 1⁄8" slope so water drains back into the shower. Use a level to        tiles overhang wall tiles.
              check the tops of the tiles for level as you work.

   160        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 160 24/9/18 5:50 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 160 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:160

             DESIGN SUGGESTIONS

                                                                                                 Textured surfaces improve the
                                                                                                 safety of tile floors, especially
                                                                                                 in wet areas such as this
                                                                                                 open shower. The shower
                                                                                                 area is defined by a simple
                                                                                                 shift in color and size.

                                                                       Mosaic tile, with its mesh backing and small shapes, works
                                                                       well on walls and on curved accents around this shower.

          The raised curb on this open shower keeps most of the
          water headed toward the drain. But no matter, the entire
          bathroom is tiled, so stray droplets aren’t a problem.

                                                                                             INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   161

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 161 24/9/18 5:50 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 161 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:161

              Wet Rooms
              & Curbless Showers

              W      et rooms—a bathroom in which all surfaces
                     are waterproof—have long been a popular
              choice for upscale remodeling projects and new
              construction in the UK. But now, thanks to the
              increasing focus on Universal Design and an
              ongoing desire for sophisticated bathroom looks,
              wet rooms are becoming a popular option for
              American homeowners.
                  The idea behind a wet room is that moisture
              doesn’t need to be contained in any single area of the
              room, because the whole room is as waterproof as a
              shower stall. This alleviates the need for divider walls
              and enclosures, freeing up space and giving a wet
              room a seamless, streamlined look. Because of the
              space-saving aspects, wet rooms are particularly well
              suited for smaller bathrooms.
                  Installing a wet room involves laying down layers
              that work together to provide an impermeable barrier
              to water, in a process called “tanking.” That process
              is made easy with the use of special rubberized
              waterproof tape and waterproofing compound that            A curbless shower is a natural part of a wet room. A single wall
              is simply rolled onto wall and floor surfaces. Some        surface material is commonly used on all walls for ease of
              companies even provide complete wet room kits              installation and to unify the look.
              (see Resources, page 285). The finished surface can
              be traditional tile (the most common choice), solid           Regardless of the drain used, wet rooms normally
              panels, such as the quartz composite surfaces used in      include a curbless shower, because there is no need to
              contemporary vanity countertops, or sheet flooring,        contain runoff water. Curbless showers present a sleek
              such as vinyl or linoleum.                                 and sophisticated look, which is why homeowners
                  In practice, the preliminary work is a lot like        are choosing to include them in many different
              taping and skim coating a newly drywalled room. The        bathrooms—including those that are not true wet
              more challenging aspects of wet room installation          rooms. Properly installed within an enclosure, a
              are making sure all the openings—from drains to            curbless shower can serve a traditional bathroom
              water-supply inlets—are properly sealed with special       every bit as well as a raised-pan shower would.
              membranes and correctly sloping the floor to a                Installing a curbless shower has become a feasible
              central drain. Normally, a wet room floor is sloped        project for even modestly skilled home DIYers thanks
              from all four corners for this purpose, but you can        to well-thought-out kits that include all the materials
              opt for a sleeker look with the use of a concealed         you’ll need. Wet rooms, on the other hand, usually
              linear “trench” drain along one edge of the room. This     require professional installation to ensure the leaks
              type of drain requires that the floor be sloped in one     never become a problem and that all applicable
              direction only.                                            building codes are met.

   162        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 162 24/9/18 5:50 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 162 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:162

             TYPICAL WET ROOM CONSTRUCTION

                 Cement board

                                         Waterproofing layer

                                          Seam tape
                                                                        Tank access plate

                                                                                 Additional waterproofing
                                                                                       membranes

                                                      Corner tape

                                                                                                               Central drain

                                                                                      Waterproofing layer

                                                         Cement board

                       Plywood

                                                                                                        INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   163

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 163 24/9/18 5:50 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 163 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:163

              Installing a Curbless Shower
              Whether it’s part of a complete “wet room” or                     Curbless shower pan manufacturers also sell pans
              installed as a standalone feature, a curbless shower         with trench drains for an even sleeker look. The pan
              combines easy access for those with limited mobility,        we used for this project is typical of the prefab curbless
              convenience for other users, and a look that is trendy,      pan construction; it can support 1,100 pounds even
              sophisticated, and attractive. The trick to installing       though the pan itself weighs less than 70 pounds, and
              one of these water features is to ensure the moisture        it sits right on top of floor joists, with the addition of
              stays inside the shower.                                     blocking to support the area around the drain and to
                  Once upon a time, creating a reliably waterproof         provide nailing surfaces around the edges.
              enclosure for a curbless shower was no small chore.               Kits such as these offer advantages beyond the
              It meant putting a lot of work into creating a custom        ease of installation and a thoughtful configuration
              shower pan. This kind of project was usually above           of parts. Usually, the plumbing can be completely
              the skill level or desire of the weekend DIYer, and it       adjusted and connected from above, so you won’t
              generally meant hiring a contractor.                         need to work in the basement or a crawl space or
                  Now you can buy curbless shower pan kits that make       open up a first-floor ceiling to install a second-floor
              installation a breeze. The manufacturers have thought        shower. The kits themselves generally include almost
              through all the issues that can arise and have developed     everything you’ll need for the installation.
              the kits and shower pans to be as foolproof as possible,
              while also meeting prevailing codes and best standards
              and practices. Installing a curbless shower using one of         TOOLS & MATERIALS
              these kits is a realistic project for any home handyperson
              with even moderate DIY skills and a weekend to spare.          Circular saw                    Putty knife
                  These pans come with preconfigured slopes to               Caulking gun                    Palm sander
              ensure optimal drainage away from the shower’s                    & waterproof (or other          & 120‑grit pad
              edges. The product we used for this project, a kit from           adjective caulk)             Scissors
              Access Reliability Center (see Resources, page 285),           Torpedo level                   Rubber gloves
              includes an offset drain hole that offers the option of
                                                                             Cordless drill & bits           Synthetic paintbrush
              rotating the pan in the event of a joist or mechanicals
              that are in the way. This product is offered in nine           PVC cement & brush              Roller & roller handle
              different sizes and can be cut with a circular saw to          Screwdriver                     Eye & ear protection
              just about any shape—including more unusual, curvy             Speed square                    Work gloves
              shapes for a truly custom look.

                                                                                                                         A curbless
                                                                                                                         shower kit
                                                                                                                         includes almost
                                                                                                                         everything you
                                                                                                                         need. All you
                                                                                                                         have to supply
                                                                                                                         are some basic
                                                                                                                         tools, the tile,
                                                                                                                         and a little
                                                                                                                         elbow grease.

   164

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 164 24/9/18 5:50 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 164 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:164

             WET ROOMS & UNIVERSAL DESIGN
          Because a wet room allows the bathroom to be designed with fewer barriers and a single-level floor surface, these rooms
          are natural partners to a Universal Design approach. If you’re thinking about converting a bathroom to a wet room, it’s
          worthwhile to consider a little extra effort to make the space as accessible as possible for the maximum number of users.

          Walls. Where codes allow it, consider using thick plywood rather than cementboard for the wall sub-surfaces.
          Plywood allows for direct installation of grab bars without the need for blocking or locating studs. If you’re set on using
          cementboard, plan out locations for grab bars near toilets, behind and alongside bathtubs, and in showers. Most codes
          specify that grab bars must be able to support up to 200 pounds—which usually means adding blocking in the walls
          behind the grab bars.

          Shower stall. One of the benefits to adding a curbless shower is easy wheelchair (or walker) access. For maximum
          accessibility, the shower area should be at least 60" wide by at least 36" deep (60" by 60" is preferable). This allows a
          wheelchair-bound user to occupy the stall with a helper. And, although the idea is a wide-open shower space, it’s always
          a good idea to add a fold down seat. This allows for transfer from a wheelchair or a place for someone with limited leg
          strength and endurance to sit.

                  How to Install a Waterproof Subbase for a Curbless Shower
                                                                                                  Remove the existing flooring material
                                                                                                  in the area of the shower pan (if you’re
                                                                                       1          remodeling an existing bathroom). Use
                                                                                                  a circular saw to cut out and remove
                                                                                                  the subfloor in the exact dimensions
                                                                                                  of the shower pan. Finish the cuts with
                                                                                                  a jigsaw or handsaw.

                                                                                                  Reinforce the floor with blocking
                                                                                                  between joists as necessary. Toenail
                                                                                                  bridge blocking in on either side of the
                                                                                                  drain waste pipe location and between
                                                                                                  joists anywhere you’ll need a nailing
                                                                                                  surface along the edges of the shower
                                                                                                  pan. If trusses or joists are spaced more
                                                                                                  than 16" O.C., add bridge blocking to
                                                                                                  adequately support the pan.

            2
                                                                                                                                 (continued)

                                                                                                  INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   165

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 165 24/9/18 5:50 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 165 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:165

                  3

                                                                                      4
              Set the pan in the opening to make sure it fits and is level. If    Install or relocate drain pipes as needed. Check with your local
              it is not level, screw shims to the tops of any low joists and      building department: if the drain and trap are not accessible
              check again: repeat if necessary until the pan is perfectly level   from below, you may need to have an on-site inspection
              in all directions.                                                  before you cover up the plumbing.

                                                                                      6
              Check the height of the drainpipe.
              Its top should be exactly 23⁄8" from
              the bottom of the pan. Measure
              down from the top of the joist. If
              the drainpipe is too high, remove
              it and trim with a tubing cutter. If it
              is too low, replace the assembly
              with a new assembly that has a
              longer tailpiece.

                  5

                                                                                  Lay a thick bead of construction adhesive along the contact
                                                                                  areas on all joists, nailing surfaces, and blocking.

   166        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 166 24/9/18 5:50 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 166 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:166

            7                                                                                                                              8
       Set the pan in place and screw it down using at least 2 screws           Disassemble the supplied drain assembly. Be careful not to
       along each side. Do not overtighten the screws. If you’ve cut            lose any of the screws. Place the drain tailpiece on the waste
       off the screwing flange on one or more sides to accommodate              pipe under where the pan’s drainhole will be located, and
       an unusual shape, drill 1⁄8" pilot holes in the cut edges at joist       measure to check that it sits at the correct level. Solvent-glue
       or blocking locations and drive the screws through the holes.            the tailpiece to the end of the waste pipe.

                                                                       9
                                                                                   Thread the tail top piece into the tail through the
                                                                                   drain flange. Use a speed square or other lever,
                                                                                   such as spread channel lock pliers, to snugly
                                                                                   tighten the tail top piece in place.

                                                                                     10

       Position the supplied gaskets on top of the tailpiece (check the
       manufacturer’s instructions; the gaskets usually need to be
       layered in the correct order). Set the drain flange piece on top
       of the tail and into the drain hole in the pan. Drill 1⁄8" pilot holes
       through the flange and into the pan. Screw the flange to the pan.                                                              (continued)

                                                                                                       INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   167

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 167 24/9/18 5:50 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 167 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:167

                                                                                     12

                  11
              Install tile underlayment for the rest of the project area. If      Scrape any stickers or other blemishes off the pan with a putty
              the underlayment is higher than the top of the pan once it          knife. Lightly sand the entire surface of the pan using 120-grit
              is installed, you’ll have to sand it to level, gradually tapering   sandpaper to help the sealant adhere. After you’re done
              away from the pan.                                                  sanding, wipe down the sanded pan with a damp sponge.
                                                                                  Make sure the entire area is clean.

                                           Seal the edge seams at the wall and
                                           between the pan and subfloor with
                                           waterproof latex sealant. Caulk any
                                           pan screw holes that were not used.

                                             13

                                                                                     14
                                                                                  Cut strips of waterproofing tape to cover all seams in the tile
                                                                                  underlayment (both walls and floor). Also cut strips for the
                                                                                  joints where walls and floor meet. Open the pail of liquid
                                                                                  waterproofing membrane and mix the liquid thoroughly.
                                                                                  Beginning at the top and working down, brush a bed of
                                                                                  waterproofing liquid over the seams. Before it dries, set the
                                                                                  tape firmly into the waterproofing. Press and smooth the tape.
                                                                                  Then brush a layer of waterproofing compound over the tape.

   168        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 168 24/9/18 5:50 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 168 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:168

           15                                                                16

       Trace a hole in the center of the waterproof drain gasket using    Apply a thin coat of the waterproofing compound around the
       the bottom of the drain clamping donut. Cut the hole out using     drain hole and to the back of the drain gasket. Don’t apply
       scissors. Be careful cutting the gasket, because it is a crucial   too much; if the waterproofing is too thick under the gasket, it
       part of the drain waterproofing. Check the fit with the gasket     may not dry correctly.
       against the underside of the clamping donut top flange.

           17                                                                18
       Put the gasket in place and brush a coat of the waterproofing      Use a roller to roll waterproofing compound across the walls
       over the gasket. Screw the clamping donut in place on the top      and over the entire pan surface. The ideal is 4mm thick (about
       of the drain and over the membrane. Hand-tighten the bolts         the thickness of a credit card). Allow this first coat to dry for
       and then cover the clamping donut with the waterproofing           2 hours, then cover with a second coat. This should conclude
       compound (avoid covering the slide lock for the drain grate).      the waterproofing phase of the project, and you’re ready to begin
                                                                          laying tile once the waterproofing compound has dried thoroughly.

                                                                                                 INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   169

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 169 24/9/18 5:51 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 169 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:169

                          How to Tile a Curbless Shower

                                                                                      2

                                                                         1
              Set the floor tile first. Begin by placing a sample of the floor    Begin laying floor tile in the corner of the shower. Lay a bed
              tile directly next to the drain so you can set the drain grate      of thinset tile adhesive using a notched trowel. The thinset
              height to match. The adjustable mounting plate for the grate        container should specify the notch size (3⁄8" square notch
              should be flush with the tops of the tile.                          is common).

                    3
                                                                                                         Install tile so a small square of untiled
                                                                                                         area is left around the drain opening
                                                                                                         (which, in the system seen here, is
                                                                                                         square, making for an easier cutting job).

                                                                                                                                               4

              Place the corner tile into the bed of thinset and press it to set
              it. Don’t press down too hard or you will displace too much of
              the material. Continue laying tile, fanning out from the corner
              toward the drain opening. Leave space around the drain
              opening, as it is likely you’ll need to cut tiles to fit.

   170        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 170 24/9/18 5:51 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 170 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:170

            5

                                                                           6
       Mark the tiles that surround the drain opening for cutting.     Cut the tiles along the trim lines using a tile saw. If you are not
       Leave a small gap between the tiles next to the drain grate     comfortable using a tile saw, score the tiles and cut them with
       mounting plate.                                                 tile nippers.

            7
                                                                          Set the cut tiles around the drain opening, doing
                                                                          your best to maintain even gaps that match the
                                                                          gaps in the rest of the floor. Once you’ve finished
                                                                          tiling around the drain, complete setting floor tile in
                                                                          the rest of the project area.

                                                                             8

       Apply thinset onto the shower pan, taking care not to get any
       on the drain grate mounting plate. You may need to use a
       small trowel or a putty knife to get into small gaps.
                                                                                                                             (continued)

                                                                                               INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                  171

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 171 24/9/18 5:51 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 171 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:171

                    9                                                                                                                          10
              Let the floor tile set overnight, and then apply grout. Using          Snap the grate cover into the cover mounting plate (if you’ve
              a grout sponge, wipe the grout over the gaps so all are filled         stuffed a rag into the drain opening to keep debris out, be
              evenly. After the grout dries, buff the floor with a towel to wipe     sure to remove it first). The grate cover seen here locks in
              up excess residue.                                                     with a small key that should be saved in case you need to
                                                                                     remove the grate cover.

                  11

                                                                                        12
              Begin setting the wall tile. Generally, it’s easiest if you start at   In the design used here, a border of the same mosaic tile used
              the bottom and work upward. Instead of thinset adhesive, an            in the floor is installed all around the shower area to make the
              adhesive mat is being used here. This relatively new product           first course. Dark brown accent tiles are installed in a single
              is designed for walls and is rated for waterproof applications.        vertical column running upward, centered on the line formed
              It is a good idea to use a spacer (¼" thick or so) to get an           by the shower faucet and showerhead. This vertical column is
              even border at the bottoms of the first tiles.                         installed after the bottom border.

   172        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 172 24/9/18 5:51 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 172 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:172

                                                                       13                                                             14

       Next, another vertical column of accent tiles is installed on        Finally, larger field tiles that match the floor tile used outside
       each side of the large, dark tiles. These columns are also laid      the shower area are installed up to the corner and outward
       using the floor tile, which connects the walls and floor visually    from the shower area. Starting at the bottom, set a thin spacer
       in an effective way.                                                 on top of the border tiles to ensure even gaps.

           15

       Grout the gaps in the wall tiles. It’s usually a good idea
       to protect any fittings, such as the shower faucet handle
       escutcheon, with painters tape prior to grouting. If you wish, a
       clear surround may be installed to visually define the shower
       area, as in the photo to the right, but because the shower pan
       is pitched toward the drain it really is not necessary.

                                                                                                   INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   173

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 173 24/9/18 5:51 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 173 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:173

                                                                                TOOLS & MATERIALS
                                                                             Channel‑type pliers             Shims
                                                                             Hacksaw                         Galvanized deck screws
                                                                             Carpenter’s level               Drain‑waste‑overflow kit
                                                                             Pencil                          1 × 3, 1 × 4, 2 × 4 lumber

              Alcove Bathtubs                                                Tape measure
                                                                             Saw
                                                                                                             Galvanized roofing nails
                                                                                                             Galvanized roof flashing
                                                                             Screwdriver                     Thinset mortar

              M      ost of our homes are equipped with an alcove            Drill                           Tub & tile caulk
                     tub (usually 60 inches long) that includes a            Adjustable wrench               Caulk gun
              tub surround and shower function. By combining                 Trowel                          Propane torch
              the tub and the shower in one fixture, you conserve
              precious bathroom floorspace and simplify the initial
              installation. Plus, you only have one bathing fixture        the old tub, it may leave an untiled space on the floor
              that needs cleaning.                                         that you will need to fill.
                  But because tub/showers are so efficient, they               Plumbing an alcove tub is a relatively difficult job
              do get a lot of use and tend to have fairly limited          because getting access to the drain lines attached
              lifespans. Pressed steel tubs have enamel finishes that      to the tub and into the floor is often very awkward.
              crack and craze; plastic and fiberglass tubs get grimy       Although an access panel is required by some codes,
              and stained; even acrylic and composite tubs show            the truth is that many tubs were installed without
              wear eventually (and as with other fixtures, styles and      them or with panels that are too small or hard to
              colors change too). Fortunately, today’s acrylic and         reach to be of much use. If you are contemplating
              fiberglass tubs have more durable finishes than those        replacing your tub, the first step in the decision
              made a decade or two ago.                                    process should be to find the access panel and
                  If you are not completely remodeling the bath-           determine if it is sufficient. If it is not (or there is no
              room, plan to make the new tub fit with its surround-        panel at all), consider how you might enlarge it. Often,
              ings. For instance, if you have wall tiles, you’ll need to   this means cutting a hole in the wall of the adjoining
              remove some of them in order to remove and replace           room and also in the ceiling below. This creates more
              the tub. Make sure you can buy new tiles that exactly        work, of course, but compared to the damage caused
              match the size and color of the existing tiles. Also         by a leaky drain from a subpar installation, making an
              check the width of the new tub; if it is narrower than       access opening is little inconvenience.

                                                                                                                         By replacing a
                                                                                                                         dingy old alcove
                                                                                                                         tub with a fresh
                                                                                                                         new one, you can
                                                                                                                         make the tub and
                                                                                                                         shower area as
                                                                                                                         pleasant to use
                                                                                                                         as it is efficient.

   174

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 174 24/9/18 5:51 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 174 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:174

              TIPS FOR INSTALLING BATHTUBS

                                                                                            Overflow coverplate

                                                                                                                                     Overflow
                                                                                                                                       pipe

               Left hand tub

                                                                                                                                       Drain
                                                                                                                                        tee
                                                                                     Drain coverplate

                                                                                                                                       Drain
                                                                                                                                     tailpiece

                                                                 Right hand tub

          Choose the correct tub for your plumbing setup.                         A drain‑waste‑overflow kit with stopper mechanism must
          Alcove‑installed tubs with only one‑sided aprons are sold               be purchased separately and attached after the tub is
          as either “left‑hand” or “right‑hand” models, depending                 set. Available in both brass and plastic types, most kits
          on the location of the predrilled drain and overflow holes in           include an overflow coverplate, an overflow pipe that
          the tub. To determine which type you need, face into the                can be adjusted to different heights, a drain tee fitting,
          alcove and check whether the tub drain is on your right or              an adjustable drain tailpiece, and a drain coverplate that
          your left.                                                              screws into the tailpiece.

                                                                                                                   The supply system for a
                                                                                                                   bathtub includes hot and
              Tub spout nipple                                                                                     cold supply pipes, shutoff
                                                                                                                   valves, a faucet and
                                                                                                                   handle(s), and a spout.
              Tub ledger                                                                       Faucet
                                                                                                                   Supply connections can be
                                                                                                                   made before or after the
                                                                                                                   tub is installed.

                                                                                              Flashing             The drain‑waste‑overflow
                                                                                                                   system for a bathtub
              Cold water                                                                                           includes the overflow
                supply                                                                     Overflow pipe           pipe, drain tee, P‑trap,
                                                                                                                   and branch drain. The
                                                                                                                   overflow pipe assembly
                                                                                                                   is attached to the tub
                                                      Shutoff
                                                      Shutoff
                                                       valves
                                                        valves                                                     before installation.
                                                                                          Drain tee fitting

                Drain
              tailpiece

              Branch                                                              Hot water supply
               drain

              P-trap                                                                  Wall and floor sections
                                                                                       removed for clarity

                                                                                                           INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                 175

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 175 2/10/18 11:01 AM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 175 2/10/18 11:01 AM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:175

                          How to Install a New Alcove Tub
                                                                                Check the subfloor for level—if it is not level, use pour-on
                                                                                floor leveler compound to correct it (ask at your local flooring
                                                                                store). Make sure the supply and drain pipes and the shutoff
                                                                                valves are in good repair, and correct any problems you
                                                                                encounter. If you have no bath fan in the alcove, now is the
                                                                                perfect time to add one.

                                                                                    2

                    1
              Prepare for the new tub. Inspect and remove old or deteriorated
              wall surfaces or framing members in the tub area. In just
              about every case, it makes sense to go ahead and strip off the
              old alcove wallcoverings and ceiling down to the studs so you
              can replace them. This also allows you to inspect for hidden
              damage in the wall and ceiling cavities. Plus, many codes no
              longer allow the use of moisture-resistant drywall (greenboard)
              in tub and shower areas. Cementboard should be used instead.

                                                                                Begin by installing the new water supply plumbing. Measure to
                                                                                determine the required height of your shower riser tube and
                                                                                cut it to length. Attach the bottom of the riser to the faucet
                                                                                body and the top to the shower elbow.

                                                                                    4

                                                                                                                             Faucet body

                                                                       3
              Check the height of the crossbraces for the faucet body and the
              showerhead. If your family members needed to stoop to use
              the old shower, consider raising the brace for the showerhead.
              Read the instructions for your new faucet/diverter and check                   Riser tube
              to see that the brace for the faucet body will conform to the
              requirements (this includes distance from the surround wall as                                                   Heatproof mat
              well as height). Adjust the brace locations as needed.

   176        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 176 24/9/18 5:51 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 176 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:176

                                                                               6

            5
       Attach the faucet body to the cross brace with pipe hanger          Slide the bathtub into the alcove. Make sure the tub is flat on
       straps. Then, attach supply tubing from the stop valves to the      the floor and pressed flush against the back wall. If your tub
       faucet body, making sure to attach the hot water to the left port   did not come with a tub protector, cut a piece of cardboard to
       and cold to the right port. Also secure the shower elbow to its     line the tub bottom and tape pieces of cardboard around the
       cross brace with a pipe strap. Do not attach the shower arm yet.    rim to protect the finish from shoes and dropped tools.

                                                                               8

          7

           Mark locations for ledger boards. To do this, trace the
           height of the top of the tub’s nailing flange onto the          Install 1 × 4 ledger boards. Drive two or three 3"-galvanized
           wall studs in the alcove. Then remove the tub and               deck screws through the ledger board at each stud. All three
           measure the height of the nailing flange. Measure               walls should receive a ledger. Leave an open space in the wet
           down this same amount from your flange lines and                wall to allow clearance for the drain-waste-overflow (DWO) kit.
           mark the new ledger board location.                             Measure to see whether the drain will line up with the tub’s
                                                                           DWO. If not, you may need to cut and reassemble the drain.
                                                                                                                                 (continued)

                                                                                                  INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   177

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 177 24/9/18 5:51 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 177 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:177

                                                                                                                                 Drain strainer

                    9                                                              10
              Install the DWO pipes before you install the tub. Make sure to    Thread the male‑threaded drain strainer into the female-
              get a good seal on the slip nuts at the pipe joints. Follow the   threaded drain waste elbow. Wrap a coil of plumber’s putty
              manufacturer’s instructions to make sure the pop-up drain         around the drain outlet underneath the plug rim first. Hand
              linkage is connected properly. Make sure rubber gaskets are       tighten only.
              positioned correctly at the openings on the outside of the tub.

                  11                                                               12

              Attach the overflow coverplate, making sure the pop-up drain      Working with a helper, place the tub in position, taking care not
              controls are in the correct position. Tighten the mounting        to bump the DWO assembly. If the DWO assembly does not
              screws that connect to the mounting plate to sandwich             line up with the drainpipe, remove the tub and adjust the
              the rubber gasket snugly between the overflow pipe flange         drain location. Many acrylic, fiberglass, and steel tubs will
              and the tub wall. Then, finish tightening the drain strainer      have a much firmer feeling if they are set in a bed of sand-mix
              against the waste elbow by inserting the handle of a pair of      concrete. Check manufacturer’s instructions and pour concrete
              pliers into the strainer body and turning.                        or mortar as needed. Set the tub carefully back in the alcove.

   178        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 178 24/9/18 5:52 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 178 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:178

           13

                                                                           14
       Attach the drain outlet from the DWO assembly to the drain       Drive a 1½" galvanized roofing nail at each stud location, just
       P-trap. This is the part of the job where you will appreciate    over the top of the tub’s nailing flange. The nail head should
       that you spent the time to create a roomy access panel for the   pin the flange to the stud. Be careful here—an errant blow or
       tub plumbing. Test the drain and overflow to make sure they      overdriving can cause the enameled finish to crack or craze.
       don’t leak. Also test the water supply plumbing, temporarily
       attaching the handles, spout, and shower arm so you can          OPTION: You may choose to drill guide holes and nail
       operate the faucet and the diverter.                             through the flange instead.

           15                                                              16

       Install the wallcoverings and tub surround. You can also make    Install fittings. First, thread the shower arm into the shower
       a custom surround from tileboard or cementboard and tile.        elbow and attach the spout nipple to the valve assembly. Also
       Many codes no longer allow the use of moisture-resistant         attach the shower head and escutcheon, the faucet handle/
       drywall (greenboard) in tub and shower enclosures; choose        diverter with escutcheon, and the tub spout. Use thread
       cementboard instead.                                             lubricant on all parts.

                                                                                               INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   179

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 179 24/9/18 5:52 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 179 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:179

                                                                                                     TOOLS & MATERIALS
                                                                                                  Measuring tape
                                                                                                  Pencil
                                                                                                  Hacksaw
              Sliding Tub Doors                                                                   Miter box
                                                                                                  Level
                                                                                                  Drill

              C    urtains on your bathtub shower are a hassle. If you forget to slide
                   them closed, mildew sets up shop in the folds. And every time you
              brush against them, they stick to your skin. Shower curtains certainly
                                                                                                  Center punch
                                                                                                  Razor blade
              don’t add much elegance or charm to a dream bath. Neither does a                    Marker
              deteriorated door. Clean up the look of your bathroom, and even give it             Masonry bit for tile wall
              an extra touch of elegance, with a new sliding tub door.                            Phillips screwdriver
                  When shopping for a sliding tub door, you have a choice of framed               Caulk gun & caulk
              or frameless. A framed door is edged in metal. The metal framing is
              typically aluminum but is available in many finishes, including those               Masking tape
              that resemble gold, brass, or chrome. Glass options are also plentiful. You         Silicone sealant & remover
              can choose between frosted or pebbled glass, clear, mirrored, tinted, or            Tub door kit
              patterned glass. Doors can be installed on ceramic tile walls or onto a             Masking tape
              fiberglass tub surround.

                                                                                                                       A sliding tub door
                                                                                                                       framed in
                                                                                                                       aluminum gives
                                                                                                                       the room a sleek,
                                                                                                                       clean look and
                                                                                                                       is just one of the
                                                                                                                       available options.

   180

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 180 24/9/18 5:52 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 180 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:180

                  How to Install a Sliding Tub Door
       Remove the old door if there is one, then inspect the walls and
       tub ledge for plumb and level. Also remove any remaining old
       caulk or residue.

            1

                                                                                                                                      2
                                                                         Measure the distance between the finished walls along the
                                                                         top of the tub ledge. Refer to the manufacturer’s instructions
                                                                         for figuring the track dimensions. For the product seen here,
                                                                         3
                                                                          ⁄16" is subtracted from the measurement to calculate the
                                                                         track dimensions.

            3                                                                4
       Using a hacksaw and a miter box, carefully cut the track to the   Place a wall channel against the wall with the longer side
       proper dimension. Center the track on the bathtub ledge with      out, and slide it into place over the track so they overlap. Use
       the taller side out and so the gaps are even at each end. Tape    a level to check the channel for plumb, and then mark the
       into position with masking tape.                                  locations of the mounting holes on the wall with a marker.
                                                                         Repeat for the other wall channel. Remove the track.
                                                                                                                               (continued)

                                                                                                INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   181

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 181 24/9/18 5:52 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 181 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:181

                                                                            5

                                                                                                                                             6
              Drill mounting holes for the wall channel at the marked             Apply a bead of silicone sealant along the joint between
              locations. In ceramic tile, mark the surface of the tile with a     the tub and the wall at the ends of the track. Apply a
              center punch, use a ¼" masonry bit to drill the hole, and then      minimum ¼" bead of sealant along the outside leg of the
              insert the included wall anchors. For fiberglass surrounds,         track underside.
              use a 1⁄8" drill bit; wall anchors are not necessary.

                                                                                                                                             8
                                           Position the track on the tub ledge
                                           and against the wall. Attach the
                                           wall channels using the provided                Header
                                           screws. Do not use caulk on the wall
                                           channels at this time.

                                                                            7

                                                                                                       Wall channel

                                                                                  Cut and install the header. At a location above the tops of
                                                                                  the wall channels, measure the distance between the walls.
                                                                                  Refer to the manufacturer’s instructions for calculating the
                                                                                  header length. For the door seen here, the length is the
                                                                                  distance between the walls minus 1⁄16". Measure the header
                                                                                  and carefully cut it to length using a hacksaw and a miter box.
                                                                                  Slide the header down on top of the wall channels until seated.

   182        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 182 24/9/18 5:52 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 182 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:182

            9
                                                                                                             Roller

                                                                               10
       Mount the rollers in the roller mounting holes. To begin, use        Carefully lift the inner panel by the sides and place the rollers on
       the second-from-the-top roller mounting holes. Follow the            the inner roller track. Roll the door toward the shower end of the
       manufacturer’s instructions for spacer or washer placement           tub. The edge of the panel should touch both rubber bumpers.
       and orientation.                                                     If it doesn’t, remove the door and move the rollers to different
                                                                            holes. Drive the screws by hand to prevent overtightening.

                                                                               12

                                                                       11
       Lift the outer panel by the sides with the towel bar facing out      Apply a bead of clear silicone sealant to the inside seam of
       from the tub. Place the outer rollers over the outer roller track.   the wall and wall channel at both ends and to the U-shaped
       Slide the door to the end opposite the shower end of the tub.        joint of the track and wall channels. Smooth the sealant with a
       If the door does not contact both bumpers, remove the door           fingertip dipped in water.
       and move the rollers to different mounting holes.

                                                                                                    INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                  183

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 183 24/9/18 5:52 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 183 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:183

                                                                                              TOOLS & MATERIALS
                                                                                            Basic plumbing tools            Shims
                                                                                            Utility knife                   TFE paste or other
                                                                                                                                thread lubricant
              Jetted Tub                                                                    4‑foot level
                                                                                            Square‑edge trowel              1 × 4 lumber
                                                                                            Drill or power driver           Plumber’s putty
                                                                                            Channel‑type pliers             1½" galvanized
              A    jetted spa, often called a whirlpool tub or a
                    hot tub, is basically a bathtub that’s plumbed
              to recirculate water, air, or both, creating an effect
                                                                                            Hacksaw
                                                                                            Level
                                                                                                                                deck screws
                                                                                                                            1" galvanized roofing nails
              known as hydromassage. Hydromassage increases                                 Circular saw                    Dry‑set mortar
              blood flow, relieves pressure on joints and muscles,                          Drill                           Trowel
              and relieves tension. Interior hydromassage tubs
                                                                                            Screwdriver                     Silicone caulk
              usually have a water pump that blows a mixture of
                                                                                            Adjustable wrench                   & caulk gun
              air and water through jets located in the tub body.
              Many fixtures include an in-line water heater to                              Drain‑waste‑overflow            Jetted tub
              maintain water temperature. Jetted spas that circulate                            assembly                    Faucet
              only warm air, not water (sometimes called “air-jet                           Rubber gaskets                  Joint compound
              tubs”) make it safe to use bath oils, bubble bath, and
              bath salts in the spa. The use of these products is
              discouraged in tubs that recirculate water, as they can                    240-volt circuit. Like normal bathtubs, jetted tubs
              be harmful to the tub’s integral plumbing.                                 can be installed in a variety of ways. Here, we install a
                  A jetted spa model with no heater requires                             drop-in tub (no nailing flange) in a three-wall alcove.
              only a single 120-volt dedicated circuit with GFCI                         This may require the construction of one or two new
              protection. Models with heaters normally require                           stub walls to house the supply and drain plumbing
              either multiple dedicated 120-volt circuits or a                           and for mounting a deck-mounted faucet.

                                                        Jetted tubs offer a taste of luxury and some welcome physical therapy that many homeowners
                                                        enjoy. Best of all, many are sized so you can simply replace your old alcove-sized bathtub with
                                                        an upgraded model (the one shown is 32" wide by 60" long). You’ll need to provide a dedicated
                                                        electrical service line for the pump motor and, if your model has one, in-line heater.

   184        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 184 24/9/18 5:52 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 184 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:184

             WHIRLPOOLS
          Installing a whirlpool is very similar to installing a bathtub, once the rough-in is completed. Completing a rough-in for a
          whirlpool requires that you install a separate GFCI-protected electrical circuit for the pump motor. Some building codes
          specify that a licensed electrician be hired to wire whirlpools; check with your local building inspector.

          Select your whirlpool before you do rough-in work, because exact requirements will differ from model to model. Select
          your faucet to match the trim kit that comes with your whirlpool. When selecting a faucet, make sure the spout is large
          enough to reach over the tub rim. Most whirlpools use “widespread” faucets because the handles and spout are separate,
          and can be positioned however you like, even on opposite sides of the tub. Most building centers carry flex tube in a
          variety of lengths for connecting the faucet handles and spout.

                                                                                 Air volume controls

                                                             Jets

                                                                                                                          On/off switch

                                                                                                                          Overflow pipe

                                                                                                                            Drain tee

                      Pump                                                                Circulating pipes

          A whirlpool circulates aerated water through jets mounted in the body of the tub. Whirlpool pumps move as much as
          50 gallons of water per minute to create a relaxing hydromassage effect. The pump, pipes, jets, and most of the controls
          are installed at the factory, making the actual hookup in your home quite simple.

                                                                                                  INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   185

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 185 24/9/18 5:52 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 185 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:185

              Tub Installation Options

              Outdoor hot tubs can be inset into a deck or installed in a        Ledger boards may be tacked to the stud walls in the tub
              framed platform that can be built on just about any surface.       installation area. These are for leveling purposes only and are
              Before installing an outdoor hot tub on a deck, consult a          not intended to support the weight of the tub and its contents.
              structural engineer to inspect the deck and evaluate its ability   Support should be left to the subfloor and joists. If you are
              to support such a heavy item. In most cases you will need to       installing a tub where there previously was none, check with
              enhance the deck undercarriage to support a hot tub.               a building inspector to confirm that the structural members in
                                                                                 the installation area are adequate.

                                                                                                        A stub wall may be required at one or
                                                                                                        both ends of the tub so you can create an
                                                                                                        access panel to the pump. Stub walls also
                                                                                                        may be used to install supply and drain
                                                                                                        plumbing and to mount an electrical box
                                                                                                        to supply power to the pump motor or
                                                                                                        heater. The stub wall should not be used
                                                                                                        to support the tub rim.

                                                                                                          Dry-set tile mortar             Tub rim

                                                                                                          Top plate

                                                                                                         Plywood
                                                                                                         decking

                                                                                                                                              Tub

                                                                                                                          Ceramic tile

                                                                                                                          Cementboard

              A drop‑in tub has no apron and is designed to be installed in a framed deck. These                         Bottom plate
              decks, typically finished with cementboard and tile, are largely cosmetic and should
              contain access panels as required by the tub manufacturer. Often, they house a                              Subfloor
              deck-mounted faucet. The deck is not intended to support the tub rim, so leave a
              small gap between the finished deck and the tub.

   186        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 186 24/9/18 5:52 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 186 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:186

                  How to Install a Jetted Tub

                                                            Drain line
                                                                                                     Outline of wallcovering to
                                                                                                     be removed and replaced
                                                                       Water supply pipes                with cementboard

                                                                 Drain opening

            1                                                                                               Old tub area

       Remove the old tub. It is always easiest to replace a tub with one of the same size and orientation. However, if you are upgrading
       to a jetted tub consider choosing one that is larger than the standard tub you are replacing. In many cases, a wider tub may
       be installed with very minimal adjustment to the plumbing. The 32"-wide by 60"-long whirlpool tub that is being installed in
       this project is the same size as the old tub, but in order to accommodate a small deck at the head of the tub (for mounting the
       faucet set) the drain pipe needed to be extended outward 12". Also, a dedicated 20-amp GFCI electrical circuit needed to be
       installed for the pump.

       NOTE: The model of tub you select, as well as the overall installation method, will determine the exact sequence of steps
       necessary to install, plumb, and wire your tub. Always read the manufacturer’s instructions closely and make certain to
       follow them.

                                                                                        Mark the height of the tub rim or flange onto the wall studs
                                                                                        and then remove the tub. If you are using leveling ledgers
                                                                                        (see page 177), you can attach them to the studs directly
                                                                                        below the lines. In the installation seen here, a small stub
                                                                                        wall will be made for the head and the foot of the tub. If this
                                                                                        is your plan, measure from the floor to your reference lines to
                                                                                        determine how tall you should build your stub wall or walls.

                                                                                                                                                     3

                                                                              2
       Remove the tub apron (if it has a removable apron) and set
       the tub so it fits against the stud walls in the installation area.
       Shim underneath the tub so it is perfectly level (some models
       have adjustable feet).                                                                                                                 (continued)

                                                                                                               INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   187

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 187 24/9/18 5:52 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 187 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:187

              Build a small wall frame for the head and the foot using
              ¾" plywood and 2 × 4s or 2 × 6s. Size the walls so they will
              be a small fraction of an inch shorter than the reference lines
              near the head and foot locations; include the thickness of
              the tile backer you are using in the height. The tub seen here
              has a vertical flange all the way around the rim, so the tile on
              the tops of the finished walls should just overlap the flange.
              Secure the wall frames by toe-nailing at floor joist locations.

                    4

                                                   Tub flange reference line

                                                                                     5
                                                                                 Extend the old drain hole in the subfloor if necessary. Because
                                                                                 of the 12"-wide stub wall at the tub head, the new tub is a foot
                                                                                 further away from the wall than the old tub.

                  6

              Make plumbing
              connections for the new
              drain line and P-trap,                                                 7
              making sure that the new
              drain pipe has the correct
                                                                                 Install electrical boxes and run new circuits if needed to supply
              minimum slope and that
                                                                                 power to the tub. If you are not comfortable doing your own
              the trap is positioned so
                                                                                 wiring or local codes don’t allow it, hire a professional electrician.
              it will align precisely with
                                                                                 The tub seen here does not have an in-line water heater, so it
              the tailpiece on the tub
                                                                                 requires electrical service for the pump motor only—a dedicated
              drain kit.
                                                                                 20-amp circuit with GFCI protection. Orient the electrical boxes
                                                                                 so the receptacle they contain will be easily accessible from the
                                                                                 access panel opening in the walls or tub skirt.

   188        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 188 24/9/18 5:52 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 188 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:188

            8
                                                                                                                                              9
       OPTION: Install wall-mounted controls for turning the
       pump on and off and for setting the temperature                            Attach the drain/overflow pipe assembly to the tub prior to
       controls if your tub has a heater. You will need to have                   installation using rubber gaskets and pipe joint compound.
       all new wiring inspected and approved by your local                        Measure the distance the drain tailpiece will need to drop
       electrical inspector.                                                      to connect with the drain trap, and trim the tailpiece to
                                                                                  fit (inset).

                                                                             10
                                                                                     Mix a batch of thinset mortar and shovel it in
                                                    Drain strainer
                                                                                     a 1"-thick layer in the tub installation area,
                                                                                     limiting the material to just those areas that
                                                                                     will contact the tub bottom. In many cases,
                                                                                     the tub has several pads adhered to the
                                                                                     underside that function as feet.

                                                                                     TIP: Moisten the subfloor so it does not
                                                                                     draw water out of the thinset too quickly.

                                                                                       11

                                                                 Overflow
                                                                coverplate

       Secure the drain/overflow assembly by tightening the overflow
       coverplate and the drain strainer onto the assembly from
       inside the tub.                                                                                                                 (continued)

                                                                                                        INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   189

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 189 24/9/18 5:52 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 189 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:189

              Slide or lower the tub
              into the installation
              area, taking care                    12
              not to disturb the
              drain/overflow
              assembly. Make sure
              the drain tailpiece
              aligns exactly over
              the P-trap opening.
              Seat the tub or tub
              feet into the mortar
              bed—apply pressure
              as needed until the
              tub aligns with your
              leveling reference
              marks or ledgers.
                                                                       Thinset mortar bed

              Double check to make
              sure the tub is level.
              If it is too low in any              13
              spot, add thinset
              mortar underneath
              the tub or foot at that
              spot. Let the mortar
              dry overnight.

                                                                                                                    Plug the pump motor into the dedicated,
                                                                            TIP                                     GFCI circuit. Reattach the tub apron.

                                                                                                                       15

                                                                         Test the drain system to make sure
                14                                                       it does not leak. Using a hose, first
                                                                         add a small amount of water and
                                                                         visually inspect the slip fittings
              Connect the drain tailpiece from the                       and the area around the drain
              DWO kit mounted on the tub to the trap                     body. If it looks good, fill the tub
              in the drain opening. You should be                        up past the overflow line to make
              able to access this connection if you                      sure the overflow pipe seal does
              reach through the apron area in the                        not leak. Drain the tub.
              front of the tub skirt.

   190        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 190 24/9/18 5:53 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 190 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:190

                  How to Finish a Jetted Tub Area
                                                                                                             Install a vapor barrier around the tub
                                                                                                             area by stapling 6-mil plastic sheeting
            1                                                                                                to the wall studs. This is not intended
                                                                                                             as a waterproofing measure and is not a
                                                                                                             substitute for a waterproof membrane if
                                                                                                             you are creating a shower surround.

                                                                                                             Install wall surface in the tub area. Use
                                                                                                             cementboard. Once all the surfaces,
            2                                                                                                both horizontal and vertical, are
                                                                                                             covered, begin marking layout lines for
                                                                                                             the tile you’re using.

                                                               Install the spout supply valves and hook
                                                               them up to the supply risers. Tubs are
                                                               not predrilled for faucets as sinks are,                                            5
                                                               so you’ll need to decide whether to drill
                                                               holes for the valves in the tub rim using
                                                               a step bit or to mount the faucet in the
                                                               platform or the rim of the support wall.

                                                                       4

            3                                                                                                Attach the spout and the valve handles,
                                                                                                             and test the supply system. To clear any
                                                                                                             debris from the lines, remove the spout
       Install your finished wall coverings                                                                  aerator and run both hot and cold water
       (tile in most cases).                                                                                 for a minute or so.

                                                                                                             INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   191

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 191 24/9/18 5:53 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 191 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:191

              Bidets
                                                                                                     TOOLS & MATERIALS

              B    idets continue to find an audience among American homeowners
                   who have traveled abroad or just visited a house or hotel with
              this distinctly continental fixture. The bidet is intended as a more
                                                                                                  Tape measure
                                                                                                  Drill
              hygienic alternative to toilet paper, and a natural companion to the                Adjustable wrench
              toilet proper.                                                                      Level
                  As homeowners in this country continue a trend toward remodeling
                                                                                                  Silicone sealant
              bathrooms for greater luxury, convenience, and comfort, many are
              installing bidets. The fixture includes both hot and cold controls with a           (2) 3⁄8" shutoff valves
              spray head or sprayer, depending on the model. Most bidets have a pop-              (2) 3⁄8" supply lines
              up drain. Of course, you can opt for a combination toilet/bidet if space or         P‑trap
              plumbing requirements are an issue, and you can even buy a bidet seat to            Tubing cutter
              retrofit an existing toilet.
                  Installing a bidet is not much different than installing a bathroom             Plumber’s putty
              sink, except that a bidet can be plumbed to a waste line under the                  Thread tape
              floor, much like a shower would be. Bidets may have single or multiple              Bidet
              deck holes for faucets, so it’s important to shop wisely and buy                    Bidet faucet
              compatible components.

                                                                                                                   A bidet is a useful
                                                                                                                   companion to a
                                                                                                                   toilet, and it is a
                                                                                                                   luxury item you
                                                                                                                   and your family
                                                                                                                   will appreciate.

   192

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 192 24/9/18 5:53 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 192 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:192

                                                                                                                                   Bidet faucet

                                                                                                       Stopper
                                                                                                                                        Pop-up
                                                                                                                                        lift rod

                 Option:
              Wall drain arm

                                                                                        Pop-up
                                                                                       mechanism

                  Option:                                                                             To floor drain
              Floor drain arm

       Bidet drains have more in common with sink drains than with toilet drains. Some even attach to a drain arm in the wall, with
       a P-trap that fits between the fixture drain tailpiece and the arm. Other bidets drain into a floor drain outlet with a trap that’s
       situated between the tailpiece and the branch drain line.

                                                                  Overflow

                                                                       Stool (basin)

                                                                        Bidet faucet

                     Stopper

                                                       Bolts              Drain line

          Lift rod

                                                Trap
                                                                                       OPTION: You can get all the features of a bidet on your
       A bidet requires a special faucet that allows you to mix                        existing toilet with a number of aftermarket bidet seats.
       hot and cold water to a temperature you find comfortable.                       These seats feature heaters, sprayers, and dryers in basic
       It has a third knob to control the water pressure. The                          or deluxe versions. Installation is easy, and no additional
       aerator and spout pivot to allow you to adjust the spray to a                   space is needed.
       comfortable height.

                                                                                                          INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   193

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 193 24/9/18 5:53 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 193 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:193

                          How to Install a Bidet

                    1

                                                                                       2
              Rough‑in supply and drain lines according to the manufacturer’s      Apply a roll of plumber’s putty around the underside of the
              specifications. If you do not have experience installing home        drain flange. Wrap the bottom 2⁄3 of the flange threads with
              plumbing, hire a plumber for this part of the job. Apply a coil of   three layers of Teflon tape. Make sure to wrap the tape
              plumber’s putty to the base of the bidet faucet, and then insert     clockwise so that tightening the nut will not bunch up the
              the faucet body into the mounting holes. Thread the washers          tape. Insert the flange in the drain hole, place the gasket
              and locknut onto the faucet body shank and hand tighten.             and washer, and then thread the nut onto the flange. Do not
              Remove any plumber’s putty squeeze-out.                              fully tighten.

                    3

                                                                                       4
              Install the pop‑up drain apparatus according to the                  Place the bidet in its final location, checking that supply and
              manufacturer’s instructions.                                         drain lines will be in alignment. Mark the locations of the two
                                                                                   side-mounting holes through the predrilled holes on the stool
                                                                                   and onto the floor.

   194        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 194 24/9/18 5:53 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 194 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:194

            5                                                                   6

       Remove the bidet, and drill 3⁄16" pilot holes at the marks on the    Connect the water supply risers to the bidet faucet using
       floor. Drive the floor bolts (included with the bidet basin) into    compression unions. Make sure to hook the hot and cold
       the holes. Position the bidet so the floor bolts fit into the bolt   risers up to the correct ports on the faucet.
       holes in the base.

                                                                       7                                                               8
       Hook up the drain line by attaching the P-trap to the drain          Remove the aerator so any debris in the supply line will clear,
       tailpiece. The trap is then attached to a branch drain line          and then turn on the water and open both faucets. Check for
       coming out of the wall or floor in the same manner as a              leaks in lines and fix them, if found. Assemble the bolt caps
       sink drain.                                                          and thread them onto the floor bolts.

                                                                            NOTE: Do not dispose of paper in the bidet—return to the
                                                                            toilet to dry off after using the bidet for cleaning.

                                                                                                   INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   195

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 195 24/9/18 5:53 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 195 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:195

              Water Softeners

              I  f your house has hard water coursing through its
                 pipes, then you’ve got a couple of problems. Not
              only does your water do a poor job of dissolving soap,
              but you also have plenty of scale deposits on dishes,
              plumbing fixtures, and the inside of your water heater.
                   Softeners fix these problems by chemically
              removing the calcium and magnesium that are
              responsible for the hard water (usually described as
              over 17 grains of minerals per gallon). These units are
              installed after the water meter but before the water
              line branches off to appliances or fixtures, with one
              exception: Piping to outside faucets should branch
              off the main line before the softener, because treating
              outside water is a waste of money.
                   Softeners come with an overflow tube and a purge
              tube to rinse out the minerals that are extracted from
              the water. These tubes should drain to a floor drain or
              to a laundry sink basin, which is the better approach
              if the sink is close by. Remember to leave an air gap
              between the tube and the sink or floor drain. Do not
              connect the tube directly to a drain or vent pipe.

                     KNOW YOUR TYPES OF SALT
                  Salt for water softeners comes in three basic types:
                  rock salt, solar salt (crystals), and evaporated salt
                  (pellets). Rock salt is a mineral that’s mined from salt
                  deposits. Solar salt is a crystalline residue left behind
                  when seawater is evaporated naturally. It sometimes is
                  sold as pellets or blocks. Evaporated salt is similar to
                  solar salt, but the liquid in the brine is evaporated using
                  mechanical methods. Rock salt is cheapest but leaves
                  behind the most residue and therefore requires more
                  frequent brine tank cleaning. Evaporated salt pellets are
                  the cleanest and require the least maintenance.               A modern water softener is a single appliance, with the
                                                                                softener resting on top of the salt storage tank.

                     TOOLS & MATERIALS
                  Tape measure                             Propane torch        Steel wool                       Solder
                  Tubing cutter                            Slip‑joint pliers    Soldering flux                   4"‑thick concrete blocks

   196        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 196 24/9/18 5:53 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 196 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:196

                               3-VALVE BYPASS                                      SOFTENED WATER
                      Bypass valve                                              From your plumbing’s point of view, the best water
                                                                                softening strategy is to position the softener close to the
                                                                                main, cold-only supply line (as seen here). Doing this
                                                                                results in both hot and cold water being softened. But
                                                                                because some homeowners object to the altered taste
                                                            Inlet valve         and increased salinity of softened water, the softener
                                                                                may be installed after the hot and cold lines have split
                                                        To water                from the main supply line. This way, the water may be
               Outlet                                   softener                softened immediately before it enters the heater, and
               valve                                                            the cold water remains unsoftened.

               From water
                softener

                                                                                                Main water
                                                                                                                       Cold
                                                                                                supply line
                                                                                                                    supply line
                                                                                              to water heater
       In some areas you are required to install a water softener
       with three valves, as shown. This arrangement allows you to
       bypass the water softener so water can run to the house when
       and if the softener is disconnected.

                  How to Install a Water Softener
       Install the bypass valve in the softener’s head. One side of the
       valve goes in the inlet port and the other fits into the outlet
       port. This valve is held in place with simple plastic clips or
       threaded couplings.

       NOTE: Check local codes for bypass requirements.

                                                                          1

                                                                                                                                         2
                                                                              The overflow tube is usually connected to the side of the
                                                                              softener’s tank. Run this tube, along with the discharge tube,
                                                                              to a floor drain or a laundry sink.

                                                                                                                                    (continued)

                                                                                                     INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   197

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 197 24/9/18 5:53 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 197 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:197

                  3                                                                   4

              Measure the distance between the bypass ports on the tank to        Use two wrenches to tighten the tube nuts, one holding the
              the cold water supply line. Cut copper tubing to fit this space,    valve stable. Don’t overtighten or you may break plastic parts
              and solder appropriate fittings onto both ends.                     in the valve.

                    5                                                                                                                          6
              Connect the copper tubing from the softener to the water            To maintain electrical bonding in a metal supply tube system,
              supply lines. Clean all fittings and pipes with steel wool. Then,   connect the copper lines with a bonding clamp.
              apply soldering flux to the parts and solder them together with
              a propane torch.

   198        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 198 24/9/18 5:53 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 198 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:198

            7

                                                                                      8

       Install the plastic tubing discharge tube on the head of the          Run the tank overflow hose and the drain tube to a nearby
       water softener following the manufacturer’s directions.               floor drain or utility sink (inset), not into a drain or vent pipe.
                                                                             The hoses should be secured so they don’t flop around, and
                                                                             their ends must be at least 1½" above a drain.

            9                                                                   10

       Follow manufacturer’s instructions to purge the air from the          Turn on the water supply and make sure the installation works
       water softener. First run water with the valve in the bypass          properly. If you see any leaks, fix them. Then add the water
       position, then pull the valve out so it is in the service position.   softening pellets to the top of the unit in the ratios explained
                                                                             on the package.

                                                                                                     INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   199

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 199 24/9/18 5:53 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 199 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:199

              Pedestal &                                                         TOOLS & MATERIALS

              Console Sinks                                                   Pedestal sink                  2 × 4 lumber
                                                                              Caulk gun & silicone caulk Water‑resistant drywall

              P    edestal sinks remain a popular option for
                   homeowners outfitting space-challenged
              bathrooms, or just looking for a more streamlined
                                                                              Stud finder
                                                                              Ratchet wrench
                                                                                                             Pencil
                                                                                                             Drill
                                                                              Basin wrench                   Eye & ear protection
              sink option. The tiny footprint of these sinks allows
              for easy cleaning and movement around the sinks.                Lag screws                     Work gloves
              This bathroom fixture is available in an amazing array
              of design styles, and you can be confident that if you
              opt for a pedestal sink, you can find one to suit exactly         Pedestal sinks are mounted in one of two ways.
              your taste or the look of any bathroom.                       Most inexpensive models are hung in much the
                  The primary drawback to pedestal sinks is                 same way as wall-mounted sinks are. The pedestal is
              that they don’t offer any storage. Their chief                actually installed after the sink is hung, and its purpose
              practical benefit is that they conceal plumbing               is purely decorative. But other, higher-end pedestal
              some homeowners would prefer to keep out of                   sinks have structural pedestals that bear the weight
              sight. Console sinks, with their two front legs, offer        of the sink. All console sinks are mounted to the wall,
              some space underneath for rolling shelf units or a            although the front legs offer additional support and
              towel basket.                                                 resistance to users leaning on the front of the sink.

              A console bathroom sink is a wall-mounted lavatory with two   A pedestal sink typically is hung on the wall. The primary
              front legs that provide backup support. Many have a narrow    function of the pedestal is to conceal plumbing and provide
              apron to conceal the drain trap.                              visual appeal.

   200        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 200 24/9/18 5:53 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 200 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:200

                  How to Install a Pedestal Sink

           Install 2 × 4 blocking between the wall
           studs behind the planned sink location.
           Cover the wall with water-resistant drywall.

            1

                                                                                          2
                                                                                      Set the basin and pedestal in position and brace them with
                                                                                      2 × 4s. Outline the top of the basin on the wall, and mark the
           Wall surface shown                                                         base of the pedestal on the floor. Mark reference points on the
           cut away for clarity                                                       wall and floor through the mounting holes found on the back
                                                                                      of the sink and the bottom of the pedestal.

       Set aside the basin and pedestal. Drill                                                                Hook up the drain and supply fittings.
       pilot holes in the wall and floor at the                                                               Caulk between the back of the sink and
       reference points, then reposition                                                                      the wall when installation is finished.
       the pedestal. Anchor the pedestal to the
       floor with lag screws.

                                                  3

                                                                       4
                                                               Attach the faucet set to the sink, then set
                                                               the sink onto the pedestal. Align the holes
                                                               on the back flange of the sink with the
                                                               pilot holes drilled in the wall, then drive
                                                               lag screws with washers into the wall
                                                               brace using a ratchet wrench. Attach the           5
                                                               sink-stopper mechanism to the sink drain.

                                                                                                              INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   201

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 201 24/9/18 5:53 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 201 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:201

              Wall-Mounted Sinks
              There are many benefits to a wall-mounted sink that,          We’ve opted to illustrate the installation of just such
              depending on your situation and needs, will offset        a sink in the instructions that follow. Keep in mind that
              the inherent lack of storage space. In contrast to        different manufacturers sometimes use very different
              the footprint of a traditional vanity-mounted sink,       mounting procedures. In any case, the idea remains
              wall-mounted units can save space on the sides and        the same: strongly secure the sink to studs or blocking,
              in front of the fixture. More importantly, they are an    so that it is completely stable and will not fall.
              essential addition to a Universal Design bathroom             The most involved part of the installation process
              where wheelchair accessibility is a key consideration.    is usually rerouting water supply and drain lines as
              It’s why these particular fixtures are sometimes called   necessary. You should hire a licensed plumber for
              “roll-under” sinks.                                       this if you’re not comfortable with the work. Once the
                   All that practicality aside, early models at the     plumbing is in place, the installation is quick and easy.
              lower end of the price spectrum were somewhat
              unattractive because their designs simply left the
              drain tailpiece, trap, and supply shut-off valves in          TOOLS & MATERIALS
              plain sight. But there’s no need for you to settle
              for a less-than-handsome wall-mounted sink.                 Carpenter’s level               Phillips screwdriver
              Manufacturers have developed two solutions to the           Adjustable wrenches             Standard screwdriver
              problem of exposed plumbing. Some are designed              Pipe wrench                     Jigsaw
              with a bowl that conceals supply line shut-offs,
              replacing the trap with sleekly designed tailpieces         Channel‑type pliers             Basin wrench
              and squared off trap bends. The other solution, and         Cordless power drill            Tape measure
              one more widely available, is a wall-mounted pedestal          & bits                       Hacksaw
              that covers the plumbing. Sinks with this feature are       Tubing cutter                   2 × 8 lumber
              sometimes called “semi-pedestal.”

                                                                                                                      Although a wall‑
                                                                                                                      mounted sink
                                                                                                                      offers many
                                                                                                                      benefits—
                                                                                                                      accessibility
                                                                                                                      to wheelchair
                                                                                                                      users among
                                                                                                                      them—there’s no
                                                                                                                      need to sacrifice
                                                                                                                      chic style for
                                                                                                                      that functionality.

   202

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 202 24/9/18 5:53 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 202 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:202

                  How to Install a Wall-Mounted Sink
                                                                                   Remove the existing sink, if any. Remove
                                                                                   wall coverings as necessary to install
                                    Double 2 × 8 blocking
                                                                        1          blocking for mounting the sink. Reroute
                                                                                   water supply and drain lines as necessary,
                                                                                   according to the sink manufacturer’s
                                                                                   directions. The sink in this project required
                                                                                   the centerpoints of the waste pipe be 21"
                                                                                   and the supply lines 24¾" up from the
         2 × 4 block for                                                           finished floor. If unsure of your plumbing
          supply lines                                                             skills or code requirements, hire a
                                                                                   professional plumber for this part of the
                                                                 24¾"              project. Install blocking between the studs
                                                                                   for attaching the mounting bracket for the
                                21"
                                                                                   sink. A doubled 2 × 8 is installed here.
                                                                                   Have your plumbing inspected, if required
                                                                                   by your municipality, before you install the
                                                                                   drywall and finished wall surface.

                                                                                   Drill guide holes for the mounting bolts if
                                                                                   your sink is a direct-mount model, as this
            2                                                                      one is. Some wall-hung sinks are hung from
                                                                                   a mounting bracket. The bolts used to hang
                                                                                   this sink are threaded like lag screws on
                                                                                   one end, with a bolt end that projects from
                                                                                   the wall. The guide holes should be spaced
                                                                                   exactly as the manufacturer specifies so
                                                                                   they align with the mounting holes in the
                                                                                   back mounting flange on the sink.

                                                                                   TIP: Protect tile surfaces with
                                                                                   masking tape in the drilling areas to
                                                                                   avoid chip-out.

                                                                                   Drive the threaded mounting bolts (screw
                                                                                   end first) into the guide holes. There should
                  Doubled nuts to drive                                            be pilot holes (smaller than the guide
                   bolt into blocking                                              holes) driven into the blocking. To drive this
                                                                                   hardware, spin a pair of nuts onto the bolt
                                                                                   end and turn the bolt closest to you with a
                                                                                   wrench. Drive the mounting bolt until the
                                                                                   end is projecting out from the wall by a little
                                                                                   more than 1½". Remove the nuts. Install the
                                                                                   pop-up drain in the sink, and then slide the
                                                                                   sink over the ends of the mounting bolts so
                                                                                   the mounting flange is flush against the wall.
                                                                                   You’ll want help for this. Thread the washers
                                                                                   and nuts onto the ends of the mounting
                                                                                   bolts, and hand-tighten. Check to make sure
                                                                                   the sink is level, and then tighten the nuts
                                                                                   with a socket wrench, reaching up into the
                                                                                   void between the basin and the flange. Don’t
                                                                        3          overtighten—you could crack the sink flange.
                                                                                                                      (continued)

                                                                                       INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   203

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 203 24/9/18 5:53 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 203 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:203

                  4

                                                                                                                                                                  Po

                                                                                                                                            5
              Have a helper hold the sink pedestal (in this model, a half-      Remove the pedestal, and drill the pilot holes for the pedestal-
              pedestal) in position against the underside of the sink. Mark     mounting bolts, which work much in the same way as the
              the edges of the pedestal on the wall covering as reference       sink-mounting bolts. Drill guide and pilot holes, then drive the
              for installing the pedestal-mounting hardware. Remove             mounting bolts, leaving about 1¼" of the bolt end exposed.
              the pedestal.

                  6

                                                                                                                                            7

              Install the drain and drain tailpiece on the sink. Also mount     Complete the drain connection by installing a P-trap assembly
              the faucet body to the sink deck if you have not done so          that connects the tailpiece and the trap arm. Also connect the
              already. Attach the drain trap arm to the drain stub out in the   drain pop-up rod that projects out of the tailpiece to the pop-
              wall, and attach shutoff valves to the drain supply lines.        up plunger mechanism you’ve already installed.

   204        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 204 2/10/18 9:50 AM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 204 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:204

                                                                               LEAK FINDER
          8             Pedestal mounting hardware

                                                                            To quickly and easily find an undersink leak, lay bright
                                                                            white paper or paper towels under the pipes and drain
                                                   Shutoff valves           connections. Open the water supply valves and run
                                                                            water in the sinks. It should be clear exactly where
                                                                            the water dripped from by the location of the drip
                                                                            on the paper.

    Pop-up plunger

                          Tailpiece

                                                           Drain arm

       Make sure the shutoff valve fittings are tight and oriented
       correctly, and then hook up the faucet supply risers to the
       shutoff valves. Turn on the water supply and test.

            9                                                                10
       Slide the pedestal into place on the mounting studs. Working       Attach the towel bar to the sink by first pushing the well nuts
       through the access space under the sink, use a wrench              into the holes on the underside of the sink rim. Set the bar in
       to tighten the mounting nut over the washer on the stud.           place, and screw in the attachment screws on both sides, just
       Carefully tighten the nut until the pedestal is held securely in   until snug.
       place. Be careful not to overtighten the nut.

                                                                                                 INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   205

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 205 2/10/18 9:51 AM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 205 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:205

              Traditional Vanity

              S   imple vanity bases are stages upon which much
                  of the drama in a bathroom can play out. Because
              there are now so many sink and counter styles and
              materials, and ways of incorporating the two, a stable
              base that can be attractive in its own right is more
              important than ever.
                 Although vanity cabinet styles vary, the basic
              structure—such as incorporating a toe-kick—is
              common to the majority of them. The process
              outlined here covers the basic way that most vanities
              are secured in place to provide ample storage and                          A traditional bathroom base cabinet serves to support an
              sturdy foundation for sinks and countertops.                               integral sink-countertop unit.

                     TOOLS & MATERIALS
                  Pencil                     Basin wrench              Plumber’s putty   Tub & tile caulk      3" drywall screws     Eye & ear
                  Carpenter’s level          Cardboard                 Lag screws        4' level              Drill                    protection
                  Screwdriver                Masking tape              Stud finder       Shims                 Work gloves

                          How to Install a Vanity Cabinet
              Measure and mark the top edge of the vanity cabinet on the
              wall, then use an electronic level/stud finder to mark the stud
              locations and a level line.

                    1

                                                                                             2
                                                                                         Slide the vanity into position so that the back rail of the
                                                                                         cabinet can later be fastened to studs at both corners and
                                                                                         in the center. The back of the cabinet should also be flush
                                                                                         against the wall. (If the wall surface is uneven, position the
                                                                                         vanity so it contacts the wall in at least one spot and the back
                                                                                         cabinet rail is parallel with the wall.)

   206        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 206 24/9/18 5:53 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 206 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:206

                                                                       VARIATION: To install two or more cabinets, set the cabinets in position against
                                                                       the wall, and align the cabinet fronts. If one cabinet is higher than the other,
                                                  3                    shim under the lower cabinet until the two are even. Clamp the cabinet faces
                                                                       together, then drill countersunk pilot holes spaced 12" apart through the face
                                                                       frames so they go at least halfway into the face frame of the second cabinet.
       Using a level as a guide, shim below the                        Drive wood screws through the pilot holes to join the cabinets together.
       vanity cabinet until the unit is level.

                                                                               4              5

       At the stud locations marked on the wall, drive 3" drywall                        Run a bead of caulk along small gaps between the vanity and
       screws through the rail on the cabinet back and into the                          wall and between the vanity and floor. For larger gaps, use
       framing members. The screws should be driven at both                              ¼-round molding between the vanity and wall. Between the
       corners and in the center of the back rail.                                       vanity and floor, install the same baseboard material used to
                                                                                         cover the gap between the wall and floor.

                                                                                                                INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   207

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 207 24/9/18 5:53 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 207 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:207

              Vanity Top
              with Integral Sink

              P    erhaps the easiest sink of all to install is one
                   in which the countertop and sink are a single
              integrated unit that simply is attached to a standard
              vanity cabinet. These integrated sinks now come
              in hundreds of different styles and in a variety of
              materials, including premium solid-surface materials
              or synthetic stones. Gone are the days when
                                                                               An integral sink‑countertop is the traditional match to a stock
              integrated sinks were those plastic faux-marble units            bathroom base cabinet.
              that looked as cheap as they were. Today’s integrated
              bathroom sinks can be quite attractive as a design
              statement and are available in lots of different shapes               TOOLS & MATERIALS
              and configurations.
                  What hasn’t changed, though, is the ease with                   Level                            Silicone caulk
              which they can be installed—a feature that makes                    Shims                            Caulk gun
              them very attractive to DIYers. Since integral sinks are
                                                                                  Faucet & drain fittings          Eye & ear protection
              predrilled for faucet and drain hookups, installing one
              is really just a matter of laying the unit on the vanity            Wrenches                         Work gloves
              cabinet, leveling and attaching it, and making the                  Plumber's putty
              plumbing connections.

                          How to Install a Vanity Top with Integral Sink

                    1                                                              2
              Check the vanity cabinet to make sure it is level. If not, you   Test‑fit the countertop‑sink unit to make sure it fits solidly on the
              can place a shim under the base of the cabinet to bring it       vanity. If it wobbles, or if the cabinet itself could not be leveled,
              to level.                                                        you can level the countertop by placing shims between the
                                                                               bottom of the countertop and the top edge of the vanity cabinet.

   208        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 208 24/9/18 5:54 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 208 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:208

            3                                                                              4

       Remove the sink‑countertop, place it on sawhorses, and then                    Begin installing the drain unit, again following the package
       attach the faucet unit using the predrilled cutouts in the                     instructions. Make sure to use plumber’s putty or sealant
       countertop. This is an easy matter of threading the mounting                   between the sink surface and the bottom of the drain flange.
       nuts onto the faucet tailpieces from below, but always make
       sure to follow the faucet manufacturer’s directions. If you
       wish, you can also preattach the water-supply tubes to the
       bottom of the faucet tailpieces.

                                                               Finish up the drain installation by
                                                               connecting the drain-stopper cable or
                                                  5            lever to the pop-up drain fitting on the
                                                                                                                  Complete the drain hookups
                                                               drain tailpiece.
                                                                                                                  by connecting the drain
                                                                                                                  trap to the sink tailpiece
                                                                                                                  at the drain-arm pipe.
                                                                                                                  Connect the water-supply
                                                                                                                  tubes from the faucet
                                                                                                                  tailpieces to the shutoff
                                                                                                                  valves inside the cabinet.

                                                                                                                  7

                                                               Apply a bead of silicone caulk around
                                                               the top lip of the vanity cabinet. Silicone
                                                  6            caulk has good adhesive properties,
                                                               and no other fasteners are required.
                                                               Set the sink-countertop unit onto the
                                                               cabinet, and press down firmly to
                                                               bond it to the cabinet. Let the caulk
                                                               dry completely before completing the
                                                               plumbing hookups.

                                                                                                              INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   209

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 209 24/9/18 5:54 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 209 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:209

              Plumbing a Double-Bowl Vanity
              Side-by-side sinks are a bathroom luxury, especially
              for busy couples (which accounts for why they
              are called “his-and-her” sinks) or busy bathrooms.
              Although the basics of installing a vanity for a double
              sink are structurally the same as a single-bowl vanity,
              the plumbing requires modification to accommodate
              the extra fixture.

                     TOOLS & MATERIALS
                  Carpenter’s level                     Silicone caulk
                  Screwdrivers                          Dual outlet valves
                  Drill & bits                          Braided steel supply lines
                  Basin wrench                          P‑trap                       Double‑bowl vanities have drain plumbing that’s very similar to
                  Stud finder                           PVC connections              double-bowl kitchen sinks. In most cases, the drain tailpieces are
                                                                                     connected beneath one of the tailpieces at a continuous waste
                  Adjustable wrench                     Plumber’s putty              tee. The drainline from the second bowl must slope downward
                  Hacksaw                               Caulk gun                    toward the tee. From the tee, the drain should have a trap (usually
                                                                                     a P-Trap) that connects to the trap arm coming out of the wall.

                          How to Plumb a Double Sink

                   1

                                                                                         2
              Shut off the supply valves located under the sink. Disconnect          Remove the existing countertop and vanity. Turn off the house water
              and remove the supply lines connecting the faucet to the               supply at the main shut-off valve. Drain the remaining water
              valves. Loosen the P-trap nuts at both ends and remove                 by opening the faucet at the lowest point in the house. Use a
              the P-trap.                                                            hacksaw to remove existing undersink shutoff valves.

   210        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 210 24/9/18 5:54 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 210 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:210

                                                                                        Secure the new vanity in place by screwing it to the wall.
                                                                                        Lay a bead of caulk along the underside and back edge
                                                                                        of the countertop, where it will contact the vanity and wall.
                                                                                        Set the countertop in place and check it for level. If your
                                                                                        sinks are not integral, install them according to the type of
                                                                                        sink you’re using.

                                                                                                                                                 4

            3
       Slide the new dual‑outlet valve onto the
       hot water supply line, pass the nut and
       compression washer over the pipe, and
       tighten with a wrench. Install the dual-
       outlet valve on the cold supply line in
       the same way.

                                                               Connect a new PVC P‑trap to the
                                                               undersink drain pipe, and attach a
                                                               tee connector to the trap. Extend PVC
                                                               connections to the drain assemblies of
                                                               both sinks.

                                                                                                6

            5                                                                                                  7
       Seat the faucets for the double sinks                                                               Connect the pop‑up stopper linkage.
       as you would for a single sink, by                                                                  Connect the cold water supply lines to
       applying a bead of putty on the                                                                     the appropriate faucet tailpieces and
       underside of the bases (unless they                                                                 repeat with the hot water supply lines.
       are to be used with gaskets instead                                                                 Turn on the main water supply, remove
       of putty). Secure them in place by                                                                  the faucet aerator, and run the water
       tightening the locking nuts on the                                                                  in the sinks. Check for leaks, and then
       underside of the faucets.                                                                           replace the aerator.

                                                                                                           INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   211

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 211 24/9/18 5:54 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 211 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:211

              Kitchen Sinks                                                                                    TOOLS & MATERIALS
                                                                                                            Spud wrench
                                                                                                            Screwdriver
              M       ost drop-in, self-rimming kitchen sinks are easily installed. Drop-in
                      sinks for do-it-yourself installation are made from cast iron coated
              with enamel, stainless steel, enameled steel, acrylic, fiberglass, or resin
                                                                                                            Sink
                                                                                                            Sink frame
              composites. Because cast-iron sinks are heavy, their weight holds them                        Plumber’s putty or silicone caulk
              in place and they require no mounting hardware. Except for the heavy                             & caulk gun
              lifting, they are easy to install. Stainless steel and enameled-steel sinks                   Mounting clips
              weigh less than cast-iron, and most require mounting brackets on the
              underside of the countertop. Some acrylic and resin sinks rely on silicone                    Jigsaw
              caulk to hold them in place.                                                                  Pen or pencil
                   If you are replacing a sink, but not the countertop, make sure the new                   Eye & ear protection
              sink is the same size or larger. All old silicone caulk residue must be removed               Work gloves
              with acetone or denatured alcohol, or else the new caulk will not stick.

                      SHOPPING TIPS
                  •    When purchasing a sink, you also need to buy strainer bodies and baskets, sink clips, and a drain trap kit.

                  •    Look for basin dividers that are lower than the sink rim—this reduces splashing.

                  •    Drain holes in the back or to the side make for more usable space under the sink.

                  •    When choosing a sink, make sure the predrilled openings will fit your faucet.

                                                                                                          Drop‑in sinks, also known as
                                                                                                          self-rimming sinks, have a wide
                                                                                                          sink flange that extends beyond the
                                                                                                          edges of the sink cutout. They also
                                                                                                          have a wide back flange to which
                                                                                                          the faucet is mounted directly.

   212

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 212 24/9/18 5:54 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 212 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:212

                  How to Install a Self-Rimming Sink

          1                                                            2                                         3
       Invert the sink and trace around the                    Drill a starter hole and cut out the sink     Attach as much of the plumbing as
       edges as a reference for making the                     opening with a jigsaw. Cut right up           makes sense to install prior to setting
       sink cutout cutting lines, which should                 to the line. Because the sink flange          the sink into the opening. Having
       be parallel to the outlines, but about 1"               fits over the edges of the cutout, the        access to the underside of the flange is
       inside of them to create a 1" ledge. If                 opening doesn’t need to be perfect, but       a great help when it comes to attaching
       your sink comes with a template for the                 as always you should try to do a nice,        the faucet body, sprayer, and strainer,
       cutout, use it.                                         neat job.                                     in particular.

          4                                                            5                                         6
       Apply a bead of silicone caulk around                   Place the sink in the opening. Try to         For sinks with mounting clips, tighten
       the edges of the sink opening. The sink                 get the sink centered right away so           the clips from below using a screwdriver
       flange most likely is not flat, so try and              you don’t need to move it around and          or wrench (depending on the type
       apply the caulk in the area that will                   disturb the caulk, which can break            of clip your sink has). There should
       make contact with the flange.                           the seal. If you are installing a heavy       be at least three clips on every side.
                                                               cast-iron sink, it’s best to leave the        Don’t overtighten the clips—this can
                                                               strainers off so you can grab onto            cause the sink flange to flatten or
                                                               the sink at the drain openings.               become warped.

                                                                                                             INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   213

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 213 24/9/18 5:54 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 213 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:213

                                                                                                                     E

                                                                                                                 F       F

                                                                                A

              Standpipe Drains                                                                                                 G

              A   standpipe drain allows you to drain a
                   water-consuming appliance (usually
              a washing machine) directly into the
                                                                                                   C
                                                                                                                     D

              waste system, instead of into a utility                                       B

              tub (also called a laundry tray). This
                                                                       A washing machine with standpipe drain: washing machine drain hose
              eliminates the possibility of the sink                   (A), 2" standpipe drain with trap (B), waste line (C), utility sink drain pipe
              drain plugging and causing the sink basin                (D), hot and cold supply lines with hose bibs (E), rubber supply hoses to
              to overflow (most utility sinks do not                   washing machine (F), and utility sink (G).
              have an overflow hole).
                 Some standpipes come with attached                         TOOLS & MATERIALS
              P-traps and can be purchased at many
              home centers.                                               Reciprocating saw            2½" deck screws             Sheet metal
                 A 2-inch pipe is required by most                        Utility knife                ½" screws                   Teflon tape
              building codes. The top of the standpipe
                                                                          Waste wye fitting            Pipe strap                  Rubber supply hose
              should be at least 18 inches high but
              no more than 42 inches above the                            Primer & solvent glue        Hose bibs                   Eye & ear protection
              floor. Hose bibs are installed in the                       90° elbow                    Solder                      Work gloves
              hot and cold supply lines at the utility                    2" standpipe with trap       Threaded tee fittings
              sink to provide the water supply to the                     2 × 4 backer                 Torch
              washing machine.

                          How to Install a Washing Machine Standpipe Drain
              Provide venting
              for the standpipe
              and/or the utility                                           1                                                           OPTION: Your
                                                                                                                                       building department
              sink. Some                                                                                                               may allow you to
              locales allow                                                                                                            vent the standpipe
              you to install                                                                                                           by installing an air
              an unvented                                                                                                              admittance valve
              standpipe, but                                                                   Air                                     (AAV). Consult
              most building                                                                 admittance                                 with your inspector
              departments now                                                                 valve                                    to be sure you
              require some sort                                                                                                        locate the AAV in
              of venting. In an                                                                                                        a code‑approved
              extreme case, you                                                                                                        manner. If you are
              may need to run                                                                                                          installing a utility
              a new vent up                                                                                                            sink instead of a
              through the roof.                                                                                                        standpipe, you may
                                                                                                                                       be able to install an
                                                                                                                                       AAV onto the drain
                                                                                                                                       trap under the sink.

   214        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 214 24/10/18 12:41 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 214 24/10/18 12:41 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:214

                             Utility sink drain pipe

               2

           Measure and mark the size and
           location of a waste wye fitting in                                  3
           the drain line. Remove the marked
           section using a reciprocating saw.
           Make cuts as straight as possible.                              Use a utility knife to remove rough burrs on the cut ends of the
                                                                           pipe. Dry-fit the waste wye fitting into the drain line to make
                                                                           sure it fits properly, then attach the wye fitting using primer
                                                                           and solvent cement.

                                                                       4

                                                                               5
       Dry‑fit a 90° elbow and a 2" standpipe with trap to the waste       Attach a 2 × 4 backer behind the top of the standpipe for support
       wye fitting. Make sure the top of the standpipe is between          using 2½" deck screws. Fasten the standpipe to the wood
       18" and 42" above the floor. Solvent-cement all the pipes           support using a length of pipe strap and ½" screws. Insert the
       in place.                                                           washing machine’s rubber drain hose into the standpipe.

                                                                                                  INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   215

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 215 24/9/18 5:54 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 215 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:215

                          How to Hook Up a Washing Machine Box
              Install hose bibs in the utility sink supply lines. Turn off water
              main and drain pipes. Cut into each supply pipe 6" to 12"
              from faucet. Solder threaded tee fittings into each supply line.                                       From washer
              Protect wood from the torch flame with two layers of sheet
              metal. Wrap Teflon tape around the threads of the hose bibs,
              and screw them into tee fittings. Connect a rubber supply
              hose from each bib to the appropriate intake port on the
              washing machine.

                    1                                                                                                          To washer

                                                                                                                                                 2
                                                                                      Recessed washing machine boxes are available for finished
                                                                                      utility rooms. The supply pipes and standpipe drain run
                                                                                      to one central location. The washing machine’s hose bibs,
                                                                                      supply hoses, and drain hose must remain easily accessible.

                     SAFE WASHING MACHINE WATER SUPPLY
                  Washing machine hoses usually last a long time, but “usually”
                  isn’t good enough. Because a damaged hose may drip or even
                  gush for a long time before it’s discovered, especially in a room
                  that’s infrequently used, it is recommended that hoses be
                  replaced every year or two.

                  For more peace of mind, consider two valve options. A
                  self-adjusting valve eliminates constant pressure on the
                  hoses and so lengthens their life. It turns on only when the
                  machine is being used. An automatic laundry shutoff valve
                  removes water pressure on the hoses when the machine is
                  not in use.

                  The self-adjusting valve shown is installed with the plumbing
                  inside a wall, for a neat look. Remove drywall, if there is any,
                  to expose the framing. Install the valve at the recommended
                  height by nailing its adjustable wings to studs on each side.
                  Run the supply pipes and the drain line between studs, attach
                  them to the valve, and test. Then apply drywall and add the
                  cover plate.

   216        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 216 24/9/18 6:06 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 216 24/9/18 6:06 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:216

                  How to Install a Utility Sink
       Assemble the sink. Work with the sink upside-down. For many
       models, the legs simply slip into slots at the corners.

            1

                                                                           2
                                                                       Attach the trap. Turn the sink sideways and install the strainer
                                                                       body: apply a rope of plumber’s putty to the underside of
                                                                       the flange, then tighten the nut on the underside of the
                                                                       sink. Assemble the drain trap. These plastic fittings can be
                                                                       tightened by hand.

                                                                                              Install and hook up the faucet. Turn the
                                                                                              sink right-side-up and install the faucet
                                                                                   3          in the sink’s holes, run flexible supply
                                                                                              lines to the hot and cold inlets, and
                                                                                              tighten with a wrench. Drive screws
                                                                                              through the holes in the legs to anchor
                                                                                              the sink to the floor (below). If you have
                                                                                              a concrete floor, you’ll need a masonry
                                                                                              bit and masonry screws.

                                                                                              INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   217

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 217 24/9/18 5:54 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 217 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:217

              Freestanding Tubs

              F   reestanding tubs offer maximum versatility in
                  bathroom design because, theoretically, they
              can be placed anywhere in the bathroom. They can
                                                                                  dwindling, they are still not hard to find, and in many
                                                                                  cases you can get one for the price of hauling it away
                                                                                  (no easy task). Often, the porcelain enamel finish
              even be installed in an alcove, in place of an alcove               needs refurbishing, which is a job best done by a tub-
              tub. However, because they are attractive from all                  reglazing specialist. The installation process is a fairly
              sides, and one of the key benefits is total access, most            simple one. The hardest part is usually running new
              homeowners install freestanding tubs with some                      drain and supply lines under the floor, so if you can
              measure of floor space all around the tub.                          place the tub over existing lines, you greatly simplify
                  Another selling point is the amazing variety                    the installation process.
              among freestanding tubs. Options include the vast                      Regardless of the tub you choose, check with
              array of clawfoot tubs and pedestal tubs in styles                  your local building inspector to help you determine
              from modern to classical. Rolltop freestanding tubs                 whether your floor has adequate structural
              feature a rolled top lip that makes getting into and out            strength to safely support a freestanding tub. The
              of the tub easy. These are often egg shaped and deep,               inspector may suggest (or require) that you have
              offering a comfortable soak after a long day. Slipper               the potential location evaluated by a qualified
              tubs offer a more dramatic shape, like Cinderella’s ball            structural engineer.
              slipper, with a high, sloped back that allows the bather
              to recline in ultimate comfort.
                  Clawfoot tubs are a category all their own.                           TOOLS & MATERIALS
              Although cast iron is the traditional material
              for clawfoots, manufacturers also offer easier-                        Adjustable wrench
              to-move acrylic and polymer options. You can
                                                                                     Plumber’s putty or silicone plumber’s grease
              pick from many different foot styles, including
              ball feet, ornamental feet, and, of course, the                        Teflon tape
              traditional claw feet. You can also outfit a clawfoot                  Power drill & bits
              tub with a shower extension on the faucet body, a                      Carpenter’s level
              direct-spray “rainwater” head, and a shower ring
              from which a shower curtain can be hung (see pages                     Hole saw
              272 to 273).                                                           Eye & ear protection
                  The clawfoot tub in this project is a salvaged, cast-              Work gloves
              iron rolltop tub. Although the supply of vintage tubs is

                     PREPPING FOR A CLAWFOOT TUB
                  The actual installation of a clawfoot tub is fairly basic. Success, though, relies on proper preparation so that the tub
                  is positioned just where you want it and the supply and drain lines are correctly aligned with the tub. Place the tub
                  roughly where you want it and use a stud finder or other method to isolate the floor joists. Determine the location for
                  connections under the floor (new tubs usually come with a template) and mark them by drilling pilot holes all the way
                  through the subflooring. Install new drain and supply plumbing (this is a good time to call in a professional plumber).
                  Finally, lay the finish flooring, if it is not already in place, before installing the tub. Make sure the floor is as level
                  as possible.

   218        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 218 24/9/18 5:54 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 218 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:218

                                                                                  INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   219

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 219 24/9/18 5:54 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 219 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:219

                          How to Install a Clawfoot Tub

                    1
              Position the tub exactly where you’d like it to rest, ideally over existing supply and drain lines. Install the feet first if they were not
              preattached (inset).

                    2                                                                     3
              Mark locations for supply risers and the drain tailpipe on the         Install the drain‑waste‑overflow assembly according to the
              floor. Drill starter holes, and double-check below the floor to        manufacturer’s instructions. With a freestanding tub, it is
              make sure floor joists will not be directly under the access           often easiest to join the assembly parts working upward from
              holes. Use a hole saw slightly wider than each pipe to drill           the drain-pipe connection in the floor. Install the drain flange
              access holes. Install supply lines and the drain line.                 in the tub, fastening it from the top into the drain shoe. Make
                                                                                     the connection to the drain pipe in the floor—if the kit comes
                                                                                     with a floor escutcheon that covers the drain connection,
                                                                                     make sure it is in place before you attach the tailpipe to the T.

   220        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 220 24/9/18 5:54 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 220 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:220

                                                                       4       5

       Fasten the overflow cover to the overflow receiver with the         Assemble the faucet according to the manufacturer’s
       bolt or bolts that are provided. Be sure to position the rubber     instructions. Most older clawfoot tubs have a two-valve faucet
       gasket that came with the drain kit so it fits neatly against the   with a gooseneck spigot that mounts directly to the wall of the
       tub wall. Do not overtighten the fasteners.                         tub at the foot end. Many newer freestanding tubs utilize a
                                                                           wall-mounted faucet.

            6

           Mount the
           faucet body to                                                      7
           the tub wall
           with the retainer
                                                                           Attach the supply risers to the valve inlets for the faucet.
           nuts that thread
                                                                           Put the supply-pipe base escutcheons in place on the
           onto the faucet
                                                                           floor over the supply-line connections. Secure the risers into
           valve stems.
                                                                           the supply connections below the floor. Turn on the water
                                                                           supply to test that there are no leaks in any of the pipes or
                                                                           fitting connections, including the drain and overflow.

             FEET FIRST
          Despite their great weight, it is always a good idea to anchor cast-iron tubs—even a small shift in position can cause
          the drain or supply connections to fail. Older tubs often have screw holes in the bottoms of the feet so they may be
          fastened to the floor once the hookups are made. Newer lighter-weight tubs generally use floor pins to stabilize the
          tub. Some manufacturers recommend using rubber pads and epoxy under each foot, in conjunction with dowels or
          mounting studs. Some tubs have self-leveling feet, with integral adjustment posts—check and follow the manufacturer’s
          installation instructions.

                                                                                                  INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   221

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 221 24/9/18 5:54 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 221 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:221

              Pot Filler

              K    itchen design trends are moving ever closer to
                   replicating commercial kitchens in the home. One
              example of this trend is the pot filler. A long-neck faucet
              that mounts to the wall behind or onto the counter
              beside the cooktop, a pot filler allows you to dispense
              water directly into large pots on the cooktop. This saves
              lugging pots of water from the sink to the stove.
                  Although horizontally mounted models are
              available, most pot fillers are attached to the wall.            A pot filler is a cold-water tap that you install above your
              Almost all are designed for cold water only. Some have           cooktop so you can add water to large stock pots without
              two valves, one at the wall and another at the end of            having to carry a full pot of water around the kitchen.
              the spout. Other models can be turned on with a foot
              pedal for safe, hands-free use.
                  A pot filler will require code-approved supply pipe               TOOLS & MATERIALS
              (½ inch in most cases) connected with a permanent                   Hack saw                        PEX fittings
              union at another supply line or the main. The best
              time to run a new supply is during a remodel. But                   PEX tools                       Reciprocating saw
              retrofitting a new supply line and mounting a pot filler            PEX pipe                        Drywall tools
              is not too difficult as a standalone project. Using PEX             Pot filler                      Pipe joint compound
              supply pipe will make running the new supply line in                Protector plates                Drywall patching materials
              finished walls easier.

                                                                                                      Plan the route for the new supply line.
                                                                                                      In most cases, you will enter the stud
                                                                                                      cavity of the wall and run a new line
                                                                                                      directly upward, past the backsplash
                                                                                                      height of the countertop (A). If the
                                                                                                      countertop backsplash is removable,
                                                                                                      avoid wallboard patching by installing
                                                                                                      the tubing behind the backsplash (B).
                                                                                                      You may also be able to run the supply
                                                                           A                          line underneath the kitchen if there is
                                                                                                      an unfinished basement (C).
                                                                       B

                                                     C

   222        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 222 24/9/18 5:54 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 222 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:222

                  How to Install a Pot Filler

                                                                       2

            1
       Shut off the water supply and locate the                Plan the route for the new supply line beginning at the tee fitting and working
       cold water supply riser at the kitchen                  toward the cooktop area. Determine the height of the new line, and then snap
       sink. Cut into the riser and install a tee              chalklines from the sink to the cooktop. With the electrical power shut off, remove
       fitting, or replace the existing shutoff                wall coverings 2" above and below the chalkline and at the location for the pot filler
       valve on the riser with a multiple-outlet               outlet. Make sure the location is high enough that the pot filler spout will clear your
       shutoff valve, with an outlet for 1⁄2"                  tallest stockpot.
       supply pipe for the pot filler.

                                                          3
                                                                                                                                                 4
       Drill 3⁄4" holes in the framing for the supply tubes. Install                  Attach the new PEX supply line to the tee fitting at the supply
       protector plates if the holes are within 11⁄4" of the stud edge.               riser, installing an accessible shutoff valve on the
       Run 1⁄2" PEX from the supply riser through the holes to the pot                new line.
       filler location (inset). Attach nailing plates to protect the pipes.

                                                                                                  Inlet
            5

                                                                                                  Flange

                                                                                          6
       At the cooktop, install the faucet union as specified by the                   Cut and install the drywall patch. Fit the flange over the
       manufacturer. Add blocking as needed. The pot filler installed                 inlet. Apply pipe joint compound to the threads of the
       here attaches to a drop-ear L-fitting, mounted to blocking.                    faucet body. Assemble and adjust the faucet according
       Apply pipe joint compound to the faucet inlet and thread it on                 to the manufacturer’s instructions. Test the faucet before
       to the L-fitting.                                                              refinishing the drywall.

                                                                                                             INSTALLING FIXTURES & FAUCETS                   223

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 223 2/10/18 9:53 AM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_082-223.indd 223 24/9/18 6:00 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:223

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 224 2/10/18 9:59 AM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 224 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:224

                                                                       Plumbing Repairs

                                                                       M      aking plumbing repairs is a good deal easier
                                                                              today than it was a generation ago. Back then, a
                                                                       leaky faucet was repaired by disassembling the valve
                                                                       and repacking it with messy string. Today, you simply
                                                                       remove the old cartridge and pop in a new one. In
                                                                       older times, if your toilet was running, you replaced
                                                                       a rubber gasket or washer. Today, you’re more
                                                                       likely to simply remove and replace the entire flush
                                                                       mechanism, which is actually a good deal easier to do
                                                                       than fixing one discreet piece of the mechanism. But
                                                                       convenience always comes at a price. Locating the
                                                                       correct replacement parts can get tricky, and instead
                                                                       of a cheap washer or bit of graphite string, you usually
                                                                       have to pay for the whole replacement parts package.
                                                                           Faucets and drains are the parts of your plumbing
                                                                       system that are most likely to need repairs. Faucets
                                                                       leak or drip, and drains clog. If you add these repairs
                                                                       to fixing toilet problems, you’ve covered almost
                                                                       everything you’re likely to face. This chapter includes
                                                                       thorough information on these common repairs, as
                                                                       well as several that you’re less likely to encounter—
                                                                       but in the event that you do, you’ll be prepared.

                                                                       In this chapter:
                                                                       •   Common Toilet Problems
                                                                       •   Clogged Toilets
                                                                       •   Toilet Flanges
                                                                       •   Sink Faucets
                                                                       •   Kitchen Sprayers
                                                                       •   Fixing Leaky Tubs & Shower Faucets
                                                                       •   Single-Handle Tub & Shower Faucet
                                                                           with Scald Control
                                                                       •   Tubs & Showers
                                                                       •   Sink Drains
                                                                       •   Branch & Main Drains
                                                                       •   Noisy Pipes

                                                                                                              PLUMBING REPAIRS              225

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 225 2/10/18 9:59 AM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 225 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:225

              Common Toilet Problems

              A    clogged toilet is one of the most common
                   plumbing problems. If a toilet overflows or
              flushes sluggishly, clear the clog with a plunger or
                                                                                   If minor adjustments do not fix the problem,
                                                                               further repairs will be needed. The parts of a
                                                                               standard toilet are not difficult to take apart, and
              closet auger. If the problem persists, the clog may be           most repair projects can be completed in less than
              in a branch drain or a drainage stack (see pages 280             an hour.
              to 281).                                                             A recurring puddle of water on the floor around
                  Most other toilet problems are fixed easily                  a toilet may be caused by a crack in the toilet base
              with minor adjustments that require no disassembly               or in the tank. A damaged toilet should be replaced.
              or replacement parts. You can make these                         Installing a new toilet is an easy project that can be
              adjustments in a few minutes, using simple tools.                finished in three or four hours.

                                                                                                      An older toilet may have a tank ball
                                                                                                      that settles onto the flush valve to stop
                                                                                                      the flow of water into the bowl. The ball
                                                                                                      is attached to a lift wire, which is in
                                                                                                      turn attached to the lift rod. A ballcock
                                                                                                      valve is usually made of brass, with
                                                                                                      rubber washers that can wear out. If the
                                                                                                      ballcock valve malfunctions, you might
                                                                                                      be able to find old washers to repair it,
                                                                                                      but replacing both the ballcock and the
                                                                                                      tank ball with a float-cup assembly and
                                                                                                      flapper is easier and makes for a more
                                                                                                      durable repair.

              A modern float-cup valve with flapper is inexpensive and made    A pressure-assist toilet has a large vessel that nearly fills the
              of plastic, but it is more reliable than an old ballcock valve   tank. As water enters the vessel, pressure builds up. When the
              and ball.                                                        toilet is flushed, this pressure helps push water forcefully down
                                                                               into the bowl. As a result, a pressure-assist toilet provides
                                                                               strong flushing power with minimal water consumption.

   226        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 226 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 226 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:226

             PROBLEMS & REPAIRS
                                                               PROBLEMS                                   REPAIRS

                                                               Toilet handle sticks or is hard to push.   1. Adjust lift wires (see page 228).
                                                                                                          2. Clean and adjust handle (see page 229).

                                                               Handle must be held down for               1. Adjust handle (see page 229).
                                                               entire flush.                              2. Shorten lift chain or wires (see page 228).
                                                                                                          3. Replace waterlogged flapper.

                                                               Handle is loose.                           1. Adjust handle (see page 229).
                                                                                                          2. Reattach lift chain or lift wires to lever (see page 228).

                                                               Toilet will not flush at all.              1. Make sure water is turned on.
                                                                                                          2. Adjust lift chain or lift wires (see page 228).

                                                               Toilet does not flush completely.          1. Adjust lift chain (see page 228).
                                                                                                          2. Adjust water level in tank (see page 230).
                                                                                                          3. Increase pressure on pressure‑assisted toilet.

                                                                                                          1. Clear clogged toilet (see page 240).
                                                               Toilet overflows or flushes sluggishly.
                                                                                                          2. Clear clogged branch drain or drainage stack
                                                                                                             (see page 281).

                                                               Toilet runs continuously                   1. Adjust lift wires or lift chain (see page 228).
                                                               or there are phantom flushes.              2. Replace leaky float ball (see page 226).
                                                                                                          3. Adjust water level in tank (see page 230).
                                                                                                          4. Adjust and clean flush valve (see page 229).
                                                                                                          5. Replace flush valve (see page 234).
                                                                                                          6. Replace flapper.
                                                                                                          7. Service pressure‑assist valve.

                                                               Water on floor around toilet.              1. Tighten tank bolts and water connections.
                                                                                                          2. Insulate tank to prevent condensation.
                                                                                                          3. Replace wax ring (see page 245).
                                                                                                          4. Replace cracked tank or bowl.

                                                               Toilet noisy when filling.                 1. Open shutoff valve completely.
                                                                                                          2. Replace ballcock and float valve.
                                                                                                          3. Refill tube is disconnected. Reconnect refill tube.

                                                               Weak flush.                                1. Clean clogged rim openings.
                                                                                                          2. Replace old low‑flow toilet.

                                                               Toilet rocks.                              1. Replace wax ring and bolts.
                                                                                                          2. Replace toilet flange (see page 245).

                                                                                                                                              PLUMBING REPAIRS             227

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 227 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 227 2/10/18 11:05 AM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:227

              Making Minor Adjustments                                                              TOOLS & MATERIALS
              Many common toilet problems can be fixed by
              making minor adjustments to the handle and the                                      Adjustable wrench               Hacksaw
              attached lift chain (or lift wires).                                                Needlenose pliers               Spray lubricant
                 If the handle sticks or is hard to push, remove the                              Screwdriver                     Small wire brush
              tank cover and clean the handle-mounting nut. Make                                  Scissors                        Vinegar
              sure the lift wires are straight.
                 If the toilet will not flush completely unless the
              handle is held down, you may have to remove excess                                   A continuously running toilet (see page 229) can
              slack in the lift chain.                                                          be caused by bent lift wires, kinks in a lift chain, or
                 If the toilet will not flush at all, the lift chain                            lime buildup on the handle mounting nut. Clean and
              may be broken or may have to be reattached to the                                 adjust the handle and the lift wires or chain to fix
              handle lever.                                                                     the problem.

                          How to Adjust a Toilet Handle & Lift Chain (or Lift Wires)

                                     Handle mounting nut
                                                                          Handle lever

                                                                                   Lift chain
                                                                                                                                                   Lift wires

                                                                                                                        Guide arm

              Clean and adjust the handle-mounting nut                 Adjust the lift chain so it hangs straight     Adjust the lift wires (found on older
              so the handle operates smoothly. A                       from the handle lever, with about ½" of        toilets without lift chains) so that
              mounting nut has reversed threads.                       slack. Remove excess slack in the chain        the wires are straight and operate
              Loosen the nut by turning it clockwise;                  by hooking the chain in a different hole       smoothly when the handle is pushed.
              tighten by turning it counterclockwise.                  in the handle lever or by removing links       A sticky handle often can be fixed by
              Remove lime buildup with a brush                         with needlenose pliers. A broken lift          straightening bent lift wires. You can
              dipped in vinegar.                                       chain must be replaced.                        also buy replacement wires or replace
                                                                                                                      the whole assembly with a float cup.

   228        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 228 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 228 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:228

              QUICK FIXES
          Phantom flushes? Phantom flushes                                                                    Seat uncomfortably low? Instead of
          are weak flushes that occur without                                                                 going to the trouble of raising the
          turning the handle. The flapper may                                                                 toilet or replacing it with a taller
          not be completely sealing against the                                                               model, you can simply replace the
          flush valve’s seat. Make sure                                                                       seat with a thicker, extended seat.
          the chain is not tangled and that the
          flapper can go all the way down. If
          that does not solve the problem, shut
          off the water and drain the tank. If
          the problem persists, the flapper may
          need to be replaced.

                                                               Seat loose? Loose seats are almost
                                                               always the result of a loose nut on the
                                                               seat bolts. Tighten the nuts with pliers.
                                                               If the nut is corroded or stripped,
                                                               replace the bolts and nuts or replace
                                                               the whole seat.

                                                               Tank fills too slowly? The first place to
                                                               check is the shutoff valve where the
                                                               supply tube for the toilet is connected.
                                                               Make sure it is fully open. If it is, you
                                                               may need to replace the shutoff—these
                                                               fittings are fairly cheap and frequently
                                                               fail to open fully.

                                                                                                              Toilet running? Running toilets
                                                                                                              are usually caused by faulty
                                                                                                              or misadjusted fill valves, but
                                                                                                              sometimes the toilet runs because
          Bowl not refilling well? The rim holes                                                              the tank is leaking water into
          may be clogged; many toilets have                                                                   the bowl. To determine if this is
          small holes on the underside of                                                                     happening with your toilet, add a
          the bowl rim, through which water                                                                   few drops of food coloring to the
          squirts during a flush. If you notice                                                               tank water. If, after a while, the water
          that some of these holes are clogged,                                                               in the bowl becomes colored, then
          use a stiff-bristled brush to clear out                                                             you have a leak and probably need
          debris. You may need to first apply                                                                 to replace the rubber gasket at the
          toilet bowl cleaner or mineral cleaner.                                                             base of your flush valve.

                                                                                                                                PLUMBING REPAIRS              229

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 229 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 229 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:229

              Reset Tank Water Level

              Tank water flowing into the overflow pipe is the sound we hear             A ball float is connected to a float arm that’s attached to a
              when a toilet is running. Usually, this is caused by a minor               plunger on the other end. As the tank fills, the float rises
              misadjustment that fails to tell the water to shut off when the            and lifts one end of the float arm. At a certain point, the float
              toilet tank is full. The culprit is a float ball or cup that is adjusted   arm depresses the plunger and stops the flow of water. By
              to set a water level in the tank that’s higher than the top of the         simply bending the float arm downward a bit, you can cause
              overflow pipe, which serves as a drain for excess tank water.              it to depress the plunger at a lower tank water level, solving
              The other photos on this page show how to fix the problem.                 the problem.

                                                                                                                                           Spring clip

              A diaphragm fill valve usually is made of plastic and has a                A float cup fill valve is made of plastic and is easy to adjust.
              wide bonnet that contains a rubber diaphragm. Turn the                     Lower the water level by pinching the spring clip with fingers
              adjustment screw clockwise to lower the water level and                    or pliers and moving the clip and cup down the pull rod and
              counterclockwise to raise it.                                              shank. Raise the water level by moving the clip and cup upward.

   230        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 230 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 230 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:230

             WHAT IF THE FLUSH STOPS TOO SOON?
                                                                       The handle lever should pull straight up on the flapper. If
                                                                       it doesn’t, reposition the chain hook on the handle lever.
                                                                       When the flapper is covering the opening, there should be
                                                                       just a little slack in the chain. If there is too much slack,
                                                                       shorten the chain and cut off excess with the cutters on
                                                                       your pliers.

          Sometimes there is plenty of water in the tank, but not
          enough of it makes it to the bowl before the flush valve
          shuts off the water from the tank. Modern toilets are
          designed to leave some water in the tank, since the first
          water that leaves the tank does so with the most force.
          (It’s pressed out by the weight of the water on top.) To
          increase the duration of the flush, shorten the length of
          the chain between the flapper and the float (yellow in the
          model shown).

                                                                       Unless the handle parts are visibly broken, try cleaning
                                                                       them with an old toothbrush dipped in white vinegar.
                                                                       Replace the handle and test the action. If it sticks or is
                                                                       hard to operate, replace it. Most replacement handles
                                                                       come with detailed instructions that tell you how to install
                                                                       and adjust them.

          If the toilet is not completing flushes and the lever and
          chain for the flapper or tank ball are correctly adjusted,
          the problem could be that the handle mechanism needs
          cleaning or replacement. Remove the chain/linkage from
          the handle lever. Remove the nut on the backside of the
          handle with an adjustable wrench. It unthreads clockwise
          (the reverse of standard nuts). Remove the handle from
          the tank.

                                                                                                                PLUMBING REPAIRS              231

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 231 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 231 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:231

                          How to Replace a Fill Valve

                    1                                                                                                                         2

                   Mounting unit
                    for fill valve

                                                               Coupling nut
                                                              for supply tube

              Toilet fill valves wear out eventually. They can be repaired,       If the fill valve spins while you turn the mounting nut, you may
              but it’s easier and a better fix to just replace them. Before       need to hold it still with locking pliers. Lift out the fill valve.
              removing the old fill valve, shut off the water supply at the       In the case of an old ballcock valve, the float ball will likely
              fixture stop valve located on the tube that supplies water to       come out as well. When replacing an old valve like this, you
              the tank. Flush the toilet, and sponge out the remaining water.     will likely also need to replace the flush valve (see pages 234
              Loosen the nut and disconnect the supply tube, then loosen          to 235).
              and remove the mounting nut.

                                                            Critical
                                                          level mark

                                                                                                                                            4

                                                                                                                 Adjust the height of the fill
                                                                                                                 valve shank so the “CL” line
                    3                                                                                            and overflow pipe will be
                                                                                                                 correctly related. Different
                                                                                                                 products are adjusted in
              The new fill valve must be installed so the critical level (“CL”)
                                                                                                                 different ways—the fill valve
              mark is at least 1" above the overflow pipe (inset). Slip the
                                                                                                                 shown here telescopes when
              shank washer on the threaded shank of the new fill valve,
                                                                                                                 it’s twisted.
              and place the valve in the hole so the washer is flat on the
              tank bottom. Compare the locations of the “CL” mark and
              the overflow pipe.

   232        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 232 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 232 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:232

                                                                                  If the overflow pipe has a cap, remove it. Attach one end of
                                                                                  the refill tube from the new valve to the plastic angle adapter
            5                                                                     and the other end to the refill nipple near the top of the valve.
                                                                                  Attach the angle adapter to the overflow pipe. Cut off excess
                                                                                  tubing with scissors to prevent kinking.

                                                                                  WARNING: Don’t insert the refill tube into the overflow pipe.
                                                                                  The outlet of the refill tube needs to be above the top of the
                                                                                  pipe for it to work properly.

                                                                                                                                             6

                                                                       Threaded
                                                                         valve
                                                                         stem
                                                                                                                     Refill tube

                                                                                                           Overflow pipe

       Slip the valve’s threaded end down through the tank. Push
       down on its shank (not the top) while tightening the locknut
       (inset). Hand tighten, then use a wrench to make an extra
       ¼ turn. Hook up the water supply tube, and tighten in the
       same way.

            7
       Turn the water on fully. Slightly tighten any fitting that drips              OPTION: Newer diaphragm valves cost a bit more than
       water. Adjust the water level in the tank by squeezing the                    float cups, but they boast quieter water flow. Install one
       spring clip on the float cup with needlenose pliers and moving                the same way you would a float cup.
       the cup up or down on the link bar. Test the flush.

                                                                                                                           PLUMBING REPAIRS              233

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 233 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 233 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:233

                          How to Replace a Flush Valve

                                                                                  1       2

              Before removing the old flush valve, shut off the water supply          Unscrew the bolts holding the toilet tank to the bowl by loosening
              at the fixture stop valve located on the tube that supplies             the nuts from below. If you are having difficulty unscrewing the
              water to the tank. Flush the toilet, and sponge out the                 tank bolts and nuts because they are fused together by rust or
              remaining water. To make this repair you’ll need to remove              corrosion, apply penetrating oil or spray lubricant to the threads,
              the tank from the bowl. Start by unscrewing the water supply            give it a few minutes to penetrate, and then try again. If that
              coupling nut from the bottom of the tank.                               fails, slip an open-ended hacksaw (or plain hacksaw blade)
                                                                                      between the tank and bowl and saw through the bolt (inset).

                                                                       Spud nut

                            Spud wrench

                                                                                  3       4
              Unhook the chain from the handle lever arm. Remove the                  Place the new flush valve in the valve hole and check to see
              tank and carefully place it upside-down on an old towel.                if the top of the overflow pipe is at least 1" below the critical
              Remove the spud washer and spud nut from the base of the                level line (see page 232) and the tank opening where the
              flush valve using a spud wrench or large channel-type pliers.           handle is installed. If the pipe is too tall, cut it to length with
              Remove the old flush valve.                                             a hacksaw.

   234        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 234 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 234 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:234

            5                                                      Spud nut
                                                                                             Intermediate nut goes between tank and bowl

                                                                Spud washer

                                                                                                                                         6
       Position the flush valve flapper below the handle lever arm,           With the tank lying on its back, thread a rubber washer onto
       and secure it to the tank from beneath with the spud nut.              each tank bolt and insert it into the bolt holes from inside the
       Tighten the nut one-half turn past hand tight with a spud              tank. Then, thread a brass washer and hex nut onto the tank
       wrench or large channel-type pliers. Overtightening may                bolts from below and tighten them to a quarter turn past hand
       cause the tank to break. Put the new spud washer over the              tight. Do not overtighten.
       spud nut, small side down.

                                                                                                                                         8
                                                                                                                      Refill tube

                                                                                                                         Overflow pipe

                                                                                                                  Chain clip

          Intermediate nut

                                                                                          Handle lever arm

            7
       With the hex nuts tightened against the tank bottom, carefully         Connect the chain clip to the handle lever arm and adjust the
       lower the tank over the bowl and set it down so the spud               number of links to allow for a little slack in the chain when the
       washer seats neatly over the water inlet in the bowl and the tank      flapper is closed. Leave a little tail on the chain for adjusting,
       bolts fit through the holes in the bowl flange. Secure the tank to     cutting off any excess. Attach the refill tube to the top of
       the bowl with a rubber washer, brass washer, and nut or wing           the overflow pipe the same way it had been attached to the
       nut at each bolt end. Press the tank to level as you hand-tighten      previous refill pipe. Turn on the water supply at the stop valve,
       the nuts. Hook up the water supply at the fill valve inlet.            and test the flush. (Some flush valve flappers are adjustable.)

                                                                                                                       PLUMBING REPAIRS              235

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 235 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 235 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:235

              Dual-flush Valves
              Though dual-flush valves for modern toilets were               rely on the force of gravity to achieve a clean and
              invented in Australia in the 1980s, they didn’t become         powerful flush, and although models from different
              prominent worldwide until the 1990s, when water-               manufacturers may vary in their installation and
              saving technology became easier to install and                 design, they all work to achieve the same purpose—a
              implement. A dual-flush valve allows you to make a             more water-efficient flush for the environmentally
              half flush when a small amount of water will suffice;          minded and cost-savings savvy consumers. To use
              when you need a stronger flush, you can turn the               dual-flush technology, some units require you to pull
              handle in the other direction for a full flush. This can       up on the handle instead of down, while others are
              save plenty of water—and money—over the course of              push-button activated. Stand-alone dual-flush valves
              a year (see chart below).                                      can be purchased for home installation in a standard
                 A typical retrofit unit comes with both a flush valve       one-flush, gravity-assisted toilet, or complete dual-
              and a fill valve, can be installed in most toilet tanks,       flush-capable toilets can be purchased directly from
              and is extremely affordable—often not more than $50.           manufacturers, and they come in a wide variety of
              Like most standard toilet valves, dual-flush valves            styles and finishes to match most bathrooms.

                                                                                  GET WITH THE (LOW) FLOW
                                                                               GALLONS                    SAVINGS IN GALLONS
                                                                               PER FLUSH (GPF)            PER YEAR (GPY)

                                                                               5.0                        0

                                                                               3.5                        11,000 gpy from 5.0 gpf

                                                                               1.6                        25,300 gpy from 5.0 gpf to 1.6 gpf
                                                                                                          14,100 gpy from 3.5 gpf to 1.6 gpf

                                                                               1.28                       27,700 gpy from 5.0 gpf to 1.28 gpf
                                                                                                          16,500 gpy from 3.5 gpf to 1.28 gpf

                                                                               1.0                        29,000 gpy from 5.0 gpf to 1.0 gpf
                                                                                                          18,600 gpy from 3.5 gpf to 1.0 gpf

                                                                             Water savings based on an average household of four, each
                                                                             flushing 5.1 times a day, 365 days a year.
                                                                             Source: WaterSense, see Resources, page 285.

                                                                                  TOOLS & MATERIALS
                                                                               Dual‑flush                         Screwdriver
                                                                                  valve assembly                  Teflon tape
                                                                               Replacement gasket                 Channel‑lock pliers
                                                                               Hex nut                            Wax pencil
                                                                               Bolts                              Bucket
                                                                               Rubber washers                     Sponge
                                                                               Brass washers                      Towel
              Conserve water (and money) with the push of a button.               (if necessary)
              Dual-flush valves can be installed in most standard toilets.

   236        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 236 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 236 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:236

                                                                                                                                 A dual-flush valve
          Refill clamp                                   Fill valve screw                                                        is easier to install
                                                                                                                                 than it looks. All
                                                                            Refill mount
                                                                                                                                 the component
                                                                                                                                 pieces are seen
                                                                               Overflow tube                                     on the left.

                                                                                      Full flush float and ladder
                 Dual-flush                              Refill
                  handle                                 hose                              Half flush float and ladder

          Fill valve assembly

                                        Flush valve assembly

                  How to Install a Dual-flush Valve
                                                                                  Disconnect the supply line from behind the tank. Use channel-
                                                                                  lock pliers to remove the lock nut from the valve shank,
            1                                                                     allowing excess water to drip into a bucket. Next, remove
                                                                                  the tank after loosening the flush valve nuts. Remove the old
         Overflow tube height                                                     gasket from the flush valve shank, but keep all the old parts
                                                                                  together—they may still be needed.

                                                                                       2

                     Water level

       Turn off the water supply. Remove the top of the tank, and
       mark both the water level and the top of the overflow tube
       using a wax pencil. Remove the old assemblies, flush a single
       time, and mark the level of the remaining water in the bottom
       of the tank. Hold the toilet handle to flush once more, and
       remove excess water with a sponge.                                                                                                (continued)

                                                                                                                            PLUMBING REPAIRS              237

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 237 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 237 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:237

                                                                                 Re-attach the refill mount, making sure it is low enough to fit
                                                                                 inside the tank and high enough to clear the lid. Cut excess
                                                                                 refill hose if necessary. To install the entire valve, hand-tighten
                                                                                 the lock nut to the threaded shank. Do not over-tighten.

                                                                                     4
                                                                                                                  Overflow tube height

                                                                                                                    Water level

                                     Refill mount

                    3                                                                                                              Residual water level

              After removing the flush valve lock nut from the new flush
              valve assembly, place the new flush valve assembly into
              the tank, ensuring it is level and comfortably seated atop the
              shank. Mark the height of the new overflow tube to match
              the height of the old tube recorded in step 1; cut the tube to                                             Refill mount
              match, removing the assembly from the tank if necessary.
              Removing the refill mount from the flush valve assembly
              (above) makes marking and cutting the tube easier.

                                                                                 The refill hose connects the dual valve assemblies; attach
                                                                                 the refill hose from the fill valve to the nipple on the dual
                                                                                 flush valve (inset), and ensure both ends are clear of the
                                                                                 valve operations. If you need to change the orientation of
                                                                                 the flush valve, release the base by turning the assembly
                                                                                 counterclockwise until the tabs unlock, lift the valves out,
                                                                                 and adjust as needed.

                                                                                                                             Refill hose
                                                                                     6

                                                                       5
              Reassemble the tank with bolts, rubber washers, brass
              washers, and a hex nut. Use the old rubber gasket if necessary
              and install the fill valve in much the same way as the flush
              valve; remove the fill valve lock nut and shank washer, and
              insert the valve onto the fill valve shank adjacent to the flush
              valve. The height of the fill valve must be approximately 3"
              greater than the flush valve; adjust as necessary by twisting
              the threaded shank in and out. When the desired height is
              reached, hand-tighten the fill valve lock nut to the shank.

   238        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 238 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 238 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:238

                                                                                            Install the dual flush handle to the tank
                                                                                            and hand-tighten the lever lock-nut.
                  7                                                                         The nut is reverse-threaded, so be
                                                                                            sure the tabs on the collar are oriented
                                                                                            vertically and aligned with the handle’s
                                                                                            tabs. Reconnect and turn on the water
                                                                                            supply, checking for leaks. Do not use
                                                                                            plumber’s putty or thread lubricants to
                                                                                            seal the fittings, as they may damage
                                                                                            the plastic nut. Teflon tape is a
                                                                                            good alternative.

vel

                    ADJUSTING THE FLUSH AND TANK LEVELS
                If the water in the tank is uneven with the original high
                water mark from step 1, turn the screw near the top
                of the fill valve clockwise to increase the water level or
                counterclockwise to decrease it.

                To adjust the level of half or full flushes, look to the flush
                valve assembly on the right; the higher float near the refill
                hose adjusts the half flush, while the opposing lower float
                on the other side of the assembly adjusts the full. Use a
                small amount of toilet paper and a test flush to gauge the
                amount of water used; if unsatisfied, adjust the appropriate
                flush by pulling out each float’s stop and raising or lowering
                each float to properly adjust the refill level. See the
                manufacturer’s instructions, as the direction of adjustment
                to raise or lower the water level varies per manufacturer.

                    ADJUSTING THE REFILL LEVEL IN THE BOWL
                The refill tube connects both valve assemblies, and the
                roller clamp on the tube can be adjusted to monitor the
                level of water in the bowl. To adjust, add a gallon of water
                to the bowl and wait 10 minutes, then mark the water
                level with a wax pencil. Flush the toilet. If the refill valve
                is still running once the water mark has been reached,
                decrease the volume of water by moving the roller clamp
                toward zero. If there’s not enough water, do the opposite,
                moving the clamp toward higher numbers. Continue
                adjusting until the water reaches the mark in the tank
                at the same time the valve turns off.

                                                                                                              PLUMBING REPAIRS              239

  305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 239                                                                 24/9/18 7:38 PM
  305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 239                                                                 24/9/18 7:37 PM
                                                                                 Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition
                                                      Text                                                                           Page:239

              Clogged Toilets                                              TOOLS & MATERIALS
                                                                         Towels                          Plunger with foldout skirt
                                                                         Closet auger                       (force cup)

              T    he toilet is clogged and has overflowed. Have
                   patience. Now is the time for considered action.
              A second flush is a tempting but unnecessary             a closet auger. Pushing anything more durable than
              gamble. First, do damage control. Mop up the water       toilet paper into the sewer may create a more serious
              if there’s been a spill. Next, consider the nature of    blockage in your drain and waste system.
              the clog. Is it entirely “natural” or might a foreign        If the tub, sink, and toilet all back up at once, the
              object be contributing to the congestion? Push a         branch drainline that serves all the bathroom fixtures
              natural blockage down the drain with a plunger. A        is probably blocked and your best recourse is to call a
              foreign object should be removed, if possible, with      drain clearing service.

                                                                                                                     A blockage in the
                                                                                                                     toilet bowl leaves
                                                                                                                     flush water from
                                                                                                                     the tank nowhere
                                                                                                                     to go but on
                                                                                                                     the floor.

   240

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 240 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 240 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:240

                                                                                     DRAIN CLEARERS
                                                                                   The home repair marketplace is filled with gadgets and
                                                                                   gimmicks, as well as well-established products, that are
                                                                                   intended to clear drains of all types. Some are caustic
                                                                                   chemicals, some are natural enzymes, others are more
                                                                                   mechanical in nature. Some help, some are worthless,
                                                                                   some can even make the problem worse. Nevertheless,
                                                                                   if you are the type of homeowner who is enamored with
                                                                                   new products and the latest solutions, you may enjoy
                                                                                   testing out new drain cleaners as they become available.
                                                                                   In this photo, for example, you’ll see a relatively new
                                                                                   product that injects blasts of compressed CO2 directly
                                                                                   into your toilet, sink, or tub drain to dislodge clogs.
                                                                                   It does not cause any chemicals to enter the waste
                                                                                   stream, and the manufacturers claim the CO2 blast is
                                                                                   very gentle and won’t damage pipes. As with any new
                                                                                   product, use it with caution. But if a plunger or a snake
                                                                                   isn’t working, it could save you the cost of a house call.

       The trap is the most common catching spot for toilet clogs.
       Once the clog forms, flushing the toilet cannot generate
       enough water power to clear the trap, so flush water backs
       up. Traps on modern 1.6-gallon toilets have been redesigned
       to larger diameters and are less prone to clogs than the first
       generation of 1.6-gallon toilets.

           Plunger                                                     Force cup

       Not all plungers were created equal. The standard plunger
       (left) is simply an inverted rubber cup and is used to plunge
       sinks, tubs, and showers. The flanged plunger, also called
       a force cup, is designed to get down into the trap of a toilet
       drain. You can fold the flange up into the flanged plunger cup
       and use it as a standard plunger.

                                                                                                                         PLUMBING REPAIRS              241

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 241 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 241 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:241

                          How to Plunge a Clogged Toilet
                                                                                        FORCE CUPS
                    1
                                                                                      A flanged plunger (force cup) fits into the mouth of the
                                                                                      toilet trap and creates a tight seal so you can build up
                                                                                      enough pressure in front of the plunger to dislodge the
                                                                                      blockage and send it on its way.

              Plunging is the easiest way to remove “natural” blockages.
              Take time to lay towels around the base of the toilet and
              remove other objects to a safe, dry location, since plunging
              may result in splashing. Often, allowing a very full toilet to sit
              for twenty or thirty minutes will permit some of the water to
              drain to a less precarious level.

                    2

                                                                                                                                               3
                   There should be enough water in the bowl to
                                                                                   If you force enough water out of the bowl that you are unable
                   completely cover the plunger. Fold out the skirt
                                                                                   to create suction with the plunger, put a controlled amount of
                   from inside the plunger to form a better seal with
                                                                                   water in the bowl by lifting up on the flush valve in the tank.
                   the opening at the base of the bowl. Pump the
                                                                                   Resume plunging. When you think the drain is clear, you can
                   plunger vigorously half a dozen times, take a rest,
                                                                                   try a controlled flush, with your hand ready to close the flush
                   and then repeat. Try this for four to five cycles.
                                                                                   valve should the water threaten to spill out of the bowl. Once
                                                                                   the blockage has cleared, dump a five-gallon pail of water
                                                                                   into the toilet to blast away any residual debris.

   242        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 242 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 242 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:242

                  How to Clear Clogs with a Closet Auger
                                                                                   CLOSET AUGERS
                                                                                 A closet auger is a semirigid cable housed in a
                                                                                 tube. The tube has a bend at the end so it can be
                                                                                 snaked through a toilet trap (without scratching it) to
                                                                                 snag blockages.
                                                        Protective rubber boot

            1
       Place the business end of the auger firmly in the bottom of the
       toilet bowl with the auger tip fully withdrawn. A rubber sleeve
       will protect the porcelain at the bottom bend of the auger. The
       tip will be facing back and up, which is the direction the toilet
       trap takes.

                                                                          2
                                                                                     Fully retract the auger until you have recovered the
                                                                                     object. This can be frustrating at times, but it is still
                                                                                     a much easier task than the alternative—to remove
                                                                                     the toilet and go fishing.

                                                                                                                                        3

       Rotate the handle on the auger housing clockwise as you push
       down on the rod, advancing the rotating auger tip up into
       the back part of the trap. You may work the cable backward
       and forward as needed, but keep the rubber boot of the
       auger firmly in place in the bowl. When you feel resistance,
       indicating you‘ve snagged the object, continue rotating the
       auger counterclockwise as you withdraw the cable and
       the object.

                                                                                                                       PLUMBING REPAIRS              243

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 243 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 243 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:243

              Toilet Flanges

              I  f your toilet rocks, it will eventually leak. The rocking means that the
                 bolts are no longer holding the toilet securely to the floor. If you have
              tightened the bolts and it still rocks, it is possible that a bolt has broken
              a piece of the flange off and is no longer able to hold. Rocking might also
              be because an ongoing leak has weakened the floor and it is now uneven.
              Whatever the reason, a rocking toilet needs to be fixed.
                   If your flange is connected to cast-iron piping, use a repair flange. This
              has a rubber compression ring that will seal the new flange to the cast-
              iron pipe. If the old flange is too close to a wall or cabinet to fit your new
              toilet, you can “relocate” the flange by as much as 2 inches by replacing it
              with an offset toilet flange (see page 246).

                     TOOLS & MATERIALS
                  Drill                              #10 stainless‑steel   Solvent‑cement                Use a flange repair kit for a quick fix to
                                                       flathead                                          a broken flange. The new flange piece
                  Wrench                                                   Marker                        from the kit is simply screwed to the
                                                       wood screws
                  Internal pipe cutter                                                                   floor after it has been oriented correctly
                                                                                                         over the broken flange.

                                                                                       TOILET SHIMS
                                                                                     If the toilet is wobbly because of an uneven floor, shims
                                                                                     may solve the problem. (Do not install shims if the toilet
                                                                                     leaks at the base; they will not solve that problem.) Slip
                                                                                     two or more plastic toilet shims under the toilet until it is
                                                                                     stabilized. Press the shims with only medium pressure;
                                                                                     don’t force them too hard. Cut the exposed portions of
                                                                                     the shims with a utility knife.

              Toilets that rock often only need to have the nuts on the
              closet bolts tightened. But if you need to tighten the bolts
              on an ongoing basis, you very likely have a problem with the
              closet flange.

   244        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 244 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 244 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:244

                  How to Replace a PVC Closet Flange

                                                                                 New pipe

                                                                           Repair Coupling

            1                                                               2
       Begin by removing the                                            If your flange is attached to a closet bend, you will need to
       toilet and wax ring. Cut                                         open up the floor around the toilet to get at the horizontal
       the pipe just below the                                          pipe connecting the bend to the stack to make the repair.
       bottom of the flange                                             If it is connected to a length of vertical plastic pipe, use a
       using an internal pipe                                           repair coupling and a short length of pipe to bring the pipe
       cutter (inset, available at                                      back up to floor level. Cement the new pipe into the repair
       plumbing supply stores).                                         coupling first and allow it to set. Clean the old pipe thoroughly
       Remove the flange.                                               before cementing.

            3                                                               4

       Cut the replacement pipe flush with the floor. Dry-fit the new   Prime and solvent-cement the pipe and flange, inserting
       flange into the pipe. Turn the flange until the side cut-out     the flange slightly off the marks and twisting it to proper
       screw slots are parallel to the wall. (Do not use the curved     alignment. Secure the flange to the floor with #10 stainless-
       keyhole slots, as they are not as strong.) Draw lines to mark    steel flathead wood screws.
       the location of the slots on the floor.

                                                                                                                 PLUMBING REPAIRS              245

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 245 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 245 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:245

                          How to Install an Offset Toilet Flange
                                                                                    You can adjust the flange location by as much as 2" if you
                                                                                    replace the old flange with an offset flange (a much easier
                                                                                    job than moving the drain line). To remove the old flange, cut
                                                                                    the pipe directly beneath the flange from the inside out using
                                                                                    an internal pipe cutter chucked into your drill. Cut all the way
                                                                                    around the pipe, and then remove the old flange.

                                                                                        2

                    1
              Most toilets sold today are 12" models, which means the
              distance from the wall at the tank side to the center of the
              drain outlet is 12". If you are replacing a toilet, the existing
              toilet (closet) flange might be either so close to the wall that
              the new model will not fit or far enough out (many older toilets
              are 14" fixtures) that there would be a 2" gap between the
              tank and wall if you installed the new model on the old flange.
              If your current toilet is still in place, you can determine the
              distance by measuring from the center of the floor bolts to the
              wall. Or remove the old toilet and measure from the wall to the
              center point of the toilet flange opening.

                                                                          3             4
              Solvent-glue a section of new drain pipe of the correct diameter      Position the offset flange into the drain opening and spin it
              into a repair coupling, and then glue the coupling to the cut         until the center of the flange is in the desired position. You
              pipe in the floor repair coupling. The goal is to have fresh          will most likely need to remove some flooring and subfloor
              drain pipe of the correct height so the ring of the new flange will   to create access for the new flange. Trace around the rim of
              rest directly on the floor surface. It’s not a bad idea to cut the    the flange.
              new pipe so it is slightly overlong and then trim it to the correct
              height once it is installed and you can test-fit the new flange.

   246        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 246 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 246 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:246

       Cut along the marked line for the new opening with a jigsaw or
       reciprocating saw, and remove the waste. Try to avoid getting
       debris in the pipe opening.

            5

                                                                               6
                                                                           Solvent glue the new offset flange into the drain pipe, making
                                                                           sure it is oriented in the correct position and that the flange
                                                                           ring rests on the floor.

                                                                           TIP: When choosing an offset flange, select a model that
                                                                           has a metal, not plastic, flange ring, because metal is much
                                                                           less likely crack or fail.

            7
       Attach the new flange to the floor by driving corrosion-resistant
       screws through the pre-drilled holes in the flange and into            OPTION: To reduce noise and air transfer, fill in the empty
       the subfloor. It is okay to skip one or two holes if there is no       space around the drain pipe with minimal expanding
       attaching surface below them, but if there are any more, then          spray foam. Install your new toilet (see pages 84 to 89).
       you should patch the subfloor beneath the flange.

                                                                                                                    PLUMBING REPAIRS              247

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 247 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 247 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:247

              Sink Faucets                                                                             TOOLS & MATERIALS
                                                                                                    Pliers
                                                                                                    Needlenose pliers
              I  t’s not surprising that sink faucets leak and drip. Any fitting that
                 contains moving mechanical parts is susceptible to failure. But add to
              the equation the persistent force of water pressure working against the
                                                                                                    Heatproof grease
                                                                                                    Channel‑type pliers
              parts, and the real surprise is that faucets don’t fail more quickly or often.
                                                                                                    Utility knife
              It would be a bit unfair to say that the inner workings of a faucet are
              regarded as disposable by manufacturers, but it is safe to say that these             White vinegar
              parts have become easier to remove and replace.                                       Old toothbrush
                   The older your faucet, the more likely you can repair it by replacing
                                                                                                    Tape measure
              small parts such as washers and O-rings. Many newer faucets can
              be repaired only by replacing the major inner components, such as a                   Repair kit (exact type varies)
              ceramic disk or a cartridge that encapsulates all the washers and O-rings             Teflon tape
              that could possibly wear out.                                                         Screwdrivers
                   The most important aspect of sink faucet repair is identifying which
              type of faucet you own. In this chapter we show all of the common types               Pipe joint compound
              and provide instructions on repairing them. In every case, the easiest and            Plumber’s putty
              most reliable repair method is to purchase a replacement kit with brand-              Rag
              new internal working parts for the model and brand of faucet you own.

              Eventually, just about every faucet develops leaks and drips.
              Repairs can usually be accomplished simply by replacing the
              mechanical parts inside the faucet body (the main trick is
              figuring out which kind of parts your faucet has).

   248        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 248 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 248 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:248

                                                                                                                                              All faucets, no
                                                                                                                                              matter the type,
                                                                                                                                              have valves that
                                                                                                                                              move many
                                                                                                                                              thousands of
                                                                                                                                              times to open and
                                                                                                                                              close hot- and
                                                                                                                                              cold-water ports.
                                                                                                                                              These valves—or
                                                                                                                                              the rubber or
                                                                                                                                              plastic parts that
                                                                                                                                              rub against other
                                                                                                                                              parts when the
                                                                                     Cartridge
                                                                                                                                              faucet is being
               Spout
                                                                                                                                              adjusted—wear
                                                                                                                                              out in time.
                                                                                                                                              Depending on the
                                                                                                                                              faucet, you may
                                                                                               Mixing chamber                                 be able to fix the
                                                                                                                                              leak by cleaning
                                                                                                                                              or replacing
                   Aerator                                                                                                                    small parts, such
                                                                                                                                              as washers or
                                                                                                                                              O-rings; or you
                                                                                                                                              may need to buy
                                                                                                                                              a repair kit and
                                                                                                                                              replace a number
                                                                                                                                              of parts; or the
                                                                                                                                              only solution may
                                                                                                                                              be to replace a
                                                                                                                                              self-enclosed
                                Hot water supply tube                                                                                         “cartridge” that
                                                                                                                                              contains all the
                                      Cold water supply tube                                                                                  moving parts.

             COMMON PROBLEMS AND REPAIRS
          PROBLEMS                                             REPAIRS

          Faucet drips from the end of the spout               1. Identify the faucet design (see page 250), then install appropriate replacement parts
          or leaks around the base.                               using directions on the following pages.

          Old worn‑out faucet continues to leak                1. Replace the old faucet (see page 250).
          after repairs are made.

          Water pressure at spout seems low,                   1. Clean faucet aerator (see page 250).
          or water flow is partially blocked.                  2. Replace corroded galvanized pipes with copper or PEX.

          Water pressure from sprayer seems                    1. Clean sprayer head (see page 259).
          low, or sprayer leaks from handle.                   2. Fix diverter valve (see page 259).

          Water leaks onto floor underneath faucet.            1. Replace cracked sprayer hose (see page 261).
                                                               2. Tighten water connections, or replace supply tubes and shutoff valves.
                                                               3. Fix leaky sink strainer.

          Hose bib or valve drips from spout                   1. Take valve apart and replace washers and O‑rings.
          or leaks around handle.

                                                                                                                                        PLUMBING REPAIRS           249

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 249 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 249 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:249

              Identifying Your Faucet and the Parts You Need
              A leaky faucet is the most common home plumbing                           knowledgeable salesperson can help you identify the
              problem. Fortunately, repair parts are available for                      parts you need.
              almost every type of faucet, from the oldest to the                           If you cannot find what you are looking for
              newest, and installing these parts is usually easy. But                   at a local store, check online faucet sites or the
              if you don’t know your make and model, the hardest                        manufacturers’ sites; they often have step-by-step
              part of fixing a leak may be identifying your faucet                      instruction for identifying what you need. Note that
              and finding the right parts. Don’t make the common                        manufacturers’ terminology may not match the terms
              mistake of thinking that any similar-looking parts will                   we use here. For example, the word “cartridge” may
              do the job; you’ve got to get exact replacements.                         refer to a ceramic-disc unit.
                  There are so many faucet types that even
              experts have trouble classifying them into                                Most faucets have repair kits, which include all the parts you
              neat categories. Two-handle faucets are either                            need, and sometimes a small tool as well. Even if some of
                                                                                        the parts in your faucet look fine, it’s a good
              compression (stem) or washerless two-handle.                              idea to install the parts
              Single-handle faucets are classified as mixing                            provided by the kit
              cartridge; ball; disc; or disc/cartridge.                                 to ensure against
                  A single-handle faucet with a rounded, dome-                          future wear.
              shaped cap is often a ball type. If a single-handle
              faucet has a flat top, it is likely a cartridge or a
              ceramic disc type. An older two-handle faucet is
              likely of the compression type; newer two-handle
              models use washerless cartridges. Shut off the water,
              and test to verify that the water is off. Dismantle
              the faucet carefully. Look for a brand name: it may
              be clearly visible on the baseplate or printed on an
              inner part, or it may not be printed anywhere. Put
              all the parts into a reliable plastic bag and take them
              to your home center or plumbing supply store. A

                     REPAIR TIPS
                  If water flow is weak,                                                Cleaning and removing
                  unscrew the aerator at the                                            debris can sometimes solve
                  tip of the spout. If there is                                         the problem of low water
                  sediment, then dirty water                                            flow and occasionally can
                  is entering the faucet,                                               solve a leak as well.
                  which could damage the
                  faucet’s inner workings.

                                                           To remove handles and                                         Apply plumber’s grease
                                                           spouts, work carefully                                        (also known as faucet
                                                           and look for small screw                                      grease or valve grease) to
                                                           heads. You often need                                         new parts before installing
                                                           to first pry off a cap on                                     them. Be especially sure to
                                                           top, but not always. Parts                                    coat rubber parts such as
                                                           may be held in place with                                     O-rings and washers.
                                                           small setscrews.

   250        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 250 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 250 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:250

       Compression Faucets

                                                                          Cap

                                                                       Top screw

                                                                        Handle

                                                                                    Pry off the cap on top of the handle and remove the screw that
                                                                                    holds the cap onto the stem. Pull the handle up and out. Use
                                                                                    an adjustable wrench or pliers to unscrew the stem and pull
                                                                                    it out.

                                                                         Valve

                                                                         O-ring

                                                                       Stem screw

       A compression faucet has a stem assembly that includes a                     If the handle is stuck, try applying mineral cleaner from above.
       retaining nut, threaded spindle, O-ring, stem washer, and                    If that doesn’t work, you may need to buy a handle puller.
       stem screw. Dripping at the spout occurs when the washer                     With the cap and the hold-down screw removed, position the
       becomes worn. Leaks around the handle are caused by a                        wings of the puller under the handle and tighten the puller to
       worn O-ring.                                                                 slowly pull the handle up.

                                                                                                                             PLUMBING REPAIRS              251

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 251 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 251 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:251

              Remove the screw
              that holds the
              rubber washer
              in place, and pry
              out the washer.
              Replace a
              worn washer
              with an exact
              replacement—
              one that is the
              same diameter,
              thickness,
              and shape.

              Replace any
              O-rings. A worn
              O-ring can cause
              water to leak
              out the handle.
              Gently pry out the
              old O-ring and
              reinstall an exact
              replacement.
              Apply plumber’s
              grease to the
              rubber parts
              before reinstalling
              the stem.

              If washers wear
              out quickly, the
              seat is likely
              worn. Use a
              seat wrench to
              unscrew the seat
              from inside the
              faucet. Replace
              it with an exact
              duplicate. If
              replacing the
              washer and
              O-ring doesn’t
              solve the
              problem, you may
              need to replace
              the entire stem.

   252        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 252 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 252 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:252

       Washerless Two-Handle Faucet
                                                                               Remove the faucet handle, and withdraw the old cartridge.
                                                                               Make a note of how the cartridge is oriented before you
                                                                               remove it. Purchase a replacement cartridge.

                                                                                                      Retaining nut

               Handle
                                                                   Set screw

            Stem screw

                                                                               Install the replacement cartridge. Clean the valve seat first,
                                                                               and coat the valve seat and O-rings with faucet grease. Be
                                                                               sure the new cartridge is in the correct position, with its tabs
                                                                               seated in the slotted body of the faucet. Re-assemble the
           Retaining nut                                                       valve and handles.

              Cartridge

              Housing

       Almost all two-handle faucets made today are “washerless.”
       Instead of an older-type compression stem, there is
       a cartridge, usually with a plastic casing. Many of these
       cartridges contain ceramic discs, while others have metal or
       plastic pathways. No matter the type of cartridge, the repair
       is the same; instead of replacing small parts, you simply
       replace the entire cartridge.

                                                                                                                        PLUMBING REPAIRS              253

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 253 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 253 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:253

              One-Handle Cartridge Faucets
                                                                                     To remove the spout, pry off the handle’s cap and remove the
                           Cap
                                                                                     screw below it. Pull the handle up and off. Use a crescent
                                                                                     wrench to remove the pivot nut.

                       Cap screw

                                                                           Handle

                     Retaining nut

                          Spout

                         O-rings
                       and gasket

                                                                                     Lift out the spout. If the faucet has a diverter valve, remove it
                     Retaining clip
                                                                                     as well. Use a screwdriver to pry out the retainer clip, which
                                                                                     holds the cartridge in place.

                        Cartridge

                         O-rings
                                                                       Faucet body

              Single-handle cartridge faucets such as this work by moving
              the cartridge up and down and side to side, which opens up
              pathways to direct varying amounts of hot and cold water to
              the spout. Moen, Price-Pfister, Delta, Peerless, Kohler, and
              others make many types of cartridges, some of which look
              very different from this one.

   254        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 254 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 254 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:254

                                                                                                         Remove the
                                                                                                         cartridge. If you
                                                                                                         simply pull up
                                                                                                         with pliers, you
                                                                                                         may leave part
                                                                                                         of the stem in
                                                                                                         the faucet body.
                                                                                                         If that happens,
                                                                                                         replace the
                                                                                                         cartridge and
                                                                                                         buy a stem puller
                                                                                                         made for your
                                                                                                         model.

                                                                                                         Gently pry out
                                                                                                         and replace all
                                                                                                         O-rings on the
                                                                                                         faucet body.
                                                                                                         Smear plumber’s
                                                                                                         grease onto the
                                                                                                         new replacement
                                                                                                         cartridge and
                                                                                                         the new O-rings,
                                                                                                         and reassemble
                                                                                                         the faucet.

                                                                                                         Here is one of
                                                                                                         many other types
                                                                                                         of single-handle
                                                                                                         cartridges. In
                                                                                                         this model, all
                                                                                                         the parts are
                                                                                                         plastic except for
                                                                                                         the stem, and
                                                                                                         it’s important to
                                                                                                         note the direction
                                                                                                         in which the
                                                                                                         cartridge is
                                                                                                         aligned. If you
                                                                                                         test the faucet
                                                                                                         and the hot and
                                                                                                         cold are reversed,
                                                                                                         disassemble
                                                                                                         and realign
                                                                                                         the cartridge.

                                                                                                    PLUMBING REPAIRS              255

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 255 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 255 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:255

              Ball Faucets

                                                                                                          Ball

                                      Handle                                                                                             Cam

                                                                       Stem screw

                          Ball cap

                            Spout
                                                                                    Remove the old ball and cam after removing the faucet handle
                                                                                    and ball cap. Some faucets may require a ball faucet tool
                                                                                    to remove the handle. Otherwise, simply use a pair of
                                                                                    channel‑type pliers to twist off the ball cap.
                            Cam

                             Ball

                        Valve seats
                        and springs

                        Faucet body
                        and O-rings
                                                                         Outlet

              The ball‑type faucet is used by Delta, Peerless, and a few
              others. The ball fits into the faucet body and is constructed
              with three holes (not visible here)—a hot inlet, a cold inlet,
              and the outlet, which fills the valve body with water that then
              flows to the spout or sprayer. Depending on the position              Pry out the neoprene valve seals and springs. Place thick
              of the ball, each inlet hole is open, closed, or somewhere            towels around the faucet. Slowly turn on the water to flush out
              in‑between. The inlet holes are sealed to the ball with valve         any debris in the faucet body. Replace the seals and springs
              seats, which are pressed tight against the ball with springs. If      with new parts. Also replace the O‑rings on the valve body.
              water drips from the spout, replace the seats and springs. Or         You may want to replace the ball and cam too, especially if
              go ahead and purchase an entire replacement kit and replace           you’re purchasing a repair kit. Coat all rubber parts in faucet
              all or most of the working parts.                                     grease, and reassemble the faucet.

   256        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 256 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 256 2/10/18 11:07 AM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:256

       Disc Faucets
                                                                                     OTHER CARTRIDGES
                  Cap
                                                                                  Many modern cartridges do not have seals or O-rings
                                                                                  that can be replaced, and some have a ball rather than
                                                                                  a ceramic disk inside. For the repair, the cartridge’s
              Cap screw
                                                                                  innards do not matter; just replace the whole cartridge.

                                                                       Handle

            Threaded nut

               Cylinder

               Cartridge

                 Spout

       Disc-type faucets are the most common single-handle faucets
       currently being made. A pair of ceramic discs encased in
       a cylinder often referred to as a “cartridge” rub together as
       they rotate to open ports for hot and cold water. The ceramic            Replace the cylinder with a new one, coating the rubber parts
       discs do wear out in time, causing leaks, and there is only one          with faucet grease before installing the new cylinder. Make
       solution—replace the disc unit/cartridge. This makes for an              sure the rubber seals fit correctly in the cylinder openings
       easy—through comparatively expensive—repair.                             before you install the cylinder. Assemble the faucet handle.

                                                                                                                        PLUMBING REPAIRS              257

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 257 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 257 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:257

              Kitchen Sprayers

              I  f water pressure from a sink sprayer seems low, or
                 if water leaks from the handle, it is usually because
              lime buildup and sediment have blocked small
                                                                          apart and clean the parts. The aerator is a screw-on
                                                                          attachment with a small wire screen that mixes tiny
                                                                          air bubbles into the water flow. Make sure the wire
              openings inside the sprayer head. To fix the problem,       screen is not clogged with sediment and lime buildup.
              first take the sprayer head apart and clean the parts. If   If water pressure is low throughout the house, it may
              cleaning the sprayer head does not help, the problem        be because galvanized steel water pipes are corroded.
              may be caused by a faulty diverter valve. The diverter      Corroded pipes should be replaced with copper.
              valve inside the faucet body shifts water flow from the
              faucet spout to the sprayer when the sprayer handle is
              pressed. Cleaning or replacing the diverter valve may           TOOLS & MATERIALS
              fix water pressure problems.
                                                                            Screwdriver                     Vinegar
                   Whenever making repairs to a sink sprayer, check
              the sprayer hose for kinks or cracks. A damaged hose          Channel‑type pliers             Universal washer kit
              should be replaced.                                           Needlenose pliers               Heatproof grease
                   If water pressure from a faucet spout seems low, or      Small brush                     Replacement sprayer hose
              if the flow is partially blocked, take the spout aerator

                                                                                            Kitchen sprayers are very convenient
                                                                                            and, in theory, quite simple. Yet, they
                                                                                            break down with surprising regularity.
                                                                                            Fixing or replacing one is an easy
                                                                                            job, however.

   258        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 258 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 258 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:258

                     Sprayer head
                                                                                Sprayer head

                    Handle mount

                                                                                Handle mount
                     Sprayer base

                                           Faucet
                                           sprayer             Tailpiece
                                           nipple
                                                              Mounting
                                                                nut
                                           Sprayer
                                            hose              Coupling
                                                                nut

                                                               Supply
                                                                tube

                                                            Stop valve

      The standard sprayer hose attachment is connected to a               Sprayer heads can be removed from the sprayer hose, usually
      nipple at the bottom of the faucet valve. When the lever of the      by loosening a retaining nut. A sprayer’s head can get clogged
      sprayer is depressed, water flows from a diverter valve in           with minerals. Unscrew the sprayer from the hose and remove
      the faucet body out to the sprayer. If your sprayer stream is        any parts at its tip. Soak it in mineral cleaner, and use a small
      weak or doesn’t work at all, the chances are good that the           brush to open any clogged orifices.
      problem lies in the diverter valve.

                  How to Repair a Sprayer
      Shut off the water at the stop valves, and remove the faucet
      handle to gain access to the faucet parts. Disassemble
      the faucet handle and body to expose the diverter valve.
      Ball-type faucets such as the one shown here require that you
      also remove the spout to get at the diverter.

            1

                                                                                                                           Diverter valve

                                                                                                                                      2
                                                                           Locate the diverter valve, seen here at the base of the valve
                                                                           body. Because different types and brands of faucets have
                                                                           differently configured diverters, do a little investigating
                                                                           beforehand to try and locate information about your faucet.
                                                                           The above faucet is a ball type.
                                                                                                                                 (continued)

                                                                                                                    PLUMBING REPAIRS              259

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 259 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 259 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:259

                                                                         FINDING THE DIVERTER ON A TWO-HANDLE FAUCET
                                                                       On a two-handle faucet, the diverter is usually located in a vertical position
                                                                       just under the spout. Remove the spout. You may need to use longnose pliers
                                                                       to pull out the diverter. Try cleaning out any debris. If that does not restore
                                                                       operation, replace the valve.

                                                          3
              Pull the diverter valve from the faucet
              body with needlenose pliers. Use a
              toothbrush dipped in white vinegar to
              clean any lime buildup from the valve. If
              the valve is in poor condition, bring it
              to the hardware store and purchase
              a replacement.

                                    Diverter valve washer

                                                                                                                           Diverter

                                             Diverter valve

                                                          4
              Coat the washer or O-ring on the new
              or cleaned diverter valve with faucet
              grease. Insert the diverter valve back
              into the faucet body. Reassemble the
              faucet. Turn on the water, and test the
              sprayer. If it still isn’t functioning to your
              satisfaction, remove the sprayer tip and
              run the sprayer without the filter and
              aerator in case any debris has made its
              way into the sprayer line during repairs.

   260        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 260 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 260 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:260

                  How to Replace a Sprayer Head

                                                                       1       2
       Replace a leaking sprayer head rather than the whole                The spray head base is held in place by a small metal
       assembly to save money, time, and effort. Start by                  C-clip. Remove the rubber washer to expose the C-clip. Use
       unscrewing the ridged base nut on the existing spray head.          needle-nose pliers to grab the clip and spread it until it pops
       The spray head should come right off once the nut is                out of its ridge and releases from the base. Remove the C-clip
       entirely unscrewed.                                                 and base.

            3

                                                                              ALTERNATIVE: To remove the entire spray assembly,
       Secure the hose from slipping down the hole, if necessary.             simply unscrew the mounting nut for the sprayer on
       Buy a head to match the one you’re replacing. Disassemble              the underside of the deck, then use a crescent wrench
       the new head, and slide the new base onto the existing                 or basin wrench to unscrew the nut on the connection
       hose. Secure the base in place with a C-clip, cover with the           between the end of the spray hose and the faucet nipple
       rubber washer, and secure the sprayer on the base by hand-             (inset). Reverse the process to install the new sprayer.
       tightening the mounting nut.

                                                                                                                    PLUMBING REPAIRS              261

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 261 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 261 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:261

              Fixing Leaky Tubs & Shower Faucets

              T   ub and shower faucets have the same basic
                  designs as sink faucets, and the techniques for
              repairing leaks are the same as described in the faucet
                                                                        the diverter valve probably needs to be cleaned and
                                                                        repaired (see pages 259 to 260).
                                                                            Two-handle and single-handle types use a gate
              repair section of this book (see pages 248 to 261). To    diverter that is operated by a pull lever or knob on
              identify your faucet design, you may have to take off     the tub spout. Although gate diverters rarely need
              the handle and disassemble the faucet.                    repair, the lever occasionally may break, come loose,
                  When a tub and shower are combined, the               or refuse to stay in the up position. To repair a gate
              showerhead and the tub spout share the same hot           diverter set in a tub spout, replace the entire spout.
              and cold water supply lines and handles. Combination          Tub and shower faucets and diverter valves may be
              faucets are available as three-handle, two-handle, or     set inside wall cavities. Removing them may require a
              single-handle types (see next page). The number of        deep-set ratchet wrench.
              handles gives clues as to the design of the faucets and       If spray from the showerhead is uneven, clean
              the kinds of repairs that may be necessary.               the spray holes. If the showerhead does not stay in
                  With combination faucets, a diverter valve or gate    an upright position, remove the head and replace
              diverter is used to direct water flow to the tub spout    the O-ring.
              or the showerhead. On three-handle faucet types, the          To add a shower to an existing tub, install a
              middle handle controls a diverter valve. If water does    flexible shower adapter. Several manufacturers make
              not shift easily from tub to showerhead, or if water      complete conversion kits that allow a shower to be
              continues to run out the spout when the shower is on,     installed in less than one hour.

                                                                                                  Tub/shower plumbing is notorious
                                                                                                  for developing drips from the
                                                                                                  tub spout and the showerhead.
                                                                                                  In most cases, the leak can be
                                                                                                  traced to the valves controlled
                                                                                                  by the faucet handles.

   262        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 262 24/9/18 7:38 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 262 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:262

       Tub & Shower Combination Faucets

                                         Showerhead                                    Showerhead                                    Showerhead

                                  Diverter valve

                                                                                            Cold                                           Cold
                                                                                            water                                          water
                                                                                           supply                                         supply
                                               Cold                                                                                         line
                                                                                             line
                                               water
                                              supply
                                                line                                                            Gate
                                                                                                               diverter

                                                                                         Tub spout                                      Tub spout
                Hot water                  Tub spout                    Hot water                                Hot water
               supply line                                             supply line                              supply line

       Three-handle faucets (see page 264)                     Two-handle faucets (see page 266) have    Single-handle faucets (see page 268)
       have valves that are either compression                 valves that are either compression or     have valves that are cartridge, ball-type,
       or cartridge design.                                    cartridge design.                         or disc design.

                                                                                                                           PLUMBING REPAIRS              263

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 263 24/9/18 7:39 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 263 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:263

              Fixing Three-Handle Tub
              & Shower Faucets                                                                       TOOLS & MATERIALS
              A three-handle faucet type has two handles to control hot and cold water            Screwdriver
              and a third handle to control the diverter valve and direct water to either         Adjustable wrench
              a tub spout or a shower head. The separate hot and cold handles indicate               or channel‑type pliers
              cartridge or compression faucet designs.                                            Deep‑set ratchet wrench
                  If a diverter valve sticks, if water flow is weak, or if water runs
              out of the tub spout when the flow is directed to the showerhead,                   Small wire brush
              the diverter needs to be repaired or replaced. Most diverter valves                 Replacement diverter cartridge
              are similar to either compression or cartridge faucet valves.                          or universal washer kit
              Compression-type diverters can be repaired, but cartridge types                     Faucet grease
              should be replaced.                                                                 Vinegar
                  Remember to turn off the water before beginning work.

                                                                                                               A three-handle tub/shower
                                                                                                               faucet has individual
       Water line to
       shower head                                                                                             controls for hot and
                                                                                                               cold water plus a third
                                                                                                               handle that operates the
                                                                                                               diverter valve.

   Diverter valve

                                                                                                                    Diverter valve handle
                         Hot
                        water
                       supply
                         line

                                    Cold
                                    water
                                   supply
                                     line

   264        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 264 24/9/18 7:39 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 264 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:264

                  How to Repair a Compression Diverter Valve

             Escutcheon

                                                                                                                  Unscrew the stem assembly using
                                                                               Bonnet nut                         a deep-set ratchet wrench. If
                                                                                                                  necessary, chip away any mortar
                                                                                                                  surrounding the bonnet nut.

                                                                                                                                                3
             Diverter handle

                                                  1                                            2
       Remove the diverter valve handle with                   Remove the bonnet nut with
       a screwdriver. Unscrew or pry off                       an adjustable wrench or
       the escutcheon.                                         channel-type pliers.

                                                                                                          Clean sediment and lime buildup from the
                                                                                                          nut using a small wire brush dipped in
            4                                                          5                                  vinegar. Coat all parts with faucet grease,
                                                                                                          and reassemble the diverter valve.
                                                                   Retaining nut

                                                                                                                                              6

                                      Stem washer

                                                                                   Threaded spindle

                                      Stem screw

       Remove the brass stem screw. Replace                    Unscrew the threaded spindle from the
       the stem washer with an exact duplicate.                retaining nut.
       If the stem screw is worn, replace it.

                                                                                                                            PLUMBING REPAIRS              265

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 265 24/9/18 7:39 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 265 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:265

              Fixing Two-Handle Tub
                                                                                                                        TOOLS & MATERIALS
              & Shower Faucets
                                                                                                                     Screwdriver
              Two-handle tub and shower faucets are either cartridge or compression
                                                                                                                     Allen wrench
              design. Because the valves of two-handle tub and shower faucets may be
              set inside the wall cavity, a deep-set socket wrench may be required to                                Pipe wrench
              remove the valve stem.                                                                                 Channel‑type pliers
                  Two-handle tub and shower designs have a gate diverter, which is a                                 Small cold chisel
              simple mechanism located in the tub spout. A gate diverter closes the                                  Ball‑peen hammer
              supply of water to the tub spout and redirects the flow to the shower
              head. They seldom need repair. Occasionally, the lever may break,                                      Deep‑set ratchet wrench
              come loose, or refuse to stay in the up position.                                                      Masking tape or cloth
                  If the gate diverter fails to work properly, replace the tub spout. Tub                            Pipe joint compound
              spouts are inexpensive and easy to replace.                                                            Replacement faucet parts,
                  Remember to turn off the water before beginning any work.                                              as needed

                 Water line to
                 shower head

                                                                       Bonnet nut

                                                                                    Valve stem

                                                                                                                                              Diverter lever

                                         Cold water
                                         supply line

                                     Hot water
                                    supply line                                                             Gate diverter

              A two-handle tub/shower faucet can operate with compression valves, but more often these days they contain cartridges that can
              be replaced. Unlike a three-handle model, the diverter is a simple gate valve that is operated by a lever.

   266        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 266 24/9/18 7:39 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 266 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:266

              TIPS ON REPLACING A TUB SPOUT
                                                               Unscrew the faucet spout. Use a pipe
                                                               wrench or insert a large screwdriver or        Spout nipple
                                                               hammer handle into the spout opening,
                                                               and turn spout counterclockwise.

                                       Allen wrench

          Check underneath the tub spout for a                                                             Spread pipe joint compound on the
          small access slot. The slot indicates                                                            threads of the spout nipple before
          the spout is held in place with an                                                               replacing the spout. If you have a
          Allen screw. Remove the screw using                                                              copper pipe or a short pipe, buy
          an Allen wrench. The spout will                                                                  a spout retrofit kit, which can attach
          slide off.                                                                                       a spout to most any pipe.

                  How to Remove a Deep-Set Faucet Valve

                        Escutcheon
            1                                                          2                                       3
                                      Masking tape

                                        Stem nipple

                                                                                      Bonnet nut

       Remove the handle and unscrew the                       Chip away any mortar surrounding the        Unscrew the bonnet nut with a deep-set
       escutcheon with channel-type pliers. Pad                bonnet nut using a ball-peen hammer         ratchet wrench. Remove the bonnet nut
       the jaws of the pliers with masking tape                and a small cold chisel.                    and stem from the faucet body.
       to prevent scratching the escutcheon.

                                                                                                                             PLUMBING REPAIRS              267

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 267 24/9/18 7:39 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 267 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:267

              Fixing Single-Handle Tub & Shower Faucets
              A single-handle tub and shower faucet has one valve that                       diverters seldom need repair. Occasionally, the lever may
              controls both water flow and temperature. Single-handle                        break, come loose, or refuse to stay in the up position.
              faucets may be ball, cartridge, or disc designs.                                  Remember to turn off the water before beginning
                  If a single-handle control valve leaks or does not                         any work; the shower faucet shown here has built-in
              function properly, disassemble the faucet, clean the valve,                    shutoff valves, but many other valves do not. Open an
              and replace any worn parts. Repairing a single-handle                          access panel in an adjoining room or closet, behind
              cartridge faucet is shown on the opposite page.                                the valve, and look for two shutoffs. If you can’t find
                  Direction of the water flow to either the tub spout                        them there, you may have to shut off intermediate
              or the showerhead is controlled by a gate diverter. Gate                       valves or the main shutoff valve.

                     TOOLS & MATERIALS
                  Screwdriver                              Adjustable wrench                 Channel‑type pliers             Replacement faucet parts,
                                                                                                                               as needed

                Water line to
                shower head

                                                                 Built-in shutoff valves

                                                                 Control valve

                                Hot water
                               supply line

                                                                                                                                 Escutcheon

                                Cold water                                                                                A single-handle tub/shower faucet
                                supply line                                                                               is the simplest type to operate
                                                                                                                          and to maintain. The handle
                                                                                                                          controls the mixing ratio of both
                                                                                                                          hot and cold water, and the
                                                                                                                          diverter is a simple gate valve.
                                                                                  Gate diverter

   268        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 268 24/9/18 7:39 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 268 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:268

                  How to Repair a Single-Handle Cartridge Tub & Shower Faucet

                                                                                                                                Bonnet nut

                                                                           Built-in shutoff valves
           Handle

                                        Escutcheon

            1                                                          2                                                3
       Use a screwdriver to remove the handle                  Turn off the water supply at the built-in           Unscrew and remove the retaining ring
       and escutcheon.                                         shutoff valves or the main shutoff valve.           or bonnet nut using adjustable wrench.

                                                              Cartridge
                    O-ring

            4                                                                                   5
       Remove the cartridge assembly by grasping the end of the                             Flush the valve body with clean water to remove sediment.
       valve with channel-type pliers and pulling gently.                                   Replace any worn O-rings. Reinstall the cartridge, and test the
                                                                                            valve. If the faucet fails to work properly, replace the cartridge.

                                                                                                                                     PLUMBING REPAIRS              269

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 269 24/9/18 7:39 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 269 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:269

              Single-Handle Tub
              & Shower Faucet
              with Scald Control

              I  n many plumbing systems, if someone flushes a
                 nearby toilet or turns on the cold water of a nearby
              faucet while someone else is taking a shower, the shower
              water temperature can suddenly rise precipitously. This
              is not only uncomfortable; it can actually scald you. For
                                                                             The temperature of your shower may drastically rise to
              that reason, many one-handle shower valves have a              dangerous, scalding levels if a nearby toilet is flushed. A
              device, called a “balancing valve” or an “anti-scald valve,”   shower fixture equipped with an anti-scald valve prevents this
              that keeps the water from getting too hot.                     sometimes dangerous situation.

                          How to Adjust the Shower’s Temperature

                    1                                                            2

              To reduce or raise the maximum temperature, remove the         To remove a balancing valve, you may need to buy a removal
              handle and escutcheon. Some models have an adjustment          tool made for your faucet. Before replacing, slowly turn on
              screw, others have a handle that can be turned by hand.        water to flush out any debris; use a towel or bucket to keep
                                                                             water from entering the inside of the wall.

   270        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 270 2/10/18 10:02 AM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 270 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:270

       Fixing & Replacing Showerheads
       If spray from the showerhead is uneven, clean
       the spray holes. The outlet or inlet holes of                                               Shower arm
       the showerhead may get clogged with mineral
       deposits. Showerheads pivot into different positions.                                                       Collar nut
       If a showerhead does not stay in position, or if it leaks,
       replace the O-ring that seals against the swivel ball.
                                                                                                                          Swivel ball nut
           A tub can be equipped with a shower by installing
       a flexible shower adapter kit. Complete kits are
       available at hardware stores and home centers.                                                                             Spray adjustment
                                                                                                                                     cam lever

                                                                                          Swivel ball
             TOOLS & MATERIALS
                                                                                                 O-ring
          Adjustable wrench or                   Thin wire (paper clip)
             channel‑type pliers                 Faucet grease
          Pipe wrench                            Rag
          Drill                                  Replacement O‑rings                               Spray outlets
          Glass & tile bit                       Masonry anchors
          Mallet                                 Flexible shower adapter
          Screwdriver                               kit (optional)                  A typical showerhead can be disassembled easily for cleaning
          Masking tape                                                              and repair. Some showerheads include a spray adjustment
                                                                                    cam lever that is used to change the force of the spray.

                  How to Clean & Repair a Showerhead

                                                                                 Inlet holes                                       O-ring

                                   Swivel ball nut

             Collar nut

                                                  1                                              2                                              3
       Unscrew the swivel ball nut using an                    Clean outlet and inlet holes of the          Replace the O-ring, if necessary.
       adjustable wrench or channel-type                       showerhead with a thin wire. Flush the       Lubricate the O-ring with faucet grease
       pliers. Wrap the jaws of the tool with                  head with clean water.                       before installing.
       masking tape to prevent marring the
       finish. Unscrew the collar nut from
       the showerhead.

                                                                                                                                PLUMBING REPAIRS            271

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 271 24/9/18 7:39 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 271 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:271

                          How to Replace a Showerhead with a Handheld Spray Head

                    1                                                          2

              Make sure when shopping for a new handheld showerhead that   Attach the new showerhead mounting bracket by screwing the
              the head mounting bracket is compatible with your existing   mounting nut end onto the end of the shower arm (you don’t
              shower arm. Ask an associate for help if you’re not sure.    need Teflon tape for this because the bracket has an internal
              Remove the existing fixed head by unscrewing the mounting    rubber washer). Hand-tighten the bracket until it is snug and
              nut with channel-lock pliers.                                the large side of the mounting slot on the end is pointing up
                                                                           and the hose connection is pointing down.

                    3                                                          4

              Attach the mounting nut end of the showerhead hose to the    Screw the showerhead base onto the conical end of the
              hose connection on the bracket. Hand-tighten the hose        showerhead hose, and slip the cone base into the mounting
              mounting nut. Do not use pliers for this.                    bracket. Turn on the water, and check that there are no
                                                                           leaks. If you find any, turn the water off and hand-tighten the
                                                                           connection further until it does not leak.

                                                                           NOTE: The hose may curl up awkwardly; time and exposure
                                                                           to hot water will soon slacken the hose to hang normally.

   272        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 272 24/9/18 7:39 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 272 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:272

       Variation: Shower Conversion Kit
                D

                                                    C                                                    1
                                                                           F
                                                                                                     Remove the old tub faucet and replace it
            A                                                                                        with the new diverter-type faucet from the
                                         E                                                           kit. Fit the assembled shower riser into
                                                                                                     the top of the faucet and hand-tighten.
                                                                                                     Apply Teflon tape to the threads before
                                                                                                     making the connection. This assembly
                B                                                                                    includes one straight and one curved
                                                                                                     section, joined by a coupling. The top,
                                                                                                     curved pipe includes a connector to a wall
                                                                                                     brace. Shorten the straight section using
                                                                                                     a tubing cutter to lower the showerhead
                                                                                                     height, if desired. Slip the compression
       A packaged kit for adding a shower to your tub features a faucet with diverter (A),           nut and washer onto the bottom end of
       shower riser plumbing (B), showerhead (C), a frame for the shower curtain (D)                 the shower riser, and attach the riser
       that mounts on the wall and ceiling with threaded rods (E), and fasteners                     to the top of the faucet, hand-tightening
       and fittings (F).                                                                             for the time being.

                                                                       2           3

       With a helper, assemble the curtain frame, securing with                After the curtain frame is completely assembled and secured,
       setscrews. Hold the frame level, and measure to the ceiling             tighten the faucet connection with a wrench. Full-size
       to determine the ceiling brace pipe length. Cut the pipe, and           shower kits require one shower curtain on each side of the
       complete the ceiling brace assembly. Set the shower riser to            curtain frame. The hooks seen here feature roller bearings
       the desired height, and connect the brace to the wall (ensure           on the tops so they can be operated very smoothly with
       strong connections by driving the mounting screws into a wall           minimal resistance.
       stud and ceiling joist, if possible).

                                                                                                                       PLUMBING REPAIRS              273

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 273 24/9/18 7:39 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 273 2/10/18 11:12 AM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:273

              Tubs & Showers

              T    ub or shower not draining? First, make sure it’s
                   only the tub or shower. If your sink is plugged too,
              it may be a coincidence or it may be that a common
              branch line is plugged. A sure sign of this is when
              water drains from the sink into the tub. This could         As with bathroom sinks, tub and shower drain pipes may
              require the help of a drain cleaning service.               become clogged with soap and hair. The drain stopping
                  If the toilet also can’t flush (or worse, water         mechanisms can also require cleaning and adjustment.
              comes into the tub when you flush the toilet), then
              the common drain to all your bathroom fixtures is
              plugged. Call a drain cleaning service. If you suspect           TOOLS & MATERIALS
              the problem is only with your tub or shower, then
                                                                            Phillips screwdriver            Old toothbrush
              read on. We’ll show you how to clear drainlines
              and clean and adjust two types of tub stopper                 Plunger                         Needlenose pliers
              mechanisms. Adjusting the mechanism can also                  Scrub brush                     Dishwashing brush
              help with the opposite problem: a tub that drains             White vinegar                   Faucet grease
              when you’re trying to take a bath.

                     MAINTENANCE TIP
                  Like bathroom sinks, tubs
                  and showers face an ongoing
                  onslaught from soap and
                  hair. When paired, this pesky
                  combination is a sure-fire
                  source of clogs. The soap scum
                  coagulates as it is washed down
                  the drain and binds the hair
                  together in a mass that grows
                  larger with every shower or bath.
                  To nip these clogs in the bud,
                  simply pour boiling hot clean
                  water down the drain from time to
                  time to melt the soapy mass and
                  wash the binder away.

   274        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 274 24/9/18 7:39 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 274 2/10/18 11:12 AM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:274

             USING HAND AUGERS
                                                                                                                On shower drains, feed the head of
                                                                                                                a hand-crank or drill-powered auger
                                                                                                                in through the drain opening after
                                                                                                                removing the strainer. Crank the
                                                                                                                handle of the auger to extend the
                                                                                                                cable and the auger head down into
                                                                                                                the trap and, if the clog is farther
                                                                 Sloped receptor                                downline, toward the branch drain.
                                                                                                                When clearing any drain, it is always
                                                                                                                better to retrieve the clog than to
                                                                                                                push it farther downline.

                                          Drain opening
             Subfloor

                                                             Trap arm

                                                                       Branch drain line
                                        Trap

                                                                                                                On combination tub/showers, it’s
                                                                                                                generally easiest to insert the auger
                                                                                                                through the overflow opening after
                                                                                                                removing the coverplate and lifting
                                                                                                                out the drain linkage. Crank the
                                                                                  Overflow drain opening        handle of the auger to extend the
                                                                                                                cable and the auger head down into
                                                                                                                the trap and, if the clog is farther
                                                                                                                downline, toward the branch drain.
                                                                                                                When clearing any drain, it is always
                                                                                                                better to retrieve the clog than to
                                                                                                                push it farther downline.

                                                                                 Drain line

                                                                                                                                  PLUMBING REPAIRS              275

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 275 24/9/18 7:39 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 275 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:275

                          How to Fix a Plunger-Type Drain

                                Coverplate

                                                                       Linkage-adjusting bracket
                                 Trip lever

                                                                            Overflow drain

                                                                               Linkage

                  Drain opening
                                                                                                              1
                                                                               Plunger
                                                                                                          A plunger-type tub drain has a simple
                                                                                                          grate over the drain opening and a
                                                                                                          behind-the-scenes plunger stopper.
                                                                                                          Remove the screws on the overflow
                                                                                                          coverplate with a slotted or Phillips
                 Tub shoe                                                                                 screwdriver. Pull the coverplate, linkage,
                                                                                                          and plunger from the overflow opening.

              Clean hair and soap off the plunger with a scrub brush.
              Mineral buildup is best tackled with white vinegar and a
              toothbrush or a small wire brush.

                                                                       2

                                                                                      3
                                                                                  Adjust the plunger. If your tub isn’t holding water with the
                                                                                  plunger down, it’s possible the plunger is hanging too high to
                                                                                  fully block water from the tub shoe. Loosen the locknut with
                                                                                  needlenose pliers, then screw the rod down about 1⁄8". Tighten
                                                                                  the locknut down. If your tub drains poorly, the plunger may
                                                                                  be set too low. Loosen the locknut, and screw the rod in 1⁄8"
                                                                                  before retightening the locknut.

   276        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 276 24/9/18 7:39 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 276 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:276

                  How to Fix a Pop-Up Drain

                           Coverplate

                           Trip lever
                                                                           Overflow drain

                                                                              Linkage

                 Drain opening

             Drain stopper                                                                                 1
                                                                                                       Raise the trip lever to the open position.
                                                                            Rocker arm
                                                                                                       Pull the stopper and rocker arm
                                                                                                       assembly from the drain. Clean off soap
                                                                                                       and hair with a dishwashing brush in
                                                                                                       a basin of hot water. Clean off mineral
                                                                                                       deposits with a toothbrush or small wire
                                                                                                       brush and white vinegar.

       Remove the screws from the cover plate. Pull the trip lever and
       the linkage from the overflow opening. Clean off soap and
       hair with a brush in a basin of hot water. Remove mineral buildup
       with white vinegar and a wire brush. Lubricate moving parts of
       the linkage and rocker arm mechanism with faucet grease.

                                                                                  Linkage adjusting bracket
                                                                       2

                                                                                                                                    Locknut

                                                                                  3
                                                                              Adjust the pop-up stopper mechanism by first loosening the
                                                                              locknut on the lift rod. If the stopper doesn’t close all the way,
                                                                              shorten the linkage by screwing the rod 1⁄8" farther into the
                                                                              linkage-adjusting bracket. If the stopper doesn’t open wide
                                                                              enough, extend the linkage by unscrewing the rod 1⁄8". Tighten
                                                                              the locknut before replacing the mechanism and testing
                                                                              your adjustment.

                                                                                                                         PLUMBING REPAIRS              277

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 277 24/9/18 7:39 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 277 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:277

              Sink Drains

              E    very sink has a drain trap and a fixture drain line. Sink clogs usually
                   are caused by a buildup of soap and hair in the trap or fixture drain
              line. Remove clogs by using a plunger, disconnecting and cleaning the
              trap (this page), or using a hand auger (see page 275).
                  Many sinks hold water with a mechanical plug called a pop-up stopper.
              If the sink will not hold standing water, or if water in the sink drains too
              slowly, the pop-up stopper must be cleaned and adjusted.

                     TOOLS & MATERIALS                                                                               Clogged lavatory sinks can be cleared
                                                                                                                     with a plunger (not to be confused with
                  Plunger                            Screwdriver                        Bucket                       a flanged force-cup). Remove the
                                                                                                                     pop-up drain plug and strainer first,
                  Channel‑type pliers                Flashlight                         Replacement gaskets          and plug the overflow hole by stuffing a
                  Small wire brush                   Rag                                Teflon tape                  wet rag into it, allowing you to create air
                                                                                                                     pressure with the plunger.

                          How to Clear a Sink Trap

                    1                         Slip nuts
                                                                                                   2

                                                                   Fixture drain line

                                                     Trap bend

              Place a bucket under the trap, and loosen the slip nuts on the                   Remove any debris. Clean the trap bend with a small wire
              trap bend with channel pliers. Unscrew the nuts by hand and                      brush. Inspect the slip nut washers and replace if necessary.
              slip them away from the connections. Pull off the trap.                          Reinstall the trap bend, and tighten the slip nuts.

   278        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 278 24/9/18 7:39 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 278 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:278

                  How to Clear a Kitchen Sink

                  Drainline from dishwasher                                                                                           2

                                                                       1
       Plunging a kitchen sink is not difficult, but you need to create    If there is a second basin, have a helper hold a basket strainer
       an uninterrupted pressure lock between the plunger and              plug in its drain or put a large pot or bucket full of water on
       the clog. If you have a dishwasher, the drain tube needs to         top of it. Unfold the skirt within the plunger and place this
       be clamped shut and sealed off at the disposal or drainline.        in the drain of the sink you are plunging. There should be
       The pads on the clamp should be large enough to flatten the         enough water in the sink to cover the plunger head. Plunge
       tube across its full diameter (or you can clamp the tube ends       rhythmically for six repetitions with increasing vigor, pulling up
       between small boards).                                              hard on the last repitition. Repeat this sequence until the clog
                                                                           is removed. Flush out a cleared pipe with plenty of hot water.

                  How to Use a Hand Auger at the Trap Arm
                                                                           If you suspect the clog is downstream of the trap, remove the
                                                                           trap arm from the fitting at the wall. Look in the fixture drain
                                                                           with a flashlight. If you see water, that means the fixture drain
                                                                           is plugged. Clear it with a hand-crank or drill-powered auger.

                                                                               2

                                                                       1
       If plunging doesn’t work, remove the trap and clean it out.
       With the trap off, see if water flows freely from both sinks (if
       you have two). Sometimes clogs will lodge in the tee fitting
       or one of the waste pipes feeding it. These may be pulled
       out manually or cleared with a bottlebrush or wire. When
       reassembling the trap, apply Teflon tape clockwise to the male
       threads of metal waste pieces. Tighten with your channel-type
       pliers. Plastic pieces need no tape and should be hand
       tightened only.

                                                                                                                    PLUMBING REPAIRS              279

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 279 24/9/18 7:39 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 279 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:279

                                                                                                TOOLS & MATERIALS
                                                                                             Adjustable wrench               Rags
                                                                                                or pipe wrench               Penetrating oil
                                                                                             Hand auger                      Cleanout plug (if needed)
                                                                                             Cold chisel                     Pipe joint compound

              Branch & Main Drains                                                           Ball‑peen hammer
                                                                                             Bucket
                                                                                                                             Electrical drum auger
                                                                                                                             Gloves
                                                                                             Ladder                          Teflon Tape
                                                                                             Phillips screwdriver
              I  f using a plunger or a hand auger does not clear
                 a clog in a fixture drain line, it means that the
              blockage may be in a branch line, the main waste-vent                        bottom of the main drainage stack. Remove the plug
              stack, or the sewer service line.                                            and push the cable of a hand auger into the opening.
                   First, use a hand-crank or drill-powered auger to                           Some sewer service lines in older homes have
              clear the branch drain line closest to any stopped-up                        a house trap. The house trap is a U-shaped fitting
              fixtures. Branch drain lines may be serviced through                         located at the point where the sewer line exits the
              the cleanout fittings located at the end of the branch.                      house. Most of the fitting will be beneath the floor
              Because waste water may be backed up in the                                  surface, but it can be identified by its two openings.
              drain lines, always open a cleanout with caution.                            Use a hand auger to clean a house trap.
              Place a bucket and rags under the opening to catch                               If the auger meets solid resistance in the sewer line,
              waste water. Never position yourself directly under                          retrieve the cable and inspect the bit. Fine, hair-like
              a cleanout opening while unscrewing the plug                                 roots on the bit indicate the line is clogged with tree
              or cover.                                                                    roots. Dirt on the bit indicates a collapsed line.
                   If using an auger on the branch line does not solve                         Use a power auger to clear sewer service lines that
              the problem, then the clog may be located in a main                          are clogged with tree roots. Power augers are available
              drainage stack. To clear the stack, run an auger cable                       at rental centers. However, a power auger is a large,
              down through the roof vent. Make sure that the                               heavy piece of equipment. Before renting, consider
              cable of your auger is long enough to reach down                             the cost of rental and the level of your do-it-yourself
              the entire length of the stack. If it is not, you may want                   skills versus the price of a professional sewer cleaning
              to rent or borrow another auger. Always use extreme                          service. If you rent a power auger, ask the rental
              caution when working on a ladder or on a roof.                               dealer for complete instructions on how to operate
                   If no clog is present in the main stack, the problem                    the equipment.
              may be located in the sewer service line. Locate the                             Always consult a professional sewer cleaning
              main cleanout, usually a wye-shaped fitting at the                           service if you suspect a collapsed line.

                                            Main drainage stack
                                                                                                                                  Cleanout fitting
                                                                                                                                     and plugs

                                                                       Branch drain line

                                                                                             Wye fitting

              Clear a branch drain line by locating the cleanout fitting at the end of the line. Place a bucket underneath the opening to catch waste
              water, then slowly unscrew the cleanout plug with an adjustable wrench. Clear clogs in the branch drain line with a hand auger.

   280        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 280 24/9/18 7:39 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 280 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:280

                  How to Clear a Branch Drain Line

                                                                                                              2
           Street side                                                                House side

            1
       Clear the house trap in a sewer service line using a hand auger. Slowly remove                     If all else fails, you can try to clear the
       only the plug on the “street side” of the trap. If water seeps out the opening as the              main drainage stack by running the
       plug is removed, the clog is in the sewer line beyond the trap. If no water seeps                  cable of a hand-crank or drill-powered
       out, auger the trap. If no clog is present in the trap, replace the street-side plug               auger down through the roof vent.
       and remove the house-side plug. Use the auger to clear clogs located between the                   Always use extreme caution while
       house trap and main stack.                                                                         working on a ladder or roof.

                  How to Replace a Main Drain Cleanout Plug

                                                                  Cleanout plug

            1                                                                          2
       Remove the cleanout plug using a large wrench. If the plug                  Remove stubborn plugs by placing the cutting edge of a cold
       does not turn out, apply penetrating oil around the edge of the             chisel on the edge of the plug. Strike the chisel with a
       plug, wait 10 minutes, and try again. Place rags and a bucket               ball-peen hammer to move the plug counterclockwise. If the
       under fitting opening to catch any water that may be backed                 plug does not turn out, break it into pieces with the chisel and
       up in the line.                                                             hammer. Remove all broken pieces.

                                                                                                   Wing nut

                                                                                                                                       Metal plates

            3                                                   Cleanout fitting
                                                                                       ALTERNATIVE: Replace the old plug with an expandable
                                                                                       rubber plug. A wing nut squeezes the rubber core
       Replace the old plug with a new plug. Apply pipe joint                          between two metal plates. The rubber bulges slightly to
       compound to the threads of the replacement plug, and screw                      create a watertight seal.
       it into the cleanout fitting.

                                                                                                                            PLUMBING REPAIRS              281

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 281 24/9/18 7:39 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 281 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:281

                                                                                  TOOLS & MATERIALS
                                                                               Reciprocating saw               Foam rubber
                                                                                  or hacksaw                      pipe insulation
                                                                               Propane torch                   Pipe and fittings,
              Noisy Pipes                                                         (for sweating copper)           as needed
                                                                               Pipe wrenches                   Utility knife
                                                                                  (for galvanized steel)       Teflon tape

              A    ir pockets in flowing water that move when                  Adjustable wrench
                    appliances or fixtures cycle on or off can cause
              pipes to bang against framing. Noise comes from
              the air pockets lurching in the pipes and the pipes            small enough to be installed easily near the noisy
              hitting structural elements. The effect is called              valve or appliance (the closer the better). They can
              water hammer.                                                  be positioned horizontally or vertically or at an angle
                  Water hammer can be more than an annoyance.                without any change in effectiveness. Unlike with
              The shockwave can cause damage and eventually                  old-style air chambers, water cannot fill a water
              failure in pipes and fittings. If a pressure-relief valve on   hammer arrester, so they should be effective for the
              your water heater leaks, it may not be a faulty valve          life of the system.
              but a pressure surge in the supply system.                         Pipes that bang against studs or joists can be
                  You can eliminate water hammer by installing a             quieted by cushioning them with pieces of pipe
              simple device called a water hammer arrester in the            insulation. Make sure pipe hangers are snug and that
              supply line. Inexpensive point-of-use arresters are            pipes are well supported.

              Loose pipes may bang or rub against joist hangers, creating    A tube strap holds pipe away from a framing member. Just
              noise. Use pieces of foam rubber pipe insulation to            snap the strap on and drive in a nail.
              cushion pipes.

   282        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 282 24/9/18 7:39 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 282 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:282

                  How to Install a Water Hammer Arrester
                                                               Install a tee fitting as close to the valve
                                                               as possible.

                                                                                                                                            Short pipe
                                                                       2

                                                                                                                                            Branch arm

                                                                                                                                              T-fitting

                                                  1                                                                3
       Shut off the water supply, and drain the                                                                Install a short piece of pipe in the
       pipes. Use a tubing cutter or reciprocating                                                             branch arm of the tee fitting. This
       saw to cut out a section of horizontal pipe                                                             short pipe will be used to attach a
       long enough for a tee fitting.                                                                          threaded fitting.

            4                                                                                                                                         5
       Install a threaded fitting. Use a fitting               Wrap the threads of the arrester in Teflon tape. Thread the arrester onto the fitting
       recommended by the manufacturer of                      by hand. Tighten by holding the fitting with one adjustable wrench and turning the
       your arrester.                                          arrester with the other. Do not overtighten. Turn the water on, and check for leaks.

                                                                                                                                 PLUMBING REPAIRS              283

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 283 24/9/18 7:39 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 283 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:283

              Measurement Conversions
              LUMBER DIMENSIONS
              NOMINAL ‑ U.S.           ACTUAL ‑ U.S. (IN INCHES)         METRIC             NOMINAL ‑ U.S.       ACTUAL ‑ U.S. (IN INCHES)       METRIC
              1×2                      ¾ × 1½                            19 × 38 mm         1½ × 4               1¼ × 3½                         32 × 89 mm
              1×3                      ¾ × 2½                            19 × 64 mm         1½ × 6               1¼ × 5½                         32 × 140 mm
              1×4                      ¾ × 3½                            19 × 89 mm         1½ × 8               1¼ × 7¼                         32 × 184 mm
              1×5                      ¾ × 4½                            19 × 114 mm        1½ × 10              1¼ × 9¼                         32 × 235 mm
              1×6                      ¾ × 5½                            19 × 140 mm        1½ × 12              1¼ × 11¼                        32 × 286 mm
              1×7                      ¾ × 6¼                            19 × 159 mm        2×4                  1½ × 3½                         38 × 89 mm
              1×8                      ¾ × 7¼                            19 × 184 mm        2×6                  1½ × 5½                         38 × 140 mm
              1 × 10                   ¾ × 9¼                            19 × 235 mm        2×8                  1½ × 7¼                         38 × 184 mm
              1 × 12                   ¾ × 11¼                           19 × 286 mm        2 × 10               1½ × 9¼                         38 × 235 mm
              1¼ × 4                   1 × 3½                            25 × 89 mm         2 × 12               1½ × 11¼                        38 × 286 mm
              1¼ × 6                   1 × 5½                            25 × 140 mm        3×6                  2½ × 5½                         64 × 140 mm
              1¼ × 8                   1 × 7¼                            25 × 184 mm        4×4                  3½ × 3½                         89 × 89 mm
              1¼ × 10                  1 × 9¼                            25 × 235 mm        4×6                  3½ × 5½                         89 × 140 mm
              1¼ × 12                  1 × 11¼                           25 × 286 mm

              METRIC CONVERSIONS
              TO CONVERT:                TO:                       MULTIPLY BY:             TO CONVERT:           TO:                     MULTIPLY BY:
              Inches                     Millimeters               25.4                     Millimeters           Inches                  0.039
              Inches                     Centimeters               2.54                     Centimeters           Inches                  0.394
              Feet                       Meters                    0.305                    Meters                Feet                    3.28
              Yards                      Meters                    0.914                    Meters                Yards                   1.09
              Square inches              Square centimeters        6.45                     Square centimeters    Square inches           0.155
              Square feet                Square meters             0.093                    Square meters         Square feet             10.8
              Square yards               Square meters             0.836                    Square meters         Square yards            1.2
              Ounces                     Milliliters               30.0                     Milliliters           Ounces                  .033
              Pints (U.S.)               Liters                    0.473 (lmp. 0.568)       Liters                Pints (U.S.)            2.114 (lmp. 1.76)
              Quarts (U.S.)              Liters                    0.946 (lmp. 1.136)       Liters                Quarts (U.S.)           1.057 (lmp. 0.88)
              Gallons (U.S.)             Liters                    3.785 (lmp. 4.546)       Liters                Gallons (U.S.)          0.264 (lmp. 0.22)
              Ounces                     Grams                     28.4                     Grams                 Ounces                  0.035
              Pounds                     Kilograms                 0.454                    Kilograms             Pounds                  2.2

              COUNTERBORE, SHANK & PILOT HOLE DIAMETERS
                 SCREW           COUNTERBORE DIAMETER FOR                  CLEARANCE HOLE FOR                              PILOT HOLE DIAMETER
                  SIZE            SCREW HEAD (IN INCHES)                 SCREW SHANK (IN INCHES)        HARD WOOD (IN INCHES)          SOFT WOOD (IN INCHES)
                    #1                          9
                                                 ⁄64                                5
                                                                                     ⁄64                           3
                                                                                                                    ⁄64                          1
                                                                                                                                                  ⁄32
                    #2                          ¼                                   3
                                                                                     ⁄32                           3
                                                                                                                    ⁄64                          1
                                                                                                                                                  ⁄32
                    #3                          ¼                                   7
                                                                                     ⁄64                           1
                                                                                                                     ⁄16                         3
                                                                                                                                                  ⁄64
                    #4                          ¼                                   1
                                                                                      ⁄8                           1
                                                                                                                     ⁄16                         3
                                                                                                                                                  ⁄64
                    #5                          ¼                                   1
                                                                                      ⁄8                           5
                                                                                                                    ⁄64                          1
                                                                                                                                                   ⁄16
                    #6                          5
                                                 ⁄16                                9
                                                                                     ⁄64                           3
                                                                                                                    ⁄32                          5
                                                                                                                                                  ⁄64
                    #7                          5
                                                 ⁄16                                5
                                                                                     ⁄32                           3
                                                                                                                    ⁄32                          5
                                                                                                                                                  ⁄64
                    #8                          3
                                                  ⁄8                               11
                                                                                      ⁄64                          1
                                                                                                                      ⁄8                         3
                                                                                                                                                  ⁄32
                    #9                          3
                                                  ⁄8                               11
                                                                                      ⁄64                          1
                                                                                                                      ⁄8                         3
                                                                                                                                                  ⁄32
                   #10                          3
                                                  ⁄8                                3
                                                                                     ⁄16                           1
                                                                                                                      ⁄8                         7
                                                                                                                                                  ⁄64
                   #11                          ½                                   3
                                                                                     ⁄16                           5
                                                                                                                    ⁄32                          9
                                                                                                                                                  ⁄64
                   #12                          ½                                   7
                                                                                     ⁄32                           9
                                                                                                                    ⁄64                           1
                                                                                                                                                    ⁄8

   284        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 284 24/9/18 7:39 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 284 23/10/18 11:58 AM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:284

       Resources
       Accessibility Resource Center (ARC)                     Kohler                                           Plumbing and Drainage Institute
       Shower and wet room kits, Aging in Place                800-456-4537                                     978-557-0720
         and accessibility accessories                         www.kohler.com                                   www.pdionline.org
       877-319-6521
                                                               Laticrete                                        Plumbing, Heating, Cooling Contractors
       www.arcfirst.net
                                                               Floor-warming mats and supplies                     Association (PHCC)
       American Standard                                       800-243-4788                                     Producers of the National Standard
       800-442-1902                                            www.laticrete.com                                   Plumbing Code
       www.americanstandard-us.com                                                                              800-533-7694
                                                               Moen
                                                                                                                www.phccweb.org
       BLACK+DECKER                                            Bathroom faucets, shower fixtures, safety
       Power tools and accessories                               and accessibility accessories                  Price Pfister
       800-544-6986                                            800-289-6636                                     800-732-8238
       www.blackanddecker.com                                  www.moen.com                                     www.pfisterfaucets.com

       International Association of Plumbing                   MTI                                              Swanstone
          & Mechanical Officials                               Tubs, shower bases and enclosures,               800-325-7008
       909-472-4100                                              sinks, accessories                             www.swanstone.com
       www.iapmo.org                                           800-783-8827
                                                                                                                Toto
                                                               www.mtibaths.com
       International Code Council                                                                               888-295-8134
       888-422-7233                                            National Kitchen & Bathroom Association          www.totousa.com
       www.iccsafe.org                                            (NKBA)
                                                                                                                Water Sense
                                                               800-843-6522
       John Guest Co.                                                                                           www.epa.gov/watersense
                                                               www.nkba.com
       Speedfit push-in fittings
                                                                                                                World Plumbing Council
       www.johnguest.com
                                                                                                                secretariat@worldplumbing.org
                                                                                                                www.worldplumbing.org

       Photo Credits
       American Standard: 128                                                          Rich Fleischman: 23 (middle left), 24 (middle), 30 (all), 31 (top inset,
                                                                                          middle left and right, bottom), 36 (top), 38-40 (all), 41 (top left
       iStock: 111 (top)
                                                                                          and right, middle left and right), 71 (top right), 246-247 (all), 261
       Kohler: 90, 200 (both), 222 (top), 236, 258                                        (all), 271 (bottom, all), 272 (all)

       Photolibrary: 174                                                               Shutterstock: 3 (bottom), 76, 85 (top right), 154, 161 (top, bottom
                                                                                         right), 227 (top)
       Price Pfister: 91 (all)
                                                                                       Symmons: 216 (bottom)

                                                                                                                       RESOURCES/PHOTO CREDITS                    285

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 285 24/9/18 7:39 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 285 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:285

              Index
              ABS (acrylonitrile butadiene styrene) pipes              braided metal pipes 20–21                        disc faucets see faucets

                  20–21                                                branch drain lines: clogs or blockages           dishwashers 100–103

              accessibility: and faucets 133; and shower                  280–281; gas 73; pipe sizing 77; sample       diverter gates 266

                  design 165; and sinks 202                               layouts 9, 34; water supply 8                 diverter valves 258–260, 262–265;

              access panels 62, 65                                     building drain see drain-waste-vent                 see also valves

              Access Reliability Center kits 164                          system (DWV)                                  drains: bathtubs 67, 276–277; fittings 48;

              air admittance valve see valves                                                                              kits 97; pop-up stoppers and drains

              alcove bathtubs see bathtubs                             capacitance and faucets 133                         136–139, 192; sinks 96–99, 136–139,

              appliances see individual appliances                     cartridge faucets 253–255, 257;                     278–279; standpipe 214–215; toilets 67

              arresters and water hammer 282–283                          see also faucets                              drain-waste-overflow (DWO) and bathtubs

              augers: and kitchen sinks 279; and                       cast iron pipes 20–21                               175, 177–179

                  plumbing lines 280–281; and shower                   cements (solvent) 42                             drain-waste-vent system (DWV): basic

                  clogs 275; and toilet clogs 19, 243; and             chases 64                                           information 8–9, 11; bathtubs 175;

                  types of 18, 19                                      chromed brass pipes 20–21                           fittings 48–51; layouts 9, 11, 68–69; new

                                                                       chromed copper supply tubes 20–21                   installations 72, 74–75; see also branch

              ball faucets 256, 259; see also faucets                  clawfoot tubs see bathtubs                          drain lines

              ball valves 55; see also valves                          closet augers see augers                         drop-in sink see sinks

              basement bath, installing pipes 75                       closet flanges see flanges and toilets           dual-flush valves 236–239

              bathrooms: bathtubs 174–179, 184–191,                    CO2 injection plunger 241

                  218–221; bidets 192–195; drains                      compression faucets 251–252;                     faucets: ball 256; bathtub-shower 262–270;

                  136–139, 278; faucets 128–132,                          see also faucets                                 compression 251–252; disc (cartridge)

                  262–270; shower conversion kits                      compression fittings 56–57; see also fittings       257; hands-free 133–135; kitchen 90–95,

                  273; showerheads 271–272; showers                       and connectors                                   258–261; lavatory 128–132; one-handled

                  140–161, 164–173, 274–275; sinks                     connectors see fittings and connectors              (cartridge) 254–255; pot fillers 222–223;

                  200–201, 202–205, 208–211; toilets                   control valves see valves                           problems and repairs 248–250; two-

                  84–89, 226–231; see also wet walls                   copper pipes and tubes: compression fittings        handled washerless (cartridge) 253; and

              bathtubs: alcove 174–179; clogged drains                    56–57; cutting and soldering copper              water flow 250

                  274–277; faucet repairs 262–270;                        24–28; push-fit fittings 31; soldering        fittings and connectors: compression fittings

                  freestanding (clawfoot) 218–221; shower                 brass 28; types of 20–22, 103; working           56; illustrated guide to fittings 48–50; PEX

                  conversion kits 273; sliding doors                      with 23, 103                                     36–40; push-fit fittings 30–31; transition

                  180–183; whirlpool 184–191                           CPVC (chlorinated polyvinyl chloride) pipes         fittings 51

              bathtub-shower combination: faucet repairs                  20–21                                         fixtures see individual fixtures

                  262–270; sliding doors 180–183                       crawl spaces and fittings 56                     fixture shutoff valves 13; see also valves

              bidets 192–195                                           curbless showers see showers                     flanges and toilets 244–247

              black (iron) pipes 20–21                                 cutting copper pipes 24–25                       flexible plastic pipes see plastic pipes

   286        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 286 24/9/18 7:39 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 286 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:286

       force cup (flanged) plungers 18, 241                    lavatory drains (bathroom sinks)                   pop-up stoppers and drains 136–139,

       framing members 62, 76                                      136–139, 278                                      192, 278

       freestanding tubs see bathtubs                          lavatory faucets 128–132; see also faucets         pot fillers see faucets

                                                               layouts, samples of 11, 34, 68–69, 125, 222        pressure surges and pipes 282

       garbage disposals 104–109                               lead and pipes 10, 11                              pullout kitchen sink faucet 93–94;

       gas pipes 73, 116; see also water heaters:              leaks: and faucets 248–249; and finding               see also faucets

          gas and electric                                         them 205                                       push-fit fittings 30–31

       gas water heaters see water heaters                                                                        PVC (polyvinyl chloride) pipes 20–21

       gate valves 55; see also valves                         main drain lines 281; see also branch              PVC-type pipes 42–45

       GFCI-protected circuits 101, 104, 184                       drain lines

       glass-wall shower see showers                           main shutoff valves 8–9, 12; see also valves       repairs and water shutoffs 12–13

       globe valves 55; see also valves                        measurement conversions 285                        retrofit icemakers see icemakers

                                                               meters (water) 8–9                                 rigid plastic pipes see plastic pipes

       hand augers see augers                                                                                     “roll-under” sinks see sinks

       hands-free faucets 133–135;                             noise and pipes 282–283

          see also faucets                                                                                        saddle valves 13; see also valves

       hard water solutions 196                                one-handle cartridge faucets see faucets           self-rimming sinks see sinks
       health hazards and lead 10, 11                          outdoor flexible plastic pipes                     semi-pedestal sink see sinks

       heaters see water heaters                                   see plastic pipes                              sensors 133

       home plumbing system 8–9                                                                                   sewer line 8–9

       hose bibs 54, 249                                       partial-house shutoffs 13; see also valves         shower-bathtub combination: and faucet

       hot tubs see whirlpool tubs                             pedestal and console sinks see sinks                  repairs 262–270; and sliding doors

                                                               PE (polyethylene) plastic pipes 20–21,                180–183

       icemakers 110–115                                           46–47                                          showers: bathtub-shower faucet repair

       integral sinks 208–211; see also sinks                  PEX: and building codes 35; and                       262–269; clogs 274–275; conversion

       integral valves 13; see also valves                         connections 36–40; general information            kits for bathtubs 273; curbless showers

       iron pipes 20–21                                            20–21, 32–33; and installations 22,               162, 164–173; enclosure kits 140–145;
                                                                   35–36, 41, 222; and system designs 34             glass-wall kits 149–153; hinged door

       jetted tubs see whirlpool tubs                          pipes: common types of 20–21; copper                  installations 146–147; shower bases

                                                                   22–29; fittings 30–31, 48–51; planning            154–161; showerheads 271–272;

       kitchens: and augers 279; dishwashers                       routes 64–69; sizing 77; water supply 10;         temperature control 270

          100–103; drains 96–99, 279; faucets                      see also specific types                        shutoff valves see valves

          90–95; garbage disposals 104–109;                    plastic pipes: flexible (polyethylene, or PE)      sinks: and clogs 278–279; kitchen 212–213;

          icemakers 110–115; pot fillers 222–223;                  20–21, 46–47; rigid (ABS, PVC, CPVC)              pedestal and console 200–201; utility

          sinks 212–213; sprayers 258–261                          20–21, 42–45                                      217; and vanities 208–211; wall-mounted

       kits: Access Reliability Center 164; drains             plumbing lines: drain and vent lines 72, 74;          (semi-pedestal) 202–205; see also

          97; faucet repair kit 250; flange repair kit             new installations 59–63, 75; planning             drains; faucets

          244; glass-wall kits 148; retrofit icemaker              routes 64–67; sample layouts 68–69;            sink sprayers see kitchens

          111; shower conversion 273; shower                       supply lines 70–71, 73                         softeners (water) 196–199

          enclosures 140                                       plungers: for sinks 278–279; for toilet clogs      soldering copper and brass 24–29, 71

                                                                   18, 241–242                                    solvent cements 42

                                                                                                                                                          INDEX   287

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 287 24/9/18 7:39 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 287 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:287

              stack see drain-waste-vent system (DWV)                  traps: drain-waste-vent systems (DWV) 8–9,      wall-mounted sinks see sinks

              stainless-steel pipes 20–21                                 11; kitchen drain repairs 96–99; lavatory    wall thickness 59, 76

              standpipe drains 214–215                                    (bathroom) drains 137                        washerless faucets see faucets

              stop valves 13; see also valves                          tubes (supply) 20–21, 53, 56–57                 washing machines 214–216

              supply system (water): and fittings 48–51;               tubs see bathtubs                               water-distribution pipes 77

                  how it works 8–10, 175; and installing               two-handled faucets see faucets                 water flow: and bathtubs and showers 274;

                  new lines 70–71; and pipes 22, 77; and                                                                  and faucets 250, 258

                  valves 52–55                                         Universal Design 165, 202;                      water hammer 282–283

              “sweating” copper see soldering copper                      see also accessibility                       water heaters: gas and electric 116–123;

                  and brass                                            utility sinks 214, 217                             tankless 116, 124–127

                                                                                                                       water meters 8–9

              tankless water heaters see water heaters                 valves: air admittance 214; control 61;         water softeners 196–199

              tile and tiling 154, 161, 170–173, 174                      diverter 258–260, 262–265; pressure          water supply system see supply

              toilets: clogs 240–243; common problems                     surges 282; repairs and installations           system (water)

                  and repairs 67, 226–231; flanges                        52–53, 54–55, 56–57; self-adjusting 216;     wax rings 86

                  244–247; installations and replacements                 shutoff 8–9, 12–13, 52–55, 56–57; and        wet rooms 162–163, 165

                  84–89, 226; low flow and water savings                  toilets 229, 230, 232–239                    wet walls 59, 66, 72, 76–81
                  236; tank or bowl water levels 230, 239;             vanities: double sinks 210–211; single          whirlpool tubs 72, 185–191;

                  valves and replacements 229, 230,                       sinks 208–209; traditional 206–207;             see also bathtubs

                  232–239                                                 see also sinks

              tools and general plumbing 15–19                         vents 8–9, 48, 74, 214

              traditional vanity see vanities

   288        THE COMPLETE GUIDE TO PLUMBING

305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 288 24/9/18 7:39 PM 305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition_224-288.indd 288 24/9/18 7:37 PM Title:305470 - B&D The Complete Guide to Plumbing 7th Edition Text Page:288

Rather have me do it?

Plumbing problems? I fix leaks, clogs, and install fixtures.